Mercurial > vim
annotate runtime/doc/options.txt @ 16443:32a543152dc0 v8.1.1226
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/6c60f47fb9251e686217d51cf81847e14d0dd26d
Author: Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
Date: Sun Apr 28 16:00:35 2019 +0200
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Problem: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text.
Solution: Make a list of all Vi options, instead of mentioning what Vi does
not have. Update the help text for options.
author | Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org> |
---|---|
date | Sun, 28 Apr 2019 16:15:06 +0200 |
parents | 9d20e26dc13c |
children | 54ffc82f38a8 |
rev | line source |
---|---|
16443
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
1 *options.txt* For Vim version 8.1. Last change: 2019 Apr 28 |
7 | 2 |
3 | |
4 VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar | |
5 | |
6 | |
7 Options *options* | |
8 | |
9 1. Setting options |set-option| | |
10 2. Automatically setting options |auto-setting| | |
11 3. Options summary |option-summary| | |
12 | |
10244
876fbdd84e52
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/2ec618c9feac4573b154510236ad8121c77d0eca
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10218
diff
changeset
|
13 For an overview of options see quickref.txt |option-list|. |
7 | 14 |
15 Vim has a number of internal variables and switches which can be set to | |
16 achieve special effects. These options come in three forms: | |
17 boolean can only be on or off *boolean* *toggle* | |
18 number has a numeric value | |
19 string has a string value | |
20 | |
21 ============================================================================== | |
523 | 22 1. Setting options *set-option* *E764* |
7 | 23 |
24 *:se* *:set* | |
25 :se[t] Show all options that differ from their default value. | |
26 | |
27 :se[t] all Show all but terminal options. | |
28 | |
29 :se[t] termcap Show all terminal options. Note that in the GUI the | |
30 key codes are not shown, because they are generated | |
31 internally and can't be changed. Changing the terminal | |
32 codes in the GUI is not useful either... | |
33 | |
34 *E518* *E519* | |
35 :se[t] {option}? Show value of {option}. | |
36 | |
37 :se[t] {option} Toggle option: set, switch it on. | |
38 Number option: show value. | |
39 String option: show value. | |
40 | |
41 :se[t] no{option} Toggle option: Reset, switch it off. | |
42 | |
2152 | 43 *:set-!* *:set-inv* |
7 | 44 :se[t] {option}! or |
16443
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
45 :se[t] inv{option} Toggle option: Invert value. |
7 | 46 |
47 *:set-default* *:set-&* *:set-&vi* *:set-&vim* | |
48 :se[t] {option}& Reset option to its default value. May depend on the | |
16443
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
49 current value of 'compatible'. |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
50 :se[t] {option}&vi Reset option to its Vi default value. |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
51 :se[t] {option}&vim Reset option to its Vim default value. |
7 | 52 |
13341
acd7eaa13d2b
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13314
diff
changeset
|
53 :se[t] all& Set all options to their default value. The values of |
7051
eff26a8620ce
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/88774fdd23f08355297bb8cda78856859051d3c7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
6949
diff
changeset
|
54 these options are not changed: |
eff26a8620ce
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/88774fdd23f08355297bb8cda78856859051d3c7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
6949
diff
changeset
|
55 all terminal options, starting with t_ |
eff26a8620ce
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/88774fdd23f08355297bb8cda78856859051d3c7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
6949
diff
changeset
|
56 'columns' |
eff26a8620ce
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/88774fdd23f08355297bb8cda78856859051d3c7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
6949
diff
changeset
|
57 'cryptmethod' |
eff26a8620ce
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/88774fdd23f08355297bb8cda78856859051d3c7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
6949
diff
changeset
|
58 'encoding' |
eff26a8620ce
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/88774fdd23f08355297bb8cda78856859051d3c7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
6949
diff
changeset
|
59 'key' |
eff26a8620ce
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/88774fdd23f08355297bb8cda78856859051d3c7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
6949
diff
changeset
|
60 'lines' |
eff26a8620ce
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/88774fdd23f08355297bb8cda78856859051d3c7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
6949
diff
changeset
|
61 'term' |
eff26a8620ce
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/88774fdd23f08355297bb8cda78856859051d3c7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
6949
diff
changeset
|
62 'ttymouse' |
eff26a8620ce
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/88774fdd23f08355297bb8cda78856859051d3c7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
6949
diff
changeset
|
63 'ttytype' |
eff26a8620ce
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/88774fdd23f08355297bb8cda78856859051d3c7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
6949
diff
changeset
|
64 Warning: This may have a lot of side effects. |
7 | 65 |
66 *:set-args* *E487* *E521* | |
67 :se[t] {option}={value} or | |
68 :se[t] {option}:{value} | |
69 Set string or number option to {value}. | |
70 For numeric options the value can be given in decimal, | |
8629
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
71 hex (preceded with 0x) or octal (preceded with '0'). |
7 | 72 The old value can be inserted by typing 'wildchar' (by |
73 default this is a <Tab> or CTRL-E if 'compatible' is | |
74 set). See |cmdline-completion|. | |
75 White space between {option} and '=' is allowed and | |
76 will be ignored. White space between '=' and {value} | |
77 is not allowed. | |
78 See |option-backslash| for using white space and | |
79 backslashes in {value}. | |
80 | |
81 :se[t] {option}+={value} *:set+=* | |
82 Add the {value} to a number option, or append the | |
83 {value} to a string option. When the option is a | |
84 comma separated list, a comma is added, unless the | |
85 value was empty. | |
86 If the option is a list of flags, superfluous flags | |
557 | 87 are removed. When adding a flag that was already |
88 present the option value doesn't change. | |
809 | 89 Also see |:set-args| above. |
7 | 90 |
91 :se[t] {option}^={value} *:set^=* | |
92 Multiply the {value} to a number option, or prepend | |
93 the {value} to a string option. When the option is a | |
94 comma separated list, a comma is added, unless the | |
95 value was empty. | |
96 Also see |:set-args| above. | |
97 | |
98 :se[t] {option}-={value} *:set-=* | |
99 Subtract the {value} from a number option, or remove | |
100 the {value} from a string option, if it is there. | |
101 If the {value} is not found in a string option, there | |
102 is no error or warning. When the option is a comma | |
103 separated list, a comma is deleted, unless the option | |
104 becomes empty. | |
105 When the option is a list of flags, {value} must be | |
106 exactly as they appear in the option. Remove flags | |
107 one by one to avoid problems. | |
108 Also see |:set-args| above. | |
109 | |
110 The {option} arguments to ":set" may be repeated. For example: > | |
111 :set ai nosi sw=3 ts=3 | |
112 If you make an error in one of the arguments, an error message will be given | |
113 and the following arguments will be ignored. | |
114 | |
115 *:set-verbose* | |
116 When 'verbose' is non-zero, displaying an option value will also tell where it | |
117 was last set. Example: > | |
118 :verbose set shiftwidth cindent? | |
14864 | 119 < shiftwidth=4 ~ |
120 Last set from modeline line 1 ~ | |
121 cindent ~ | |
122 Last set from /usr/local/share/vim/vim60/ftplugin/c.vim line 30 ~ | |
1621 | 123 This is only done when specific option values are requested, not for ":verbose |
124 set all" or ":verbose set" without an argument. | |
125 When the option was set by hand there is no "Last set" message. | |
7 | 126 When the option was set while executing a function, user command or |
127 autocommand, the script in which it was defined is reported. | |
128 Note that an option may also have been set as a side effect of setting | |
129 'compatible'. | |
1621 | 130 A few special texts: |
14864 | 131 Last set from modeline line 1 ~ |
1621 | 132 Option was set in a |modeline|. |
133 Last set from --cmd argument ~ | |
134 Option was set with command line argument |--cmd| or +. | |
135 Last set from -c argument ~ | |
136 Option was set with command line argument |-c|, +, |-S| or | |
137 |-q|. | |
138 Last set from environment variable ~ | |
139 Option was set from an environment variable, $VIMINIT, | |
140 $GVIMINIT or $EXINIT. | |
141 Last set from error handler ~ | |
142 Option was cleared when evaluating it resulted in an error. | |
143 | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
144 {not available when compiled without the |+eval| feature} |
7 | 145 |
146 *:set-termcap* *E522* | |
667 | 147 For {option} the form "t_xx" may be used to set a terminal option. This will |
7 | 148 override the value from the termcap. You can then use it in a mapping. If |
149 the "xx" part contains special characters, use the <t_xx> form: > | |
150 :set <t_#4>=^[Ot | |
151 This can also be used to translate a special code for a normal key. For | |
152 example, if Alt-b produces <Esc>b, use this: > | |
153 :set <M-b>=^[b | |
154 (the ^[ is a real <Esc> here, use CTRL-V <Esc> to enter it) | |
155 The advantage over a mapping is that it works in all situations. | |
156 | |
2726 | 157 You can define any key codes, e.g.: > |
158 :set t_xy=^[foo; | |
159 There is no warning for using a name that isn't recognized. You can map these | |
160 codes as you like: > | |
161 :map <t_xy> something | |
162 < *E846* | |
163 When a key code is not set, it's like it does not exist. Trying to get its | |
164 value will result in an error: > | |
165 :set t_kb= | |
166 :set t_kb | |
167 E846: Key code not set: t_kb | |
168 | |
36 | 169 The t_xx options cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
170 security reasons. | |
171 | |
7 | 172 The listing from ":set" looks different from Vi. Long string options are put |
10 | 173 at the end of the list. The number of options is quite large. The output of |
7 | 174 "set all" probably does not fit on the screen, causing Vim to give the |
175 |more-prompt|. | |
176 | |
177 *option-backslash* | |
178 To include white space in a string option value it has to be preceded with a | |
179 backslash. To include a backslash you have to use two. Effectively this | |
180 means that the number of backslashes in an option value is halved (rounded | |
181 down). | |
182 A few examples: > | |
183 :set tags=tags\ /usr/tags results in "tags /usr/tags" | |
184 :set tags=tags\\,file results in "tags\,file" | |
185 :set tags=tags\\\ file results in "tags\ file" | |
186 | |
10 | 187 The "|" character separates a ":set" command from a following command. To |
188 include the "|" in the option value, use "\|" instead. This example sets the | |
7 | 189 'titlestring' option to "hi|there": > |
190 :set titlestring=hi\|there | |
191 This sets the 'titlestring' option to "hi" and 'iconstring' to "there": > | |
192 :set titlestring=hi|set iconstring=there | |
193 | |
642 | 194 Similarly, the double quote character starts a comment. To include the '"' in |
195 the option value, use '\"' instead. This example sets the 'titlestring' | |
196 option to 'hi "there"': > | |
197 :set titlestring=hi\ \"there\" | |
198 | |
10 | 199 For MS-DOS and WIN32 backslashes in file names are mostly not removed. More |
7 | 200 precise: For options that expect a file name (those where environment |
201 variables are expanded) a backslash before a normal file name character is not | |
202 removed. But a backslash before a special character (space, backslash, comma, | |
203 etc.) is used like explained above. | |
204 There is one special situation, when the value starts with "\\": > | |
205 :set dir=\\machine\path results in "\\machine\path" | |
206 :set dir=\\\\machine\\path results in "\\machine\path" | |
207 :set dir=\\path\\file results in "\\path\file" (wrong!) | |
208 For the first one the start is kept, but for the second one the backslashes | |
209 are halved. This makes sure it works both when you expect backslashes to be | |
10 | 210 halved and when you expect the backslashes to be kept. The third gives a |
7 | 211 result which is probably not what you want. Avoid it. |
212 | |
213 *add-option-flags* *remove-option-flags* | |
214 *E539* *E550* *E551* *E552* | |
215 Some options are a list of flags. When you want to add a flag to such an | |
216 option, without changing the existing ones, you can do it like this: > | |
217 :set guioptions+=a | |
218 Remove a flag from an option like this: > | |
219 :set guioptions-=a | |
220 This removes the 'a' flag from 'guioptions'. | |
10 | 221 Note that you should add or remove one flag at a time. If 'guioptions' has |
7 | 222 the value "ab", using "set guioptions-=ba" won't work, because the string "ba" |
223 doesn't appear. | |
224 | |
225 *:set_env* *expand-env* *expand-environment-var* | |
22 | 226 Environment variables in specific string options will be expanded. If the |
7 | 227 environment variable exists the '$' and the following environment variable |
228 name is replaced with its value. If it does not exist the '$' and the name | |
229 are not modified. Any non-id character (not a letter, digit or '_') may | |
230 follow the environment variable name. That character and what follows is | |
231 appended to the value of the environment variable. Examples: > | |
232 :set term=$TERM.new | |
233 :set path=/usr/$INCLUDE,$HOME/include,. | |
234 When adding or removing a string from an option with ":set opt-=val" or ":set | |
235 opt+=val" the expansion is done before the adding or removing. | |
236 | |
237 | |
238 Handling of local options *local-options* | |
239 | |
240 Some of the options only apply to a window or buffer. Each window or buffer | |
10449
222b1432814e
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/5162822914372fc916a93f85848c0c82209e7cec
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10272
diff
changeset
|
241 has its own copy of this option, thus each can have its own value. This |
7 | 242 allows you to set 'list' in one window but not in another. And set |
243 'shiftwidth' to 3 in one buffer and 4 in another. | |
244 | |
245 The following explains what happens to these local options in specific | |
246 situations. You don't really need to know all of this, since Vim mostly uses | |
247 the option values you would expect. Unfortunately, doing what the user | |
248 expects is a bit complicated... | |
249 | |
250 When splitting a window, the local options are copied to the new window. Thus | |
251 right after the split the contents of the two windows look the same. | |
252 | |
253 When editing a new buffer, its local option values must be initialized. Since | |
254 the local options of the current buffer might be specifically for that buffer, | |
255 these are not used. Instead, for each buffer-local option there also is a | |
256 global value, which is used for new buffers. With ":set" both the local and | |
257 global value is changed. With "setlocal" only the local value is changed, | |
258 thus this value is not used when editing a new buffer. | |
259 | |
9852
4eea48b76d03
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/95ec9d6a6ab3117d60ff638670a803d43974ba51
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9737
diff
changeset
|
260 When editing a buffer that has been edited before, the options from the window |
4eea48b76d03
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/95ec9d6a6ab3117d60ff638670a803d43974ba51
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9737
diff
changeset
|
261 that was last closed are used again. If this buffer has been edited in this |
4eea48b76d03
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/95ec9d6a6ab3117d60ff638670a803d43974ba51
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9737
diff
changeset
|
262 window, the values from back then are used. Otherwise the values from the |
4eea48b76d03
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/95ec9d6a6ab3117d60ff638670a803d43974ba51
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9737
diff
changeset
|
263 last closed window where the buffer was edited last are used. |
7 | 264 |
265 It's possible to set a local window option specifically for a type of buffer. | |
266 When you edit another buffer in the same window, you don't want to keep | |
267 using these local window options. Therefore Vim keeps a global value of the | |
268 local window options, which is used when editing another buffer. Each window | |
269 has its own copy of these values. Thus these are local to the window, but | |
270 global to all buffers in the window. With this you can do: > | |
271 :e one | |
272 :set list | |
273 :e two | |
274 Now the 'list' option will also be set in "two", since with the ":set list" | |
275 command you have also set the global value. > | |
276 :set nolist | |
277 :e one | |
278 :setlocal list | |
279 :e two | |
280 Now the 'list' option is not set, because ":set nolist" resets the global | |
281 value, ":setlocal list" only changes the local value and ":e two" gets the | |
282 global value. Note that if you do this next: > | |
283 :e one | |
4358 | 284 You will get back the 'list' value as it was the last time you edited "one". |
285 The options local to a window are remembered for each buffer. This also | |
286 happens when the buffer is not loaded, but they are lost when the buffer is | |
287 wiped out |:bwipe|. | |
7 | 288 |
289 *:setl* *:setlocal* | |
290 :setl[ocal] ... Like ":set" but set only the value local to the | |
291 current buffer or window. Not all options have a | |
292 local value. If the option does not have a local | |
293 value the global value is set. | |
2413 | 294 With the "all" argument: display local values for all |
295 local options. | |
296 Without argument: Display local values for all local | |
297 options which are different from the default. | |
7 | 298 When displaying a specific local option, show the |
1621 | 299 local value. For a global/local boolean option, when |
300 the global value is being used, "--" is displayed | |
301 before the option name. | |
302 For a global option the global value is | |
7 | 303 shown (but that might change in the future). |
304 | |
809 | 305 :setl[ocal] {option}< Set the local value of {option} to its global value by |
306 copying the value. | |
307 | |
3281 | 308 :se[t] {option}< For |global-local| options: Remove the local value of |
309 {option}, so that the global value will be used. | |
7 | 310 |
311 *:setg* *:setglobal* | |
312 :setg[lobal] ... Like ":set" but set only the global value for a local | |
313 option without changing the local value. | |
314 When displaying an option, the global value is shown. | |
2413 | 315 With the "all" argument: display global values for all |
316 local options. | |
317 Without argument: display global values for all local | |
318 options which are different from the default. | |
7 | 319 |
320 For buffer-local and window-local options: | |
321 Command global value local value ~ | |
322 :set option=value set set | |
323 :setlocal option=value - set | |
324 :setglobal option=value set - | |
325 :set option? - display | |
326 :setlocal option? - display | |
327 :setglobal option? display - | |
328 | |
329 | |
330 Global options with a local value *global-local* | |
331 | |
40 | 332 Options are global when you mostly use one value for all buffers and windows. |
333 For some global options it's useful to sometimes have a different local value. | |
334 You can set the local value with ":setlocal". That buffer or window will then | |
335 use the local value, while other buffers and windows continue using the global | |
336 value. | |
7 | 337 |
338 For example, you have two windows, both on C source code. They use the global | |
339 'makeprg' option. If you do this in one of the two windows: > | |
340 :set makeprg=gmake | |
341 then the other window will switch to the same value. There is no need to set | |
342 the 'makeprg' option in the other C source window too. | |
343 However, if you start editing a Perl file in a new window, you want to use | |
1152 | 344 another 'makeprg' for it, without changing the value used for the C source |
10 | 345 files. You use this command: > |
7 | 346 :setlocal makeprg=perlmake |
347 You can switch back to using the global value by making the local value empty: > | |
348 :setlocal makeprg= | |
15729 | 349 This only works for a string option. For a number or boolean option you need |
350 to use the "<" flag, like this: > | |
7 | 351 :setlocal autoread< |
15729 | 352 Note that for non-boolean and non-number options using "<" copies the global |
353 value to the local value, it doesn't switch back to using the global value | |
354 (that matters when the global value changes later). You can also use: > | |
809 | 355 :set path< |
356 This will make the local value of 'path' empty, so that the global value is | |
357 used. Thus it does the same as: > | |
358 :setlocal path= | |
7 | 359 Note: In the future more global options can be made global-local. Using |
360 ":setlocal" on a global option might work differently then. | |
361 | |
362 | |
363 Setting the filetype | |
364 | |
11473 | 365 :setf[iletype] [FALLBACK] {filetype} *:setf* *:setfiletype* |
7 | 366 Set the 'filetype' option to {filetype}, but only if |
367 not done yet in a sequence of (nested) autocommands. | |
368 This is short for: > | |
369 :if !did_filetype() | |
370 : setlocal filetype={filetype} | |
371 :endif | |
372 < This command is used in a filetype.vim file to avoid | |
373 setting the 'filetype' option twice, causing different | |
374 settings and syntax files to be loaded. | |
11473 | 375 |
376 When the optional FALLBACK argument is present, a | |
377 later :setfiletype command will override the | |
16023 | 378 'filetype'. This is to be used for filetype |
379 detections that are just a guess. |did_filetype()| | |
380 will return false after this command. | |
11473 | 381 |
2698
b6471224d2af
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2681
diff
changeset
|
382 *option-window* *optwin* |
7 | 383 :bro[wse] se[t] *:set-browse* *:browse-set* *:opt* *:options* |
384 :opt[ions] Open a window for viewing and setting all options. | |
385 Options are grouped by function. | |
386 Offers short help for each option. Hit <CR> on the | |
387 short help to open a help window with more help for | |
388 the option. | |
389 Modify the value of the option and hit <CR> on the | |
390 "set" line to set the new value. For window and | |
391 buffer specific options, the last accessed window is | |
392 used to set the option value in, unless this is a help | |
393 window, in which case the window below help window is | |
394 used (skipping the option-window). | |
13437 | 395 {not available when compiled without the |+eval| |
396 feature} | |
7 | 397 |
398 *$HOME* | |
399 Using "~" is like using "$HOME", but it is only recognized at the start of an | |
400 option and after a space or comma. | |
401 | |
402 On Unix systems "~user" can be used too. It is replaced by the home directory | |
403 of user "user". Example: > | |
404 :set path=~mool/include,/usr/include,. | |
405 | |
406 On Unix systems the form "${HOME}" can be used too. The name between {} can | |
407 contain non-id characters then. Note that if you want to use this for the | |
408 "gf" command, you need to add the '{' and '}' characters to 'isfname'. | |
409 | |
12254 | 410 NOTE: expanding environment variables and "~/" is only done with the ":set" |
411 command, not when assigning a value to an option with ":let". | |
412 | |
413 *$HOME-windows* | |
3224 | 414 On MS-Windows, if $HOME is not defined as an environment variable, then |
415 at runtime Vim will set it to the expansion of $HOMEDRIVE$HOMEPATH. | |
12499 | 416 If $HOMEDRIVE is not set then $USERPROFILE is used. |
417 | |
418 This expanded value is not exported to the environment, this matters when | |
419 running an external command: > | |
420 :echo system('set | findstr ^HOME=') | |
421 and > | |
422 :echo luaeval('os.getenv("HOME")') | |
423 should echo nothing (an empty string) despite exists('$HOME') being true. | |
424 When setting $HOME to a non-empty string it will be exported to the | |
425 subprocesses. | |
3224 | 426 |
7 | 427 |
428 Note the maximum length of an expanded option is limited. How much depends on | |
429 the system, mostly it is something like 256 or 1024 characters. | |
430 | |
431 *:fix* *:fixdel* | |
432 :fix[del] Set the value of 't_kD': | |
433 't_kb' is 't_kD' becomes ~ | |
434 CTRL-? CTRL-H | |
435 not CTRL-? CTRL-? | |
436 | |
16443
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
437 (CTRL-? is 0177 octal, 0x7f hex) |
7 | 438 |
439 If your delete key terminal code is wrong, but the | |
440 code for backspace is alright, you can put this in | |
441 your .vimrc: > | |
442 :fixdel | |
443 < This works no matter what the actual code for | |
444 backspace is. | |
445 | |
446 If the backspace key terminal code is wrong you can | |
447 use this: > | |
448 :if &term == "termname" | |
449 : set t_kb=^V<BS> | |
450 : fixdel | |
451 :endif | |
452 < Where "^V" is CTRL-V and "<BS>" is the backspace key | |
10 | 453 (don't type four characters!). Replace "termname" |
7 | 454 with your terminal name. |
455 | |
456 If your <Delete> key sends a strange key sequence (not | |
457 CTRL-? or CTRL-H) you cannot use ":fixdel". Then use: > | |
458 :if &term == "termname" | |
459 : set t_kD=^V<Delete> | |
460 :endif | |
461 < Where "^V" is CTRL-V and "<Delete>" is the delete key | |
462 (don't type eight characters!). Replace "termname" | |
463 with your terminal name. | |
464 | |
465 *Linux-backspace* | |
466 Note about Linux: By default the backspace key | |
467 produces CTRL-?, which is wrong. You can fix it by | |
468 putting this line in your rc.local: > | |
469 echo "keycode 14 = BackSpace" | loadkeys | |
470 < | |
471 *NetBSD-backspace* | |
472 Note about NetBSD: If your backspace doesn't produce | |
473 the right code, try this: > | |
474 xmodmap -e "keycode 22 = BackSpace" | |
475 < If this works, add this in your .Xmodmap file: > | |
476 keysym 22 = BackSpace | |
477 < You need to restart for this to take effect. | |
478 | |
479 ============================================================================== | |
480 2. Automatically setting options *auto-setting* | |
481 | |
482 Besides changing options with the ":set" command, there are three alternatives | |
483 to set options automatically for one or more files: | |
484 | |
485 1. When starting Vim initializations are read from various places. See | |
486 |initialization|. Most of them are performed for all editing sessions, | |
487 and some of them depend on the directory where Vim is started. | |
488 You can create an initialization file with |:mkvimrc|, |:mkview| and | |
489 |:mksession|. | |
490 2. If you start editing a new file, the automatic commands are executed. | |
491 This can be used to set options for files matching a particular pattern and | |
492 many other things. See |autocommand|. | |
493 3. If you start editing a new file, and the 'modeline' option is on, a | |
494 number of lines at the beginning and end of the file are checked for | |
495 modelines. This is explained here. | |
496 | |
497 *modeline* *vim:* *vi:* *ex:* *E520* | |
498 There are two forms of modelines. The first form: | |
5055 | 499 [text]{white}{vi:|vim:|ex:}[white]{options} |
5024
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
500 |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
501 [text] any text or empty |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
502 {white} at least one blank character (<Space> or <Tab>) |
5055 | 503 {vi:|vim:|ex:} the string "vi:", "vim:" or "ex:" |
5024
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
504 [white] optional white space |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
505 {options} a list of option settings, separated with white space |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
506 or ':', where each part between ':' is the argument |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
507 for a ":set" command (can be empty) |
7 | 508 |
5055 | 509 Examples: |
782 | 510 vi:noai:sw=3 ts=6 ~ |
5055 | 511 vim: tw=77 ~ |
7 | 512 |
513 The second form (this is compatible with some versions of Vi): | |
514 | |
5024
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
515 [text]{white}{vi:|vim:|Vim:|ex:}[white]se[t] {options}:[text] |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
516 |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
517 [text] any text or empty |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
518 {white} at least one blank character (<Space> or <Tab>) |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
519 {vi:|vim:|Vim:|ex:} the string "vi:", "vim:", "Vim:" or "ex:" |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
520 [white] optional white space |
5055 | 521 se[t] the string "set " or "se " (note the space); When |
522 "Vim" is used it must be "set". | |
5024
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
523 {options} a list of options, separated with white space, which |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
524 is the argument for a ":set" command |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
525 : a colon |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
526 [text] any text or empty |
7 | 527 |
5055 | 528 Examples: |
782 | 529 /* vim: set ai tw=75: */ ~ |
5055 | 530 /* Vim: set ai tw=75: */ ~ |
7 | 531 |
5024
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
532 The white space before {vi:|vim:|Vim:|ex:} is required. This minimizes the |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
533 chance that a normal word like "lex:" is caught. There is one exception: |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
534 "vi:" and "vim:" can also be at the start of the line (for compatibility with |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
535 version 3.0). Using "ex:" at the start of the line will be ignored (this |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
536 could be short for "example:"). |
7 | 537 |
538 *modeline-local* | |
539 The options are set like with ":setlocal": The new value only applies to the | |
11 | 540 buffer and window that contain the file. Although it's possible to set global |
541 options from a modeline, this is unusual. If you have two windows open and | |
542 the files in it set the same global option to a different value, the result | |
543 depends on which one was opened last. | |
7 | 544 |
23 | 545 When editing a file that was already loaded, only the window-local options |
546 from the modeline are used. Thus if you manually changed a buffer-local | |
547 option after opening the file, it won't be changed if you edit the same buffer | |
548 in another window. But window-local options will be set. | |
549 | |
7 | 550 *modeline-version* |
551 If the modeline is only to be used for some versions of Vim, the version | |
5024
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
552 number can be specified where "vim:" or "Vim:" is used: |
7 | 553 vim{vers}: version {vers} or later |
554 vim<{vers}: version before {vers} | |
555 vim={vers}: version {vers} | |
556 vim>{vers}: version after {vers} | |
6647 | 557 {vers} is 700 for Vim 7.0 (hundred times the major version plus minor). |
558 For example, to use a modeline only for Vim 7.0: | |
559 /* vim700: set foldmethod=marker */ ~ | |
560 To use a modeline for Vim after version 7.2: | |
561 /* vim>702: set cole=2: */ ~ | |
7 | 562 There can be no blanks between "vim" and the ":". |
563 | |
564 | |
565 The number of lines that are checked can be set with the 'modelines' option. | |
566 If 'modeline' is off or 'modelines' is 0 no lines are checked. | |
567 | |
568 Note that for the first form all of the rest of the line is used, thus a line | |
782 | 569 like: |
570 /* vi:ts=4: */ ~ | |
571 will give an error message for the trailing "*/". This line is OK: | |
572 /* vi:set ts=4: */ ~ | |
7 | 573 |
574 If an error is detected the rest of the line is skipped. | |
575 | |
576 If you want to include a ':' in a set command precede it with a '\'. The | |
782 | 577 backslash in front of the ':' will be removed. Example: |
578 /* vi:set dir=c\:\tmp: */ ~ | |
7 | 579 This sets the 'dir' option to "c:\tmp". Only a single backslash before the |
580 ':' is removed. Thus to include "\:" you have to specify "\\:". | |
581 | |
582 No other commands than "set" are supported, for security reasons (somebody | |
1111 | 583 might create a Trojan horse text file with modelines). And not all options |
584 can be set. For some options a flag is set, so that when it's used the | |
1152 | 585 |sandbox| is effective. Still, there is always a small risk that a modeline |
1111 | 586 causes trouble. E.g., when some joker sets 'textwidth' to 5 all your lines |
587 are wrapped unexpectedly. So disable modelines before editing untrusted text. | |
588 The mail ftplugin does this, for example. | |
7 | 589 |
590 Hint: If you would like to do something else than setting an option, you could | |
591 define an autocommand that checks the file for a specific string. For | |
592 example: > | |
593 au BufReadPost * if getline(1) =~ "VAR" | call SetVar() | endif | |
594 And define a function SetVar() that does something with the line containing | |
595 "VAR". | |
596 | |
597 ============================================================================== | |
598 3. Options summary *option-summary* | |
599 | |
600 In the list below all the options are mentioned with their full name and with | |
601 an abbreviation if there is one. Both forms may be used. | |
602 | |
603 In this document when a boolean option is "set" that means that ":set option" | |
604 is entered. When an option is "reset", ":set nooption" is used. | |
605 | |
606 For some options there are two default values: The "Vim default", which is | |
607 used when 'compatible' is not set, and the "Vi default", which is used when | |
608 'compatible' is set. | |
609 | |
610 Most options are the same in all windows and buffers. There are a few that | |
10 | 611 are specific to how the text is presented in a window. These can be set to a |
7 | 612 different value in each window. For example the 'list' option can be set in |
613 one window and reset in another for the same text, giving both types of view | |
614 at the same time. There are a few options that are specific to a certain | |
615 file. These can have a different value for each file or buffer. For example | |
616 the 'textwidth' option can be 78 for a normal text file and 0 for a C | |
617 program. | |
618 | |
619 global one option for all buffers and windows | |
620 local to window each window has its own copy of this option | |
621 local to buffer each buffer has its own copy of this option | |
622 | |
623 When creating a new window the option values from the currently active window | |
624 are used as a default value for the window-specific options. For the | |
625 buffer-specific options this depends on the 's' and 'S' flags in the | |
626 'cpoptions' option. If 's' is included (which is the default) the values for | |
627 buffer options are copied from the currently active buffer when a buffer is | |
10 | 628 first entered. If 'S' is present the options are copied each time the buffer |
629 is entered, this is almost like having global options. If 's' and 'S' are not | |
7 | 630 present, the options are copied from the currently active buffer when the |
631 buffer is created. | |
632 | |
519 | 633 Hidden options *hidden-options* |
634 | |
635 Not all options are supported in all versions. This depends on the supported | |
636 features and sometimes on the system. A remark about this is in curly braces | |
637 below. When an option is not supported it may still be set without getting an | |
638 error, this is called a hidden option. You can't get the value of a hidden | |
639 option though, it is not stored. | |
640 | |
641 To test if option "foo" can be used with ":set" use something like this: > | |
642 if exists('&foo') | |
643 This also returns true for a hidden option. To test if option "foo" is really | |
644 supported use something like this: > | |
645 if exists('+foo') | |
646 < | |
7 | 647 *E355* |
648 A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|. | |
649 | |
650 *'aleph'* *'al'* *aleph* *Aleph* | |
651 'aleph' 'al' number (default 128 for MS-DOS, 224 otherwise) | |
652 global | |
653 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft| | |
654 feature} | |
655 The ASCII code for the first letter of the Hebrew alphabet. The | |
656 routine that maps the keyboard in Hebrew mode, both in Insert mode | |
657 (when hkmap is set) and on the command-line (when hitting CTRL-_) | |
658 outputs the Hebrew characters in the range [aleph..aleph+26]. | |
659 aleph=128 applies to PC code, and aleph=224 applies to ISO 8859-8. | |
660 See |rileft.txt|. | |
661 | |
662 *'allowrevins'* *'ari'* *'noallowrevins'* *'noari'* | |
663 'allowrevins' 'ari' boolean (default off) | |
664 global | |
665 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft| | |
666 feature} | |
667 Allow CTRL-_ in Insert and Command-line mode. This is default off, to | |
668 avoid that users that accidentally type CTRL-_ instead of SHIFT-_ get | |
669 into reverse Insert mode, and don't know how to get out. See | |
670 'revins'. | |
671 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
672 | |
673 *'altkeymap'* *'akm'* *'noaltkeymap'* *'noakm'* | |
674 'altkeymap' 'akm' boolean (default off) | |
675 global | |
676 {only available when compiled with the |+farsi| | |
677 feature} | |
15850
a6ca8cf07a98
patch 8.1.0932: Farsi support is outdated and unused
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15840
diff
changeset
|
678 This option was for using Farsi, which has been removed. See |
a6ca8cf07a98
patch 8.1.0932: Farsi support is outdated and unused
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15840
diff
changeset
|
679 |farsi.txt|. |
7 | 680 |
681 *'ambiwidth'* *'ambw'* | |
682 'ambiwidth' 'ambw' string (default: "single") | |
683 global | |
684 Only effective when 'encoding' is "utf-8" or another Unicode encoding. | |
685 Tells Vim what to do with characters with East Asian Width Class | |
686 Ambiguous (such as Euro, Registered Sign, Copyright Sign, Greek | |
687 letters, Cyrillic letters). | |
688 | |
689 There are currently two possible values: | |
233 | 690 "single": Use the same width as characters in US-ASCII. This is |
7 | 691 expected by most users. |
692 "double": Use twice the width of ASCII characters. | |
2492
c945fdb34ce3
Disallow setting 'ambiwidth' to "double" when 'listchars' or 'fillchars'
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2490
diff
changeset
|
693 *E834* *E835* |
c945fdb34ce3
Disallow setting 'ambiwidth' to "double" when 'listchars' or 'fillchars'
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2490
diff
changeset
|
694 The value "double" cannot be used if 'listchars' or 'fillchars' |
c945fdb34ce3
Disallow setting 'ambiwidth' to "double" when 'listchars' or 'fillchars'
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2490
diff
changeset
|
695 contains a character that would be double width. |
7 | 696 |
697 There are a number of CJK fonts for which the width of glyphs for | |
698 those characters are solely based on how many octets they take in | |
699 legacy/traditional CJK encodings. In those encodings, Euro, | |
700 Registered sign, Greek/Cyrillic letters are represented by two octets, | |
233 | 701 therefore those fonts have "wide" glyphs for them. This is also |
7 | 702 true of some line drawing characters used to make tables in text |
233 | 703 file. Therefore, when a CJK font is used for GUI Vim or |
7 | 704 Vim is running inside a terminal (emulators) that uses a CJK font |
705 (or Vim is run inside an xterm invoked with "-cjkwidth" option.), | |
706 this option should be set to "double" to match the width perceived | |
707 by Vim with the width of glyphs in the font. Perhaps it also has | |
708 to be set to "double" under CJK Windows 9x/ME or Windows 2k/XP | |
709 when the system locale is set to one of CJK locales. See Unicode | |
710 Standard Annex #11 (http://www.unicode.org/reports/tr11). | |
711 | |
4229 | 712 Vim may set this option automatically at startup time when Vim is |
713 compiled with the |+termresponse| feature and if |t_u7| is set to the | |
12499 | 714 escape sequence to request cursor position report. The response can |
715 be found in |v:termu7resp|. | |
4229 | 716 |
7 | 717 *'antialias'* *'anti'* *'noantialias'* *'noanti'* |
718 'antialias' 'anti' boolean (default: off) | |
719 global | |
720 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled | |
721 on Mac OS X} | |
722 This option only has an effect in the GUI version of Vim on Mac OS X | |
723 v10.2 or later. When on, Vim will use smooth ("antialiased") fonts, | |
724 which can be easier to read at certain sizes on certain displays. | |
725 Setting this option can sometimes cause problems if 'guifont' is set | |
726 to its default (empty string). | |
11160 | 727 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
7 | 728 |
729 *'autochdir'* *'acd'* *'noautochdir'* *'noacd'* | |
730 'autochdir' 'acd' boolean (default off) | |
731 global | |
2152 | 732 {only available when compiled with it, use |
733 exists("+autochdir") to check} | |
438 | 734 When on, Vim will change the current working directory whenever you |
735 open a file, switch buffers, delete a buffer or open/close a window. | |
736 It will change to the directory containing the file which was opened | |
737 or selected. | |
819 | 738 Note: When this option is on some plugins may not work. |
7 | 739 |
740 *'arabic'* *'arab'* *'noarabic'* *'noarab'* | |
741 'arabic' 'arab' boolean (default off) | |
742 local to window | |
743 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic| | |
744 feature} | |
745 This option can be set to start editing Arabic text. | |
746 Setting this option will: | |
747 - Set the 'rightleft' option, unless 'termbidi' is set. | |
748 - Set the 'arabicshape' option, unless 'termbidi' is set. | |
749 - Set the 'keymap' option to "arabic"; in Insert mode CTRL-^ toggles | |
750 between typing English and Arabic key mapping. | |
751 - Set the 'delcombine' option | |
752 Note that 'encoding' must be "utf-8" for working with Arabic text. | |
753 | |
754 Resetting this option will: | |
755 - Reset the 'rightleft' option. | |
756 - Disable the use of 'keymap' (without changing its value). | |
757 Note that 'arabicshape' and 'delcombine' are not reset (it is a global | |
3557 | 758 option). |
11160 | 759 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
7 | 760 Also see |arabic.txt|. |
761 | |
762 *'arabicshape'* *'arshape'* | |
763 *'noarabicshape'* *'noarshape'* | |
764 'arabicshape' 'arshape' boolean (default on) | |
765 global | |
766 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic| | |
767 feature} | |
768 When on and 'termbidi' is off, the required visual character | |
769 corrections that need to take place for displaying the Arabic language | |
3893 | 770 take effect. Shaping, in essence, gets enabled; the term is a broad |
7 | 771 one which encompasses: |
772 a) the changing/morphing of characters based on their location | |
773 within a word (initial, medial, final and stand-alone). | |
774 b) the enabling of the ability to compose characters | |
775 c) the enabling of the required combining of some characters | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
776 When disabled the display shows each character's true stand-alone |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
777 form. |
7 | 778 Arabic is a complex language which requires other settings, for |
779 further details see |arabic.txt|. | |
11160 | 780 NOTE: This option is set when 'compatible' is set. |
7 | 781 |
782 *'autoindent'* *'ai'* *'noautoindent'* *'noai'* | |
783 'autoindent' 'ai' boolean (default off) | |
784 local to buffer | |
785 Copy indent from current line when starting a new line (typing <CR> | |
786 in Insert mode or when using the "o" or "O" command). If you do not | |
787 type anything on the new line except <BS> or CTRL-D and then type | |
1152 | 788 <Esc>, CTRL-O or <CR>, the indent is deleted again. Moving the cursor |
789 to another line has the same effect, unless the 'I' flag is included | |
790 in 'cpoptions'. | |
10 | 791 When autoindent is on, formatting (with the "gq" command or when you |
792 reach 'textwidth' in Insert mode) uses the indentation of the first | |
793 line. | |
7 | 794 When 'smartindent' or 'cindent' is on the indent is changed in |
795 a different way. | |
7147
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
796 The 'autoindent' option is reset when the 'paste' option is set and |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
797 restored when 'paste' is reset. |
7 | 798 {small difference from Vi: After the indent is deleted when typing |
799 <Esc> or <CR>, the cursor position when moving up or down is after the | |
800 deleted indent; Vi puts the cursor somewhere in the deleted indent}. | |
801 | |
802 *'autoread'* *'ar'* *'noautoread'* *'noar'* | |
803 'autoread' 'ar' boolean (default off) | |
804 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
805 When a file has been detected to have been changed outside of Vim and | |
806 it has not been changed inside of Vim, automatically read it again. | |
14298
4a588e3afd4a
Update runtime files, add Danish translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14249
diff
changeset
|
807 When the file has been deleted this is not done, so you have the text |
4a588e3afd4a
Update runtime files, add Danish translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14249
diff
changeset
|
808 from before it was deleted. When it appears again then it is read. |
4a588e3afd4a
Update runtime files, add Danish translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14249
diff
changeset
|
809 |timestamp| |
7 | 810 If this option has a local value, use this command to switch back to |
811 using the global value: > | |
812 :set autoread< | |
813 < | |
814 *'autowrite'* *'aw'* *'noautowrite'* *'noaw'* | |
815 'autowrite' 'aw' boolean (default off) | |
816 global | |
817 Write the contents of the file, if it has been modified, on each | |
818 :next, :rewind, :last, :first, :previous, :stop, :suspend, :tag, :!, | |
864 | 819 :make, CTRL-] and CTRL-^ command; and when a :buffer, CTRL-O, CTRL-I, |
7 | 820 '{A-Z0-9}, or `{A-Z0-9} command takes one to another file. |
821 Note that for some commands the 'autowrite' option is not used, see | |
822 'autowriteall' for that. | |
14695 | 823 Some buffers will not be written, specifically when 'buftype' is |
14668 | 824 "nowrite", "nofile", "terminal" or "prompt". |
7 | 825 |
826 *'autowriteall'* *'awa'* *'noautowriteall'* *'noawa'* | |
827 'autowriteall' 'awa' boolean (default off) | |
828 global | |
829 Like 'autowrite', but also used for commands ":edit", ":enew", ":quit", | |
830 ":qall", ":exit", ":xit", ":recover" and closing the Vim window. | |
831 Setting this option also implies that Vim behaves like 'autowrite' has | |
832 been set. | |
833 | |
834 *'background'* *'bg'* | |
2826 | 835 'background' 'bg' string (default "dark" or "light", see below) |
7 | 836 global |
837 When set to "dark", Vim will try to use colors that look good on a | |
838 dark background. When set to "light", Vim will try to use colors that | |
839 look good on a light background. Any other value is illegal. | |
840 Vim tries to set the default value according to the terminal used. | |
841 This will not always be correct. | |
842 Setting this option does not change the background color, it tells Vim | |
843 what the background color looks like. For changing the background | |
844 color, see |:hi-normal|. | |
845 | |
846 When 'background' is set Vim will adjust the default color groups for | |
10 | 847 the new value. But the colors used for syntax highlighting will not |
1621 | 848 change. *g:colors_name* |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
849 When a color scheme is loaded (the "g:colors_name" variable is set) |
7 | 850 setting 'background' will cause the color scheme to be reloaded. If |
851 the color scheme adjusts to the value of 'background' this will work. | |
852 However, if the color scheme sets 'background' itself the effect may | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
853 be undone. First delete the "g:colors_name" variable when needed. |
7 | 854 |
855 When setting 'background' to the default value with: > | |
856 :set background& | |
857 < Vim will guess the value. In the GUI this should work correctly, | |
858 in other cases Vim might not be able to guess the right value. | |
859 | |
12499 | 860 When the |t_RB| option is set, Vim will use it to request the background |
11442 | 861 color from the terminal. If the returned RGB value is dark/light and |
862 'background' is not dark/light, 'background' will be set and the | |
863 screen is redrawn. This may have side effects, make t_BG empty in | |
12499 | 864 your .vimrc if you suspect this problem. The response to |t_RB| can |
12756
3b26420fc639
Long overdue runtime update.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12744
diff
changeset
|
865 be found in |v:termrbgresp|. |
11442 | 866 |
7 | 867 When starting the GUI, the default value for 'background' will be |
868 "light". When the value is not set in the .gvimrc, and Vim detects | |
869 that the background is actually quite dark, 'background' is set to | |
870 "dark". But this happens only AFTER the .gvimrc file has been read | |
871 (because the window needs to be opened to find the actual background | |
872 color). To get around this, force the GUI window to be opened by | |
873 putting a ":gui" command in the .gvimrc file, before where the value | |
874 of 'background' is used (e.g., before ":syntax on"). | |
2826 | 875 |
876 For MS-DOS, Windows and OS/2 the default is "dark". | |
877 For other systems "dark" is used when 'term' is "linux", | |
878 "screen.linux", "cygwin" or "putty", or $COLORFGBG suggests a dark | |
879 background. Otherwise the default is "light". | |
880 | |
12254 | 881 The |:terminal| command and the |term_start()| function use the |
882 'background' value to decide whether the terminal window will start | |
883 with a white or black background. | |
884 | |
7 | 885 Normally this option would be set in the .vimrc file. Possibly |
886 depending on the terminal name. Example: > | |
887 :if &term == "pcterm" | |
888 : set background=dark | |
889 :endif | |
890 < When this option is set, the default settings for the highlight groups | |
891 will change. To use other settings, place ":highlight" commands AFTER | |
892 the setting of the 'background' option. | |
893 This option is also used in the "$VIMRUNTIME/syntax/syntax.vim" file | |
894 to select the colors for syntax highlighting. After changing this | |
895 option, you must load syntax.vim again to see the result. This can be | |
896 done with ":syntax on". | |
897 | |
898 *'backspace'* *'bs'* | |
9669
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
899 'backspace' 'bs' string (default "", set to "indent,eol,start" |
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
900 in |defaults.vim|) |
7 | 901 global |
902 Influences the working of <BS>, <Del>, CTRL-W and CTRL-U in Insert | |
903 mode. This is a list of items, separated by commas. Each item allows | |
904 a way to backspace over something: | |
905 value effect ~ | |
906 indent allow backspacing over autoindent | |
907 eol allow backspacing over line breaks (join lines) | |
908 start allow backspacing over the start of insert; CTRL-W and CTRL-U | |
909 stop once at the start of insert. | |
910 | |
911 When the value is empty, Vi compatible backspacing is used. | |
912 | |
913 For backwards compatibility with version 5.4 and earlier: | |
914 value effect ~ | |
915 0 same as ":set backspace=" (Vi compatible) | |
916 1 same as ":set backspace=indent,eol" | |
917 2 same as ":set backspace=indent,eol,start" | |
918 | |
919 See |:fixdel| if your <BS> or <Del> key does not do what you want. | |
920 NOTE: This option is set to "" when 'compatible' is set. | |
921 | |
922 *'backup'* *'bk'* *'nobackup'* *'nobk'* | |
923 'backup' 'bk' boolean (default off) | |
924 global | |
925 Make a backup before overwriting a file. Leave it around after the | |
926 file has been successfully written. If you do not want to keep the | |
927 backup file, but you do want a backup while the file is being | |
928 written, reset this option and set the 'writebackup' option (this is | |
929 the default). If you do not want a backup file at all reset both | |
10 | 930 options (use this if your file system is almost full). See the |
7 | 931 |backup-table| for more explanations. |
932 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a backup is not made anyway. | |
933 When 'patchmode' is set, the backup may be renamed to become the | |
934 oldest version of a file. | |
935 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
936 | |
937 *'backupcopy'* *'bkc'* | |
938 'backupcopy' 'bkc' string (Vi default for Unix: "yes", otherwise: "auto") | |
6243 | 939 global or local to buffer |global-local| |
7 | 940 When writing a file and a backup is made, this option tells how it's |
941 done. This is a comma separated list of words. | |
942 | |
943 The main values are: | |
944 "yes" make a copy of the file and overwrite the original one | |
945 "no" rename the file and write a new one | |
946 "auto" one of the previous, what works best | |
947 | |
948 Extra values that can be combined with the ones above are: | |
949 "breaksymlink" always break symlinks when writing | |
950 "breakhardlink" always break hardlinks when writing | |
951 | |
952 Making a copy and overwriting the original file: | |
953 - Takes extra time to copy the file. | |
954 + When the file has special attributes, is a (hard/symbolic) link or | |
955 has a resource fork, all this is preserved. | |
956 - When the file is a link the backup will have the name of the link, | |
957 not of the real file. | |
958 | |
959 Renaming the file and writing a new one: | |
960 + It's fast. | |
961 - Sometimes not all attributes of the file can be copied to the new | |
962 file. | |
963 - When the file is a link the new file will not be a link. | |
964 | |
965 The "auto" value is the middle way: When Vim sees that renaming file | |
966 is possible without side effects (the attributes can be passed on and | |
1152 | 967 the file is not a link) that is used. When problems are expected, a |
968 copy will be made. | |
7 | 969 |
970 The "breaksymlink" and "breakhardlink" values can be used in | |
971 combination with any of "yes", "no" and "auto". When included, they | |
972 force Vim to always break either symbolic or hard links by doing | |
973 exactly what the "no" option does, renaming the original file to | |
974 become the backup and writing a new file in its place. This can be | |
975 useful for example in source trees where all the files are symbolic or | |
976 hard links and any changes should stay in the local source tree, not | |
977 be propagated back to the original source. | |
978 *crontab* | |
979 One situation where "no" and "auto" will cause problems: A program | |
980 that opens a file, invokes Vim to edit that file, and then tests if | |
981 the open file was changed (through the file descriptor) will check the | |
10 | 982 backup file instead of the newly created file. "crontab -e" is an |
7 | 983 example. |
984 | |
985 When a copy is made, the original file is truncated and then filled | |
986 with the new text. This means that protection bits, owner and | |
987 symbolic links of the original file are unmodified. The backup file | |
10 | 988 however, is a new file, owned by the user who edited the file. The |
7 | 989 group of the backup is set to the group of the original file. If this |
990 fails, the protection bits for the group are made the same as for | |
991 others. | |
992 | |
993 When the file is renamed this is the other way around: The backup has | |
994 the same attributes of the original file, and the newly written file | |
995 is owned by the current user. When the file was a (hard/symbolic) | |
996 link, the new file will not! That's why the "auto" value doesn't | |
997 rename when the file is a link. The owner and group of the newly | |
998 written file will be set to the same ones as the original file, but | |
999 the system may refuse to do this. In that case the "auto" value will | |
1000 again not rename the file. | |
1001 | |
11160 | 1002 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is |
1003 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
1004 | |
7 | 1005 *'backupdir'* *'bdir'* |
1006 'backupdir' 'bdir' string (default for Amiga: ".,t:", | |
5555 | 1007 for MS-DOS and Win32: ".,$TEMP,c:/tmp,c:/temp" |
7 | 1008 for Unix: ".,~/tmp,~/") |
1009 global | |
1010 List of directories for the backup file, separated with commas. | |
1011 - The backup file will be created in the first directory in the list | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
1012 where this is possible. The directory must exist, Vim will not |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
1013 create it for you. |
8629
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
1014 - Empty means that no backup file will be created ('patchmode' is |
7 | 1015 impossible!). Writing may fail because of this. |
1016 - A directory "." means to put the backup file in the same directory | |
1017 as the edited file. | |
33 | 1018 - A directory starting with "./" (or ".\" for MS-DOS et al.) means to |
7 | 1019 put the backup file relative to where the edited file is. The |
1020 leading "." is replaced with the path name of the edited file. | |
1021 ("." inside a directory name has no special meaning). | |
1022 - Spaces after the comma are ignored, other spaces are considered part | |
1023 of the directory name. To have a space at the start of a directory | |
1024 name, precede it with a backslash. | |
1025 - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with a backslash. | |
1026 - A directory name may end in an '/'. | |
14475
dddba3937532
patch 8.1.0251: using full path is not supported for 'backupdir'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14421
diff
changeset
|
1027 - For Unix and Win32, if a directory ends in two path separators "//", |
15033 | 1028 the backup file name will be built from the complete path to the |
1029 file with all path separators changed to percent '%' signs. This | |
1030 will ensure file name uniqueness in the backup directory. | |
14475
dddba3937532
patch 8.1.0251: using full path is not supported for 'backupdir'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14421
diff
changeset
|
1031 On Win32, it is also possible to end with "\\". However, When a |
dddba3937532
patch 8.1.0251: using full path is not supported for 'backupdir'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14421
diff
changeset
|
1032 separating comma is following, you must use "//", since "\\" will |
dddba3937532
patch 8.1.0251: using full path is not supported for 'backupdir'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14421
diff
changeset
|
1033 include the comma in the file name. Therefore it is recommended to |
dddba3937532
patch 8.1.0251: using full path is not supported for 'backupdir'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14421
diff
changeset
|
1034 use '//', instead of '\\'. |
7 | 1035 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. |
1036 - Careful with '\' characters, type one before a space, type two to | |
1037 get one in the option (see |option-backslash|), for example: > | |
1038 :set bdir=c:\\tmp,\ dir\\,with\\,commas,\\\ dir\ with\ spaces | |
1039 < - For backwards compatibility with Vim version 3.0 a '>' at the start | |
1040 of the option is removed. | |
1041 See also 'backup' and 'writebackup' options. | |
1042 If you want to hide your backup files on Unix, consider this value: > | |
1043 :set backupdir=./.backup,~/.backup,.,/tmp | |
1044 < You must create a ".backup" directory in each directory and in your | |
1045 home directory for this to work properly. | |
1046 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing | |
1047 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version | |
1048 uses another default. | |
1049 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
1050 security reasons. | |
1051 | |
1052 *'backupext'* *'bex'* *E589* | |
1053 'backupext' 'bex' string (default "~", for VMS: "_") | |
1054 global | |
1055 String which is appended to a file name to make the name of the | |
1056 backup file. The default is quite unusual, because this avoids | |
1057 accidentally overwriting existing files with a backup file. You might | |
1058 prefer using ".bak", but make sure that you don't have files with | |
1059 ".bak" that you want to keep. | |
36 | 1060 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal. |
7 | 1061 |
26 | 1062 If you like to keep a lot of backups, you could use a BufWritePre |
1063 autocommand to change 'backupext' just before writing the file to | |
1064 include a timestamp. > | |
1065 :au BufWritePre * let &bex = '-' . strftime("%Y%b%d%X") . '~' | |
1066 < Use 'backupdir' to put the backup in a different directory. | |
1067 | |
7 | 1068 *'backupskip'* *'bsk'* |
13664
f64c5e636c9f
patch 8.0.1704: 'backupskip' default doesn't work for Mac
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13482
diff
changeset
|
1069 'backupskip' 'bsk' string (default: "$TMPDIR/*,$TMP/*,$TEMP/*" |
f64c5e636c9f
patch 8.0.1704: 'backupskip' default doesn't work for Mac
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13482
diff
changeset
|
1070 Unix: "/tmp/*,$TMPDIR/*,$TMP/*,$TEMP/*" |
f64c5e636c9f
patch 8.0.1704: 'backupskip' default doesn't work for Mac
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13482
diff
changeset
|
1071 Mac: "/private/tmp/*,$TMPDIR/*,$TMP/*,$TEMP/*") |
7 | 1072 global |
1073 {not available when compiled without the |+wildignore| | |
1074 feature} | |
1075 A list of file patterns. When one of the patterns matches with the | |
1076 name of the file which is written, no backup file is created. Both | |
1077 the specified file name and the full path name of the file are used. | |
1078 The pattern is used like with |:autocmd|, see |autocmd-patterns|. | |
1079 Watch out for special characters, see |option-backslash|. | |
1080 When $TMPDIR, $TMP or $TEMP is not defined, it is not used for the | |
233 | 1081 default value. "/tmp/*" is only used for Unix. |
1152 | 1082 |
3513 | 1083 WARNING: Not having a backup file means that when Vim fails to write |
1084 your buffer correctly and then, for whatever reason, Vim exits, you | |
1085 lose both the original file and what you were writing. Only disable | |
1086 backups if you don't care about losing the file. | |
1087 | |
1152 | 1088 Note that environment variables are not expanded. If you want to use |
1089 $HOME you must expand it explicitly, e.g.: > | |
8835
c1a5623cfc86
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/7c1c6dbb6817640fd3956a0d5417da23fde336d8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8748
diff
changeset
|
1090 :let &backupskip = escape(expand('$HOME'), '\') . '/tmp/*' |
1152 | 1091 |
1092 < Note that the default also makes sure that "crontab -e" works (when a | |
557 | 1093 backup would be made by renaming the original file crontab won't see |
1094 the newly created file). Also see 'backupcopy' and |crontab|. | |
7 | 1095 |
1096 *'balloondelay'* *'bdlay'* | |
1097 'balloondelay' 'bdlay' number (default: 600) | |
1098 global | |
1099 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval| | |
1100 feature} | |
1101 Delay in milliseconds before a balloon may pop up. See |balloon-eval|. | |
1102 | |
1103 *'ballooneval'* *'beval'* *'noballooneval'* *'nobeval'* | |
1104 'ballooneval' 'beval' boolean (default off) | |
1105 global | |
1106 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval| | |
189 | 1107 feature} |
12865
ebb4f6c93598
patch 8.0.1309: cannot use 'balloonexpr' in a terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12826
diff
changeset
|
1108 Switch on the |balloon-eval| functionality for the GUI. |
ebb4f6c93598
patch 8.0.1309: cannot use 'balloonexpr' in a terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12826
diff
changeset
|
1109 |
ebb4f6c93598
patch 8.0.1309: cannot use 'balloonexpr' in a terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12826
diff
changeset
|
1110 *'balloonevalterm'* *'bevalterm'* *'noballoonevalterm'* |
ebb4f6c93598
patch 8.0.1309: cannot use 'balloonexpr' in a terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12826
diff
changeset
|
1111 *'nobevalterm'* |
ebb4f6c93598
patch 8.0.1309: cannot use 'balloonexpr' in a terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12826
diff
changeset
|
1112 'balloonevalterm' 'bevalterm' boolean (default off) |
ebb4f6c93598
patch 8.0.1309: cannot use 'balloonexpr' in a terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12826
diff
changeset
|
1113 global |
ebb4f6c93598
patch 8.0.1309: cannot use 'balloonexpr' in a terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12826
diff
changeset
|
1114 {only available when compiled with the |
ebb4f6c93598
patch 8.0.1309: cannot use 'balloonexpr' in a terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12826
diff
changeset
|
1115 |+balloon_eval_term| feature} |
ebb4f6c93598
patch 8.0.1309: cannot use 'balloonexpr' in a terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12826
diff
changeset
|
1116 Switch on the |balloon-eval| functionality for the terminal. |
7 | 1117 |
189 | 1118 *'balloonexpr'* *'bexpr'* |
1119 'balloonexpr' 'bexpr' string (default "") | |
790 | 1120 global or local to buffer |global-local| |
189 | 1121 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval| |
1122 feature} | |
782 | 1123 Expression for text to show in evaluation balloon. It is only used |
1124 when 'ballooneval' is on. These variables can be used: | |
189 | 1125 |
1126 v:beval_bufnr number of the buffer in which balloon is going to show | |
1127 v:beval_winnr number of the window | |
9227
ecb621205ed1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/82af8710bf8d1caeeceafb1370a052cb7d92f076
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9116
diff
changeset
|
1128 v:beval_winid ID of the window |
189 | 1129 v:beval_lnum line number |
1130 v:beval_col column number (byte index) | |
1131 v:beval_text word under or after the mouse pointer | |
1132 | |
1133 The evaluation of the expression must not have side effects! | |
1134 Example: > | |
1135 function! MyBalloonExpr() | |
435 | 1136 return 'Cursor is at line ' . v:beval_lnum . |
189 | 1137 \', column ' . v:beval_col . |
1138 \ ' of file ' . bufname(v:beval_bufnr) . | |
1139 \ ' on word "' . v:beval_text . '"' | |
1140 endfunction | |
1141 set bexpr=MyBalloonExpr() | |
1142 set ballooneval | |
1143 < | |
11062 | 1144 Also see |balloon_show()|, can be used if the content of the balloon |
1145 is to be fetched asynchronously. | |
1146 | |
189 | 1147 NOTE: The balloon is displayed only if the cursor is on a text |
1148 character. If the result of evaluating 'balloonexpr' is not empty, | |
1149 Vim does not try to send a message to an external debugger (Netbeans | |
1150 or Sun Workshop). | |
1151 | |
3682 | 1152 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a |
1153 modeline, see |sandbox-option|. | |
634 | 1154 |
1155 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while | |
1156 evaluating 'balloonexpr' |textlock|. | |
1157 | |
446 | 1158 To check whether line breaks in the balloon text work use this check: > |
435 | 1159 if has("balloon_multiline") |
714 | 1160 < When they are supported "\n" characters will start a new line. If the |
1161 expression evaluates to a |List| this is equal to using each List item | |
1162 as a string and putting "\n" in between them. | |
11160 | 1163 NOTE: This option is set to "" when 'compatible' is set. |
714 | 1164 |
6949 | 1165 *'belloff'* *'bo'* |
1166 'belloff' 'bo' string (default "") | |
1167 global | |
1168 Specifies for which events the bell will not be rung. It is a comma | |
1169 separated list of items. For each item that is present, the bell | |
1170 will be silenced. This is most useful to specify specific events in | |
1171 insert mode to be silenced. | |
1172 | |
1173 item meaning when present ~ | |
1174 all All events. | |
1175 backspace When hitting <BS> or <Del> and deleting results in an | |
1176 error. | |
1177 cursor Fail to move around using the cursor keys or | |
1178 <PageUp>/<PageDown> in |Insert-mode|. | |
1179 complete Error occurred when using |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-K| or | |
1180 |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-T|. | |
1181 copy Cannot copy char from insert mode using |i_CTRL-Y| or | |
1182 |i_CTRL-E|. | |
1183 ctrlg Unknown Char after <C-G> in Insert mode. | |
1184 error Other Error occurred (e.g. try to join last line) | |
1185 (mostly used in |Normal-mode| or |Cmdline-mode|). | |
1186 esc hitting <Esc> in |Normal-mode|. | |
1187 ex In |Visual-mode|, hitting |Q| results in an error. | |
1188 hangul Error occurred when using hangul input. | |
1189 insertmode Pressing <Esc> in 'insertmode'. | |
1190 lang Calling the beep module for Lua/Mzscheme/TCL. | |
1191 mess No output available for |g<|. | |
1192 showmatch Error occurred for 'showmatch' function. | |
1193 operator Empty region error |cpo-E|. | |
1194 register Unknown register after <C-R> in |Insert-mode|. | |
1195 shell Bell from shell output |:!|. | |
1196 spell Error happened on spell suggest. | |
1197 wildmode More matches in |cmdline-completion| available | |
1198 (depends on the 'wildmode' setting). | |
1199 | |
11160 | 1200 This is most useful to fine tune when in Insert mode the bell should |
1201 be rung. For Normal mode and Ex commands, the bell is often rung to | |
6949 | 1202 indicate that an error occurred. It can be silenced by adding the |
1203 "error" keyword. | |
1204 | |
7 | 1205 *'binary'* *'bin'* *'nobinary'* *'nobin'* |
1206 'binary' 'bin' boolean (default off) | |
1207 local to buffer | |
1208 This option should be set before editing a binary file. You can also | |
1209 use the |-b| Vim argument. When this option is switched on a few | |
1210 options will be changed (also when it already was on): | |
1211 'textwidth' will be set to 0 | |
1212 'wrapmargin' will be set to 0 | |
1213 'modeline' will be off | |
1214 'expandtab' will be off | |
1215 Also, 'fileformat' and 'fileformats' options will not be used, the | |
1216 file is read and written like 'fileformat' was "unix" (a single <NL> | |
1217 separates lines). | |
1218 The 'fileencoding' and 'fileencodings' options will not be used, the | |
1219 file is read without conversion. | |
1220 NOTE: When you start editing a(nother) file while the 'bin' option is | |
1221 on, settings from autocommands may change the settings again (e.g., | |
1222 'textwidth'), causing trouble when editing. You might want to set | |
1223 'bin' again when the file has been loaded. | |
1224 The previous values of these options are remembered and restored when | |
1225 'bin' is switched from on to off. Each buffer has its own set of | |
1226 saved option values. | |
1227 To edit a file with 'binary' set you can use the |++bin| argument. | |
1228 This avoids you have to do ":set bin", which would have effect for all | |
1229 files you edit. | |
1230 When writing a file the <EOL> for the last line is only written if | |
1231 there was one in the original file (normally Vim appends an <EOL> to | |
1232 the last line if there is none; this would make the file longer). See | |
1233 the 'endofline' option. | |
1234 | |
1235 *'bioskey'* *'biosk'* *'nobioskey'* *'nobiosk'* | |
1236 'bioskey' 'biosk' boolean (default on) | |
1237 global | |
16443
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
1238 {only for MS-DOS} |
8246
f16bfe02cef1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/f391327adbbffb11180cf6038a92af1ed144e907
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8182
diff
changeset
|
1239 This was for MS-DOS and is no longer supported. |
7 | 1240 |
1241 *'bomb'* *'nobomb'* | |
1242 'bomb' boolean (default off) | |
1243 local to buffer | |
1244 When writing a file and the following conditions are met, a BOM (Byte | |
1245 Order Mark) is prepended to the file: | |
1246 - this option is on | |
1247 - the 'binary' option is off | |
1248 - 'fileencoding' is "utf-8", "ucs-2", "ucs-4" or one of the little/big | |
1249 endian variants. | |
1250 Some applications use the BOM to recognize the encoding of the file. | |
1251 Often used for UCS-2 files on MS-Windows. For other applications it | |
1252 causes trouble, for example: "cat file1 file2" makes the BOM of file2 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
1253 appear halfway the resulting file. Gcc doesn't accept a BOM. |
7 | 1254 When Vim reads a file and 'fileencodings' starts with "ucs-bom", a |
1255 check for the presence of the BOM is done and 'bomb' set accordingly. | |
1256 Unless 'binary' is set, it is removed from the first line, so that you | |
1257 don't see it when editing. When you don't change the options, the BOM | |
1258 will be restored when writing the file. | |
1259 | |
1260 *'breakat'* *'brk'* | |
1261 'breakat' 'brk' string (default " ^I!@*-+;:,./?") | |
1262 global | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
1263 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak| |
7 | 1264 feature} |
1265 This option lets you choose which characters might cause a line | |
500 | 1266 break if 'linebreak' is on. Only works for ASCII and also for 8-bit |
1267 characters when 'encoding' is an 8-bit encoding. | |
7 | 1268 |
8835
c1a5623cfc86
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/7c1c6dbb6817640fd3956a0d5417da23fde336d8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8748
diff
changeset
|
1269 *'breakindent'* *'bri'* *'nobreakindent'* *'nobri'* |
6009 | 1270 'breakindent' 'bri' boolean (default off) |
1271 local to window | |
1272 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak| | |
1273 feature} | |
1274 Every wrapped line will continue visually indented (same amount of | |
1275 space as the beginning of that line), thus preserving horizontal blocks | |
1276 of text. | |
11160 | 1277 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
6009 | 1278 |
1279 *'breakindentopt'* *'briopt'* | |
1280 'breakindentopt' 'briopt' string (default empty) | |
1281 local to window | |
1282 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak| | |
1283 feature} | |
1284 Settings for 'breakindent'. It can consist of the following optional | |
6026 | 1285 items and must be separated by a comma: |
6009 | 1286 min:{n} Minimum text width that will be kept after |
1287 applying 'breakindent', even if the resulting | |
1288 text should normally be narrower. This prevents | |
1289 text indented almost to the right window border | |
1290 occupying lot of vertical space when broken. | |
6026 | 1291 shift:{n} After applying 'breakindent', the wrapped line's |
1292 beginning will be shifted by the given number of | |
1293 characters. It permits dynamic French paragraph | |
6009 | 1294 indentation (negative) or emphasizing the line |
1295 continuation (positive). | |
13341
acd7eaa13d2b
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13314
diff
changeset
|
1296 sbr Display the 'showbreak' value before applying the |
6009 | 1297 additional indent. |
1298 The default value for min is 20 and shift is 0. | |
1299 | |
7 | 1300 *'browsedir'* *'bsdir'* |
29 | 1301 'browsedir' 'bsdir' string (default: "last") |
7 | 1302 global |
16443
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
1303 {only for Motif, Athena, GTK, Mac and Win32 GUI} |
7 | 1304 Which directory to use for the file browser: |
1621 | 1305 last Use same directory as with last file browser, where a |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
1306 file was opened or saved. |
7 | 1307 buffer Use the directory of the related buffer. |
1308 current Use the current directory. | |
1309 {path} Use the specified directory | |
1310 | |
1311 *'bufhidden'* *'bh'* | |
1312 'bufhidden' 'bh' string (default: "") | |
1313 local to buffer | |
1314 This option specifies what happens when a buffer is no longer | |
1315 displayed in a window: | |
1316 <empty> follow the global 'hidden' option | |
1317 hide hide the buffer (don't unload it), also when 'hidden' | |
1318 is not set | |
1319 unload unload the buffer, also when 'hidden' is set or using | |
1320 |:hide| | |
1321 delete delete the buffer from the buffer list, also when | |
1322 'hidden' is set or using |:hide|, like using | |
1323 |:bdelete| | |
1324 wipe wipe out the buffer from the buffer list, also when | |
1325 'hidden' is set or using |:hide|, like using | |
1326 |:bwipeout| | |
1327 | |
82 | 1328 CAREFUL: when "unload", "delete" or "wipe" is used changes in a buffer |
3224 | 1329 are lost without a warning. Also, these values may break autocommands |
1330 that switch between buffers temporarily. | |
7 | 1331 This option is used together with 'buftype' and 'swapfile' to specify |
1332 special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|. | |
1333 | |
1334 *'buflisted'* *'bl'* *'nobuflisted'* *'nobl'* *E85* | |
1335 'buflisted' 'bl' boolean (default: on) | |
1336 local to buffer | |
1337 When this option is set, the buffer shows up in the buffer list. If | |
1338 it is reset it is not used for ":bnext", "ls", the Buffers menu, etc. | |
1339 This option is reset by Vim for buffers that are only used to remember | |
1340 a file name or marks. Vim sets it when starting to edit a buffer. | |
1341 But not when moving to a buffer with ":buffer". | |
1342 | |
1343 *'buftype'* *'bt'* *E382* | |
1344 'buftype' 'bt' string (default: "") | |
1345 local to buffer | |
1346 The value of this option specifies the type of a buffer: | |
1347 <empty> normal buffer | |
1348 nofile buffer which is not related to a file and will not be | |
1349 written | |
1350 nowrite buffer which will not be written | |
17 | 1351 acwrite buffer which will always be written with BufWriteCmd |
13437 | 1352 autocommands. |
7 | 1353 quickfix quickfix buffer, contains list of errors |:cwindow| |
648 | 1354 or list of locations |:lwindow| |
7 | 1355 help help buffer (you are not supposed to set this |
1356 manually) | |
11757
74abb6c84984
patch 8.0.0761: options not set properly for a terminal buffer
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11666
diff
changeset
|
1357 terminal buffer for a |terminal| (you are not supposed to set |
74abb6c84984
patch 8.0.0761: options not set properly for a terminal buffer
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11666
diff
changeset
|
1358 this manually) |
14019
dc67449d648c
patch 8.1.0027: difficult to make a plugin that feeds a line to a job
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14006
diff
changeset
|
1359 prompt buffer where only the last line can be edited, meant |
dc67449d648c
patch 8.1.0027: difficult to make a plugin that feeds a line to a job
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14006
diff
changeset
|
1360 to be used by a plugin, see |prompt-buffer| |
dc67449d648c
patch 8.1.0027: difficult to make a plugin that feeds a line to a job
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14006
diff
changeset
|
1361 {only when compiled with the |+channel| feature} |
7 | 1362 |
1363 This option is used together with 'bufhidden' and 'swapfile' to | |
1364 specify special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|. | |
1365 | |
1366 Be careful with changing this option, it can have many side effects! | |
1367 | |
648 | 1368 A "quickfix" buffer is only used for the error list and the location |
1369 list. This value is set by the |:cwindow| and |:lwindow| commands and | |
1370 you are not supposed to change it. | |
7 | 1371 |
1372 "nofile" and "nowrite" buffers are similar: | |
1373 both: The buffer is not to be written to disk, ":w" doesn't | |
1374 work (":w filename" does work though). | |
1375 both: The buffer is never considered to be |'modified'|. | |
1376 There is no warning when the changes will be lost, for | |
1377 example when you quit Vim. | |
1378 both: A swap file is only created when using too much memory | |
1379 (when 'swapfile' has been reset there is never a swap | |
1380 file). | |
1381 nofile only: The buffer name is fixed, it is not handled like a | |
1382 file name. It is not modified in response to a |:cd| | |
1383 command. | |
6647 | 1384 both: When using ":e bufname" and already editing "bufname" |
1385 the buffer is made empty and autocommands are | |
1386 triggered as usual for |:edit|. | |
17 | 1387 *E676* |
1388 "acwrite" implies that the buffer name is not related to a file, like | |
1389 "nofile", but it will be written. Thus, in contrast to "nofile" and | |
1390 "nowrite", ":w" does work and a modified buffer can't be abandoned | |
1391 without saving. For writing there must be matching |BufWriteCmd|, | |
1392 |FileWriteCmd| or |FileAppendCmd| autocommands. | |
7 | 1393 |
1394 *'casemap'* *'cmp'* | |
1395 'casemap' 'cmp' string (default: "internal,keepascii") | |
1396 global | |
1397 Specifies details about changing the case of letters. It may contain | |
1398 these words, separated by a comma: | |
1399 internal Use internal case mapping functions, the current | |
1400 locale does not change the case mapping. This only | |
493 | 1401 matters when 'encoding' is a Unicode encoding, |
1402 "latin1" or "iso-8859-15". When "internal" is | |
1403 omitted, the towupper() and towlower() system library | |
1404 functions are used when available. | |
7 | 1405 keepascii For the ASCII characters (0x00 to 0x7f) use the US |
1406 case mapping, the current locale is not effective. | |
1407 This probably only matters for Turkish. | |
1408 | |
1409 *'cdpath'* *'cd'* *E344* *E346* | |
1410 'cdpath' 'cd' string (default: equivalent to $CDPATH or ",,") | |
1411 global | |
1412 {not available when compiled without the | |
1413 |+file_in_path| feature} | |
1414 This is a list of directories which will be searched when using the | |
16427
8c3a1bd270bb
patch 8.1.1218: cannot set a directory for a tab page
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16380
diff
changeset
|
1415 |:cd|, |:tcd| and |:lcd| commands, provided that the directory being |
8c3a1bd270bb
patch 8.1.1218: cannot set a directory for a tab page
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16380
diff
changeset
|
1416 searched for has a relative path, not an absolute part starting with |
8c3a1bd270bb
patch 8.1.1218: cannot set a directory for a tab page
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16380
diff
changeset
|
1417 "/", "./" or "../", the 'cdpath' option is not used then. |
7 | 1418 The 'cdpath' option's value has the same form and semantics as |
1419 |'path'|. Also see |file-searching|. | |
1420 The default value is taken from $CDPATH, with a "," prepended to look | |
1421 in the current directory first. | |
1422 If the default value taken from $CDPATH is not what you want, include | |
1423 a modified version of the following command in your vimrc file to | |
1424 override it: > | |
1425 :let &cdpath = ',' . substitute(substitute($CDPATH, '[, ]', '\\\0', 'g'), ':', ',', 'g') | |
1426 < This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
1427 security reasons. | |
1428 (parts of 'cdpath' can be passed to the shell to expand file names). | |
1429 | |
1430 *'cedit'* | |
1431 'cedit' string (Vi default: "", Vim default: CTRL-F) | |
1432 global | |
1433 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit| | |
1434 feature} | |
1435 The key used in Command-line Mode to open the command-line window. | |
1436 The default is CTRL-F when 'compatible' is off. | |
1437 Only non-printable keys are allowed. | |
1438 The key can be specified as a single character, but it is difficult to | |
1439 type. The preferred way is to use the <> notation. Examples: > | |
9407
619a98a67f67
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e18dbe865d190e74fb5d43ac8bc6ac22507d0223
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9344
diff
changeset
|
1440 :exe "set cedit=\<C-Y>" |
619a98a67f67
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e18dbe865d190e74fb5d43ac8bc6ac22507d0223
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9344
diff
changeset
|
1441 :exe "set cedit=\<Esc>" |
7 | 1442 < |Nvi| also has this option, but it only uses the first character. |
1443 See |cmdwin|. | |
11160 | 1444 NOTE: This option is set to the Vim default value when 'compatible' |
1445 is reset. | |
7 | 1446 |
1447 *'charconvert'* *'ccv'* *E202* *E214* *E513* | |
1448 'charconvert' 'ccv' string (default "") | |
1449 global | |
15878 | 1450 {only available when compiled with the |+eval| feature} |
7 | 1451 An expression that is used for character encoding conversion. It is |
1452 evaluated when a file that is to be read or has been written has a | |
1453 different encoding from what is desired. | |
1454 'charconvert' is not used when the internal iconv() function is | |
1455 supported and is able to do the conversion. Using iconv() is | |
1456 preferred, because it is much faster. | |
1457 'charconvert' is not used when reading stdin |--|, because there is no | |
1458 file to convert from. You will have to save the text in a file first. | |
1459 The expression must return zero or an empty string for success, | |
1460 non-zero for failure. | |
1461 The possible encoding names encountered are in 'encoding'. | |
1462 Additionally, names given in 'fileencodings' and 'fileencoding' are | |
1463 used. | |
1464 Conversion between "latin1", "unicode", "ucs-2", "ucs-4" and "utf-8" | |
1465 is done internally by Vim, 'charconvert' is not used for this. | |
1466 'charconvert' is also used to convert the viminfo file, if the 'c' | |
1467 flag is present in 'viminfo'. Also used for Unicode conversion. | |
1468 Example: > | |
1469 set charconvert=CharConvert() | |
1470 fun CharConvert() | |
1471 system("recode " | |
1472 \ . v:charconvert_from . ".." . v:charconvert_to | |
1473 \ . " <" . v:fname_in . " >" v:fname_out) | |
1474 return v:shell_error | |
1475 endfun | |
1476 < The related Vim variables are: | |
1477 v:charconvert_from name of the current encoding | |
1478 v:charconvert_to name of the desired encoding | |
1479 v:fname_in name of the input file | |
1480 v:fname_out name of the output file | |
1481 Note that v:fname_in and v:fname_out will never be the same. | |
1482 Note that v:charconvert_from and v:charconvert_to may be different | |
1483 from 'encoding'. Vim internally uses UTF-8 instead of UCS-2 or UCS-4. | |
1484 Encryption is not done by Vim when using 'charconvert'. If you want | |
1485 to encrypt the file after conversion, 'charconvert' should take care | |
1486 of this. | |
1487 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
1488 security reasons. | |
1489 | |
1490 *'cindent'* *'cin'* *'nocindent'* *'nocin'* | |
1491 'cindent' 'cin' boolean (default off) | |
1492 local to buffer | |
1493 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent| | |
1494 feature} | |
1621 | 1495 Enables automatic C program indenting. See 'cinkeys' to set the keys |
7 | 1496 that trigger reindenting in insert mode and 'cinoptions' to set your |
1497 preferred indent style. | |
1498 If 'indentexpr' is not empty, it overrules 'cindent'. | |
1499 If 'lisp' is not on and both 'indentexpr' and 'equalprg' are empty, | |
1500 the "=" operator indents using this algorithm rather than calling an | |
1501 external program. | |
1502 See |C-indenting|. | |
1503 When you don't like the way 'cindent' works, try the 'smartindent' | |
1504 option or 'indentexpr'. | |
1505 This option is not used when 'paste' is set. | |
1506 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
1507 | |
1508 *'cinkeys'* *'cink'* | |
15701
9cd11f6beb70
patch 8.1.0858: 'indentkeys' and 'cinkeys' defaults are different
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15512
diff
changeset
|
1509 'cinkeys' 'cink' string (default "0{,0},0),0],:,0#,!^F,o,O,e") |
7 | 1510 local to buffer |
1511 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent| | |
1512 feature} | |
1513 A list of keys that, when typed in Insert mode, cause reindenting of | |
1514 the current line. Only used if 'cindent' is on and 'indentexpr' is | |
1515 empty. | |
1516 For the format of this option see |cinkeys-format|. | |
1517 See |C-indenting|. | |
1518 | |
1519 *'cinoptions'* *'cino'* | |
1520 'cinoptions' 'cino' string (default "") | |
1521 local to buffer | |
1522 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent| | |
1523 feature} | |
1524 The 'cinoptions' affect the way 'cindent' reindents lines in a C | |
1525 program. See |cinoptions-values| for the values of this option, and | |
1526 |C-indenting| for info on C indenting in general. | |
1527 | |
1528 | |
1529 *'cinwords'* *'cinw'* | |
1530 'cinwords' 'cinw' string (default "if,else,while,do,for,switch") | |
1531 local to buffer | |
1532 {not available when compiled without both the | |
1533 |+cindent| and the |+smartindent| features} | |
1534 These keywords start an extra indent in the next line when | |
1535 'smartindent' or 'cindent' is set. For 'cindent' this is only done at | |
1536 an appropriate place (inside {}). | |
1537 Note that 'ignorecase' isn't used for 'cinwords'. If case doesn't | |
1538 matter, include the keyword both the uppercase and lowercase: | |
1539 "if,If,IF". | |
1540 | |
1541 *'clipboard'* *'cb'* | |
1542 'clipboard' 'cb' string (default "autoselect,exclude:cons\|linux" | |
1543 for X-windows, "" otherwise) | |
1544 global | |
1545 {only in GUI versions or when the |+xterm_clipboard| | |
1546 feature is included} | |
1547 This option is a list of comma separated names. | |
1548 These names are recognized: | |
1549 | |
3674 | 1550 *clipboard-unnamed* |
7 | 1551 unnamed When included, Vim will use the clipboard register '*' |
1552 for all yank, delete, change and put operations which | |
1553 would normally go to the unnamed register. When a | |
1554 register is explicitly specified, it will always be | |
1555 used regardless of whether "unnamed" is in 'clipboard' | |
1556 or not. The clipboard register can always be | |
1557 explicitly accessed using the "* notation. Also see | |
1558 |gui-clipboard|. | |
1559 | |
3682 | 1560 *clipboard-unnamedplus* |
4119 | 1561 unnamedplus A variant of the "unnamed" flag which uses the |
1562 clipboard register '+' (|quoteplus|) instead of | |
1563 register '*' for all yank, delete, change and put | |
1564 operations which would normally go to the unnamed | |
1565 register. When "unnamed" is also included to the | |
1566 option, yank operations (but not delete, change or | |
1567 put) will additionally copy the text into register | |
1568 '*'. | |
2662 | 1569 Only available with the |+X11| feature. |
2654 | 1570 Availability can be checked with: > |
1571 if has('unnamedplus') | |
1572 < | |
3682 | 1573 *clipboard-autoselect* |
7 | 1574 autoselect Works like the 'a' flag in 'guioptions': If present, |
1575 then whenever Visual mode is started, or the Visual | |
1576 area extended, Vim tries to become the owner of the | |
1577 windowing system's global selection or put the | |
1578 selected text on the clipboard used by the selection | |
14999 | 1579 register "*. See |'go-a'| and |quotestar| for details. |
1580 When the GUI is active, the 'a' flag in 'guioptions' | |
1581 is used, when the GUI is not active, this "autoselect" | |
1582 flag is used. | |
7 | 1583 Also applies to the modeless selection. |
1584 | |
3674 | 1585 *clipboard-autoselectplus* |
1586 autoselectplus Like "autoselect" but using the + register instead of | |
1587 the * register. Compare to the 'P' flag in | |
1588 'guioptions'. | |
1589 | |
1590 *clipboard-autoselectml* | |
7 | 1591 autoselectml Like "autoselect", but for the modeless selection |
1592 only. Compare to the 'A' flag in 'guioptions'. | |
1593 | |
3674 | 1594 *clipboard-html* |
1904 | 1595 html When the clipboard contains HTML, use this when |
1596 pasting. When putting text on the clipboard, mark it | |
1597 as HTML. This works to copy rendered HTML from | |
1598 Firefox, paste it as raw HTML in Vim, select the HTML | |
1599 in Vim and paste it in a rich edit box in Firefox. | |
2240
6b4879aea261
Add test for gettabvar() and settabvar().
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2220
diff
changeset
|
1600 You probably want to add this only temporarily, |
6b4879aea261
Add test for gettabvar() and settabvar().
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2220
diff
changeset
|
1601 possibly use BufEnter autocommands. |
1904 | 1602 Only supported for GTK version 2 and later. |
1603 | |
3674 | 1604 *clipboard-exclude* |
7 | 1605 exclude:{pattern} |
1606 Defines a pattern that is matched against the name of | |
1607 the terminal 'term'. If there is a match, no | |
1608 connection will be made to the X server. This is | |
1609 useful in this situation: | |
1610 - Running Vim in a console. | |
1611 - $DISPLAY is set to start applications on another | |
1612 display. | |
1613 - You do not want to connect to the X server in the | |
1614 console, but do want this in a terminal emulator. | |
1615 To never connect to the X server use: > | |
1616 exclude:.* | |
1617 < This has the same effect as using the |-X| argument. | |
1618 Note that when there is no connection to the X server | |
1619 the window title won't be restored and the clipboard | |
1620 cannot be accessed. | |
1621 The value of 'magic' is ignored, {pattern} is | |
1622 interpreted as if 'magic' was on. | |
1623 The rest of the option value will be used for | |
1624 {pattern}, this must be the last entry. | |
1625 | |
1626 *'cmdheight'* *'ch'* | |
1627 'cmdheight' 'ch' number (default 1) | |
1628 global | |
1629 Number of screen lines to use for the command-line. Helps avoiding | |
1630 |hit-enter| prompts. | |
824 | 1631 The value of this option is stored with the tab page, so that each tab |
1632 page can have a different value. | |
7 | 1633 |
1634 *'cmdwinheight'* *'cwh'* | |
1635 'cmdwinheight' 'cwh' number (default 7) | |
1636 global | |
1637 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit| | |
1638 feature} | |
1639 Number of screen lines to use for the command-line window. |cmdwin| | |
1640 | |
2608
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1641 *'colorcolumn'* *'cc'* |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1642 'colorcolumn' 'cc' string (default "") |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1643 local to window |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1644 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1645 feature} |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1646 'colorcolumn' is a comma separated list of screen columns that are |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1647 highlighted with ColorColumn |hl-ColorColumn|. Useful to align |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1648 text. Will make screen redrawing slower. |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1649 The screen column can be an absolute number, or a number preceded with |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1650 '+' or '-', which is added to or subtracted from 'textwidth'. > |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1651 |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1652 :set cc=+1 " highlight column after 'textwidth' |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1653 :set cc=+1,+2,+3 " highlight three columns after 'textwidth' |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1654 :hi ColorColumn ctermbg=lightgrey guibg=lightgrey |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1655 < |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1656 When 'textwidth' is zero then the items with '-' and '+' are not used. |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1657 A maximum of 256 columns are highlighted. |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1658 |
7 | 1659 *'columns'* *'co'* *E594* |
1660 'columns' 'co' number (default 80 or terminal width) | |
1661 global | |
1662 Number of columns of the screen. Normally this is set by the terminal | |
161 | 1663 initialization and does not have to be set by hand. Also see |
1664 |posix-screen-size|. | |
7 | 1665 When Vim is running in the GUI or in a resizable window, setting this |
1666 option will cause the window size to be changed. When you only want | |
1667 to use the size for the GUI, put the command in your |gvimrc| file. | |
1668 When you set this option and Vim is unable to change the physical | |
1152 | 1669 number of columns of the display, the display may be messed up. For |
1670 the GUI it is always possible and Vim limits the number of columns to | |
1671 what fits on the screen. You can use this command to get the widest | |
1672 window possible: > | |
1673 :set columns=9999 | |
1674 < Minimum value is 12, maximum value is 10000. | |
7 | 1675 |
1676 *'comments'* *'com'* *E524* *E525* | |
1677 'comments' 'com' string (default | |
1678 "s1:/*,mb:*,ex:*/,://,b:#,:%,:XCOMM,n:>,fb:-") | |
1679 local to buffer | |
1680 {not available when compiled without the |+comments| | |
1681 feature} | |
1682 A comma separated list of strings that can start a comment line. See | |
1683 |format-comments|. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes to | |
1684 insert a space. | |
1685 | |
1686 *'commentstring'* *'cms'* *E537* | |
1687 'commentstring' 'cms' string (default "/*%s*/") | |
1688 local to buffer | |
1689 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
1690 feature} | |
1691 A template for a comment. The "%s" in the value is replaced with the | |
1692 comment text. Currently only used to add markers for folding, see | |
1693 |fold-marker|. | |
1694 | |
1695 *'compatible'* *'cp'* *'nocompatible'* *'nocp'* | |
819 | 1696 'compatible' 'cp' boolean (default on, off when a |vimrc| or |gvimrc| |
9669
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
1697 file is found, reset in |defaults.vim|) |
7 | 1698 global |
1699 This option has the effect of making Vim either more Vi-compatible, or | |
1700 make Vim behave in a more useful way. | |
11062 | 1701 |
7 | 1702 This is a special kind of option, because when it's set or reset, |
11062 | 1703 other options are also changed as a side effect. |
1704 NOTE: Setting or resetting this option can have a lot of unexpected | |
1705 effects: Mappings are interpreted in another way, undo behaves | |
1706 differently, etc. If you set this option in your vimrc file, you | |
1707 should probably put it at the very start. | |
1708 | |
7 | 1709 By default this option is on and the Vi defaults are used for the |
1710 options. This default was chosen for those people who want to use Vim | |
1711 just like Vi, and don't even (want to) know about the 'compatible' | |
1712 option. | |
819 | 1713 When a |vimrc| or |gvimrc| file is found while Vim is starting up, |
378 | 1714 this option is switched off, and all options that have not been |
1715 modified will be set to the Vim defaults. Effectively, this means | |
819 | 1716 that when a |vimrc| or |gvimrc| file exists, Vim will use the Vim |
378 | 1717 defaults, otherwise it will use the Vi defaults. (Note: This doesn't |
1152 | 1718 happen for the system-wide vimrc or gvimrc file, nor for a file given |
1719 with the |-u| argument). Also see |compatible-default| and | |
1720 |posix-compliance|. | |
7 | 1721 You can also set this option with the "-C" argument, and reset it with |
1722 "-N". See |-C| and |-N|. | |
11062 | 1723 See 'cpoptions' for more fine tuning of Vi compatibility. |
1724 | |
1725 When this option is set, numerous other options are set to make Vim as | |
1726 Vi-compatible as possible. When this option is unset, various options | |
1727 are set to make Vim more useful. The table below lists all the | |
1728 options affected. | |
1729 The {?} column indicates when the options are affected: | |
1730 + Means that the option is set to the value given in {set value} when | |
1731 'compatible' is set. | |
1732 & Means that the option is set to the value given in {set value} when | |
1733 'compatible' is set AND is set to its Vim default value when | |
1734 'compatible' is unset. | |
1735 - Means the option is NOT changed when setting 'compatible' but IS | |
1736 set to its Vim default when 'compatible' is unset. | |
1737 The {effect} column summarises the change when 'compatible' is set. | |
1738 | |
11160 | 1739 option ? set value effect ~ |
11062 | 1740 |
1741 'allowrevins' + off no CTRL-_ command | |
1742 'antialias' + off don't use antialiased fonts | |
1743 'arabic' + off reset arabic-related options | |
1744 'arabicshape' + on correct character shapes | |
1745 'backspace' + "" normal backspace | |
1746 'backup' + off no backup file | |
1747 'backupcopy' & Unix: "yes" backup file is a copy | |
1748 else: "auto" copy or rename backup file | |
1749 'balloonexpr' + "" text to show in evaluation balloon | |
1750 'breakindent' + off don't indent when wrapping lines | |
1751 'cedit' - {unchanged} {set vim default only on resetting 'cp'} | |
1752 'cindent' + off no C code indentation | |
1753 'compatible' - {unchanged} {set vim default only on resetting 'cp'} | |
1754 'copyindent' + off don't copy indent structure | |
1755 'cpoptions' & (all flags) Vi-compatible flags | |
1756 'cscopepathcomp'+ 0 don't show directories in tags list | |
13341
acd7eaa13d2b
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13314
diff
changeset
|
1757 'cscoperelative'+ off don't use basename of path as prefix |
11062 | 1758 'cscopetag' + off don't use cscope for ":tag" |
11160 | 1759 'cscopetagorder'+ 0 see |cscopetagorder| |
11062 | 1760 'cscopeverbose' + off see |cscopeverbose| |
1761 'delcombine' + off unicode: delete whole char combination | |
1762 'digraph' + off no digraphs | |
1763 'esckeys' & off no <Esc>-keys in Insert mode | |
1764 'expandtab' + off tabs not expanded to spaces | |
1765 'fileformats' & "" no automatic file format detection, | |
7 | 1766 "dos,unix" except for DOS, Windows and OS/2 |
11062 | 1767 'formatexpr' + "" use 'formatprg' for auto-formatting |
1768 'formatoptions' & "vt" Vi compatible formatting | |
1769 'gdefault' + off no default 'g' flag for ":s" | |
1770 'history' & 0 no commandline history | |
1771 'hkmap' + off no Hebrew keyboard mapping | |
1772 'hkmapp' + off no phonetic Hebrew keyboard mapping | |
1773 'hlsearch' + off no highlighting of search matches | |
1774 'incsearch' + off no incremental searching | |
1775 'indentexpr' + "" no indenting by expression | |
1776 'insertmode' + off do not start in Insert mode | |
1777 'iskeyword' & "@,48-57,_" keywords contain alphanumeric | |
7 | 1778 characters and '_' |
11062 | 1779 'joinspaces' + on insert 2 spaces after period |
1780 'modeline' & off no modelines | |
1781 'more' & off no pauses in listings | |
1782 'mzquantum' - {unchanged} {set vim default only on resetting 'cp'} | |
1783 'numberwidth' & 8 min number of columns for line number | |
1784 'preserveindent'+ off don't preserve current indent structure | |
1785 when changing it | |
1786 'revins' + off no reverse insert | |
1787 'ruler' + off no ruler | |
1788 'scrolljump' + 1 no jump scroll | |
1789 'scrolloff' + 0 no scroll offset | |
1790 'shelltemp' - {unchanged} {set vim default only on resetting 'cp'} | |
1791 'shiftround' + off indent not rounded to shiftwidth | |
1792 'shortmess' & "" no shortening of messages | |
1793 'showcmd' & off command characters not shown | |
1794 'showmode' & off current mode not shown | |
1795 'sidescrolloff' + 0 cursor moves to edge of screen in scroll | |
1796 'smartcase' + off no automatic ignore case switch | |
1797 'smartindent' + off no smart indentation | |
1798 'smarttab' + off no smart tab size | |
1799 'softtabstop' + 0 tabs are always 'tabstop' positions | |
1800 'startofline' + on goto startofline with some commands | |
1801 'tagcase' & "followic" 'ignorecase' when searching tags file | |
1802 'tagrelative' & off tag file names are not relative | |
1803 'termguicolors' + off don't use highlight-(guifg|guibg) | |
1804 'textauto' & off no automatic textmode detection | |
1805 'textwidth' + 0 no automatic line wrap | |
1806 'tildeop' + off tilde is not an operator | |
1807 'ttimeout' + off no terminal timeout | |
1808 'undofile' + off don't use an undo file | |
11160 | 1809 'viminfo' - {unchanged} {set Vim default only on resetting 'cp'} |
11062 | 1810 'virtualedit' + "" cursor can only be placed on characters |
1811 'whichwrap' & "" left-right movements don't wrap | |
1812 'wildchar' & CTRL-E only when the current value is <Tab> | |
7 | 1813 use CTRL-E for cmdline completion |
11062 | 1814 'writebackup' + on or off depends on the |+writebackup| feature |
7 | 1815 |
1816 *'complete'* *'cpt'* *E535* | |
1817 'complete' 'cpt' string (default: ".,w,b,u,t,i") | |
1818 local to buffer | |
1819 This option specifies how keyword completion |ins-completion| works | |
1820 when CTRL-P or CTRL-N are used. It is also used for whole-line | |
1821 completion |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-L|. It indicates the type of completion | |
1822 and the places to scan. It is a comma separated list of flags: | |
8629
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
1823 . scan the current buffer ('wrapscan' is ignored) |
7 | 1824 w scan buffers from other windows |
1825 b scan other loaded buffers that are in the buffer list | |
1826 u scan the unloaded buffers that are in the buffer list | |
1827 U scan the buffers that are not in the buffer list | |
1828 k scan the files given with the 'dictionary' option | |
703 | 1829 kspell use the currently active spell checking |spell| |
7 | 1830 k{dict} scan the file {dict}. Several "k" flags can be given, |
1831 patterns are valid too. For example: > | |
1832 :set cpt=k/usr/dict/*,k~/spanish | |
1833 < s scan the files given with the 'thesaurus' option | |
1834 s{tsr} scan the file {tsr}. Several "s" flags can be given, patterns | |
1835 are valid too. | |
1836 i scan current and included files | |
1837 d scan current and included files for defined name or macro | |
1838 |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-D| | |
1839 ] tag completion | |
1840 t same as "]" | |
1841 | |
1842 Unloaded buffers are not loaded, thus their autocmds |:autocmd| are | |
1843 not executed, this may lead to unexpected completions from some files | |
1844 (gzipped files for example). Unloaded buffers are not scanned for | |
1845 whole-line completion. | |
1846 | |
1847 The default is ".,w,b,u,t,i", which means to scan: | |
1848 1. the current buffer | |
1849 2. buffers in other windows | |
1850 3. other loaded buffers | |
1851 4. unloaded buffers | |
1852 5. tags | |
1853 6. included files | |
1854 | |
1855 As you can see, CTRL-N and CTRL-P can be used to do any 'iskeyword'- | |
233 | 1856 based expansion (e.g., dictionary |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-K|, included patterns |
1857 |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-I|, tags |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-]| and normal expansions). | |
7 | 1858 |
12 | 1859 *'completefunc'* *'cfu'* |
1860 'completefunc' 'cfu' string (default: empty) | |
1861 local to buffer | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
1862 {not available when compiled without the |+eval| |
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
1863 or |+insert_expand| features} |
623 | 1864 This option specifies a function to be used for Insert mode completion |
1865 with CTRL-X CTRL-U. |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-U| | |
648 | 1866 See |complete-functions| for an explanation of how the function is |
1867 invoked and what it should return. | |
2642 | 1868 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
1869 security reasons. | |
14 | 1870 |
540 | 1871 *'completeopt'* *'cot'* |
730 | 1872 'completeopt' 'cot' string (default: "menu,preview") |
540 | 1873 global |
766 | 1874 {not available when compiled without the |
1875 |+insert_expand| feature} | |
665 | 1876 A comma separated list of options for Insert mode completion |
1877 |ins-completion|. The supported values are: | |
540 | 1878 |
1879 menu Use a popup menu to show the possible completions. The | |
1880 menu is only shown when there is more than one match and | |
1881 sufficient colors are available. |ins-completion-menu| | |
1882 | |
707 | 1883 menuone Use the popup menu also when there is only one match. |
856 | 1884 Useful when there is additional information about the |
707 | 1885 match, e.g., what file it comes from. |
1886 | |
836 | 1887 longest Only insert the longest common text of the matches. If |
1888 the menu is displayed you can use CTRL-L to add more | |
1889 characters. Whether case is ignored depends on the kind | |
1890 of completion. For buffer text the 'ignorecase' option is | |
1891 used. | |
665 | 1892 |
730 | 1893 preview Show extra information about the currently selected |
1152 | 1894 completion in the preview window. Only works in |
1895 combination with "menu" or "menuone". | |
1896 | |
6911 | 1897 noinsert Do not insert any text for a match until the user selects |
1898 a match from the menu. Only works in combination with | |
1899 "menu" or "menuone". No effect if "longest" is present. | |
1900 | |
1901 noselect Do not select a match in the menu, force the user to | |
1902 select one from the menu. Only works in combination with | |
1903 "menu" or "menuone". | |
1904 | |
730 | 1905 |
2378
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1906 *'concealcursor'* *'cocu'* |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1907 'concealcursor' 'cocu' string (default: "") |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1908 local to window |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1909 {not available when compiled without the |+conceal| |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1910 feature} |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1911 Sets the modes in which text in the cursor line can also be concealed. |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1912 When the current mode is listed then concealing happens just like in |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1913 other lines. |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1914 n Normal mode |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1915 v Visual mode |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1916 i Insert mode |
2382
3a5ededa240a
Add the 'c' flag to 'concealcursor'.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2380
diff
changeset
|
1917 c Command line editing, for 'incsearch' |
3a5ededa240a
Add the 'c' flag to 'concealcursor'.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2380
diff
changeset
|
1918 |
2400
e6f1424dd66a
Let 'v' flag in 'concealcursor' apply to all lines in the Visual area.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2394
diff
changeset
|
1919 'v' applies to all lines in the Visual area, not only the cursor. |
2382
3a5ededa240a
Add the 'c' flag to 'concealcursor'.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2380
diff
changeset
|
1920 A useful value is "nc". This is used in help files. So long as you |
2378
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1921 are moving around text is concealed, but when starting to insert text |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1922 or selecting a Visual area the concealed text is displayed, so that |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1923 you can see what you are doing. |
2380
b47748aa3236
Don't conceal text in lines inside the Visual area.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2378
diff
changeset
|
1924 Keep in mind that the cursor position is not always where it's |
b47748aa3236
Don't conceal text in lines inside the Visual area.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2378
diff
changeset
|
1925 displayed. E.g., when moving vertically it may change column. |
2378
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1926 |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1927 |
14864 | 1928 *'conceallevel'* *'cole'* |
1929 'conceallevel' 'cole' number (default 0) | |
2250
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
1930 local to window |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
1931 {not available when compiled without the |+conceal| |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
1932 feature} |
2340
99c1eba60b2d
Make automatic prototype generation work with more interfaces.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2337
diff
changeset
|
1933 Determine how text with the "conceal" syntax attribute |:syn-conceal| |
99c1eba60b2d
Make automatic prototype generation work with more interfaces.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2337
diff
changeset
|
1934 is shown: |
99c1eba60b2d
Make automatic prototype generation work with more interfaces.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2337
diff
changeset
|
1935 |
99c1eba60b2d
Make automatic prototype generation work with more interfaces.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2337
diff
changeset
|
1936 Value Effect ~ |
2250
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
1937 0 Text is shown normally |
2426 | 1938 1 Each block of concealed text is replaced with one |
1939 character. If the syntax item does not have a custom | |
1940 replacement character defined (see |:syn-cchar|) the | |
1941 character defined in 'listchars' is used (default is a | |
1942 space). | |
1943 It is highlighted with the "Conceal" highlight group. | |
2250
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
1944 2 Concealed text is completely hidden unless it has a |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
1945 custom replacement character defined (see |
2426 | 1946 |:syn-cchar|). |
2349
586a459f3980
Never hide text for conceal in cursor line. Do hide when there is
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2348
diff
changeset
|
1947 3 Concealed text is completely hidden. |
586a459f3980
Never hide text for conceal in cursor line. Do hide when there is
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2348
diff
changeset
|
1948 |
586a459f3980
Never hide text for conceal in cursor line. Do hide when there is
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2348
diff
changeset
|
1949 Note: in the cursor line concealed text is not hidden, so that you can |
2378
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1950 edit and copy the text. This can be changed with the 'concealcursor' |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1951 option. |
2250
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
1952 |
7 | 1953 *'confirm'* *'cf'* *'noconfirm'* *'nocf'* |
1954 'confirm' 'cf' boolean (default off) | |
1955 global | |
1956 When 'confirm' is on, certain operations that would normally | |
1957 fail because of unsaved changes to a buffer, e.g. ":q" and ":e", | |
1958 instead raise a |dialog| asking if you wish to save the current | |
1959 file(s). You can still use a ! to unconditionally |abandon| a buffer. | |
1960 If 'confirm' is off you can still activate confirmation for one | |
1961 command only (this is most useful in mappings) with the |:confirm| | |
1962 command. | |
1963 Also see the |confirm()| function and the 'v' flag in 'guioptions'. | |
1964 | |
1965 *'conskey'* *'consk'* *'noconskey'* *'noconsk'* | |
1966 'conskey' 'consk' boolean (default off) | |
1967 global | |
8246
f16bfe02cef1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/f391327adbbffb11180cf6038a92af1ed144e907
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8182
diff
changeset
|
1968 This was for MS-DOS and is no longer supported. |
7 | 1969 |
1970 *'copyindent'* *'ci'* *'nocopyindent'* *'noci'* | |
1971 'copyindent' 'ci' boolean (default off) | |
1972 local to buffer | |
1973 Copy the structure of the existing lines indent when autoindenting a | |
1974 new line. Normally the new indent is reconstructed by a series of | |
1975 tabs followed by spaces as required (unless |'expandtab'| is enabled, | |
1976 in which case only spaces are used). Enabling this option makes the | |
1977 new line copy whatever characters were used for indenting on the | |
1621 | 1978 existing line. 'expandtab' has no effect on these characters, a Tab |
1979 remains a Tab. If the new indent is greater than on the existing | |
7 | 1980 line, the remaining space is filled in the normal manner. |
11160 | 1981 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
7 | 1982 Also see 'preserveindent'. |
1983 | |
8148
f5da459c5698
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e0fa3742ead676a3074a10edadbc955e1a89153d
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8061
diff
changeset
|
1984 *'cpoptions'* *'cpo'* *cpo* |
7 | 1985 'cpoptions' 'cpo' string (Vim default: "aABceFs", |
1986 Vi default: all flags) | |
1987 global | |
1988 A sequence of single character flags. When a character is present | |
5340 | 1989 this indicates Vi-compatible behavior. This is used for things where |
1990 not being Vi-compatible is mostly or sometimes preferred. | |
7 | 1991 'cpoptions' stands for "compatible-options". |
1992 Commas can be added for readability. | |
1993 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the | |
1994 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|. | |
1995 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is | |
1996 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
164 | 1997 NOTE: This option is set to the POSIX default value at startup when |
1998 the Vi default value would be used and the $VIM_POSIX environment | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
1999 variable exists |posix|. This means Vim tries to behave like the |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2000 POSIX specification. |
7 | 2001 |
2002 contains behavior ~ | |
2003 *cpo-a* | |
2004 a When included, a ":read" command with a file name | |
2005 argument will set the alternate file name for the | |
2006 current window. | |
2007 *cpo-A* | |
2008 A When included, a ":write" command with a file name | |
2009 argument will set the alternate file name for the | |
2010 current window. | |
2011 *cpo-b* | |
2012 b "\|" in a ":map" command is recognized as the end of | |
2013 the map command. The '\' is included in the mapping, | |
2014 the text after the '|' is interpreted as the next | |
2015 command. Use a CTRL-V instead of a backslash to | |
2016 include the '|' in the mapping. Applies to all | |
2017 mapping, abbreviation, menu and autocmd commands. | |
2018 See also |map_bar|. | |
2019 *cpo-B* | |
2020 B A backslash has no special meaning in mappings, | |
14372 | 2021 abbreviations, user commands and the "to" part of the |
2022 menu commands. Remove this flag to be able to use a | |
2023 backslash like a CTRL-V. For example, the command | |
2024 ":map X \<Esc>" results in X being mapped to: | |
7 | 2025 'B' included: "\^[" (^[ is a real <Esc>) |
2026 'B' excluded: "<Esc>" (5 characters) | |
2027 ('<' excluded in both cases) | |
2028 *cpo-c* | |
2029 c Searching continues at the end of any match at the | |
2030 cursor position, but not further than the start of the | |
2031 next line. When not present searching continues | |
2032 one character from the cursor position. With 'c' | |
2033 "abababababab" only gets three matches when repeating | |
2034 "/abab", without 'c' there are five matches. | |
2035 *cpo-C* | |
2036 C Do not concatenate sourced lines that start with a | |
2037 backslash. See |line-continuation|. | |
2038 *cpo-d* | |
2039 d Using "./" in the 'tags' option doesn't mean to use | |
2040 the tags file relative to the current file, but the | |
2041 tags file in the current directory. | |
2042 *cpo-D* | |
2043 D Can't use CTRL-K to enter a digraph after Normal mode | |
2044 commands with a character argument, like |r|, |f| and | |
2045 |t|. | |
2046 *cpo-e* | |
2047 e When executing a register with ":@r", always add a | |
2048 <CR> to the last line, also when the register is not | |
2049 linewise. If this flag is not present, the register | |
2050 is not linewise and the last line does not end in a | |
2051 <CR>, then the last line is put on the command-line | |
2052 and can be edited before hitting <CR>. | |
2053 *cpo-E* | |
2054 E It is an error when using "y", "d", "c", "g~", "gu" or | |
2055 "gU" on an Empty region. The operators only work when | |
13818
28ac7914b2b6
Update runtime files and translations
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13742
diff
changeset
|
2056 at least one character is to be operated on. Example: |
7 | 2057 This makes "y0" fail in the first column. |
2058 *cpo-f* | |
2059 f When included, a ":read" command with a file name | |
2060 argument will set the file name for the current buffer, | |
2061 if the current buffer doesn't have a file name yet. | |
2062 *cpo-F* | |
2063 F When included, a ":write" command with a file name | |
2064 argument will set the file name for the current | |
2065 buffer, if the current buffer doesn't have a file name | |
590 | 2066 yet. Also see |cpo-P|. |
7 | 2067 *cpo-g* |
2068 g Goto line 1 when using ":edit" without argument. | |
164 | 2069 *cpo-H* |
2070 H When using "I" on a line with only blanks, insert | |
2071 before the last blank. Without this flag insert after | |
2072 the last blank. | |
7 | 2073 *cpo-i* |
2074 i When included, interrupting the reading of a file will | |
2075 leave it modified. | |
10 | 2076 *cpo-I* |
2077 I When moving the cursor up or down just after inserting | |
2078 indent for 'autoindent', do not delete the indent. | |
7 | 2079 *cpo-j* |
2080 j When joining lines, only add two spaces after a '.', | |
2081 not after '!' or '?'. Also see 'joinspaces'. | |
2082 *cpo-J* | |
2083 J A |sentence| has to be followed by two spaces after | |
233 | 2084 the '.', '!' or '?'. A <Tab> is not recognized as |
7 | 2085 white space. |
2086 *cpo-k* | |
2087 k Disable the recognition of raw key codes in | |
2088 mappings, abbreviations, and the "to" part of menu | |
2089 commands. For example, if <Key> sends ^[OA (where ^[ | |
2090 is <Esc>), the command ":map X ^[OA" results in X | |
2091 being mapped to: | |
2092 'k' included: "^[OA" (3 characters) | |
2093 'k' excluded: "<Key>" (one key code) | |
2094 Also see the '<' flag below. | |
2095 *cpo-K* | |
2096 K Don't wait for a key code to complete when it is | |
2097 halfway a mapping. This breaks mapping <F1><F1> when | |
2098 only part of the second <F1> has been read. It | |
2099 enables cancelling the mapping by typing <F1><Esc>. | |
2100 *cpo-l* | |
2101 l Backslash in a [] range in a search pattern is taken | |
168 | 2102 literally, only "\]", "\^", "\-" and "\\" are special. |
2103 See |/[]| | |
7 | 2104 'l' included: "/[ \t]" finds <Space>, '\' and 't' |
2105 'l' excluded: "/[ \t]" finds <Space> and <Tab> | |
168 | 2106 Also see |cpo-\|. |
7 | 2107 *cpo-L* |
2108 L When the 'list' option is set, 'wrapmargin', | |
2109 'textwidth', 'softtabstop' and Virtual Replace mode | |
2110 (see |gR|) count a <Tab> as two characters, instead of | |
2111 the normal behavior of a <Tab>. | |
2112 *cpo-m* | |
2113 m When included, a showmatch will always wait half a | |
2114 second. When not included, a showmatch will wait half | |
2115 a second or until a character is typed. |'showmatch'| | |
2116 *cpo-M* | |
2117 M When excluded, "%" matching will take backslashes into | |
2118 account. Thus in "( \( )" and "\( ( \)" the outer | |
2119 parenthesis match. When included "%" ignores | |
2120 backslashes, which is Vi compatible. | |
2121 *cpo-n* | |
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2122 n When included, the column used for 'number' and |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2123 'relativenumber' will also be used for text of wrapped |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2124 lines. |
7 | 2125 *cpo-o* |
2126 o Line offset to search command is not remembered for | |
2127 next search. | |
2128 *cpo-O* | |
2129 O Don't complain if a file is being overwritten, even | |
2130 when it didn't exist when editing it. This is a | |
2131 protection against a file unexpectedly created by | |
2132 someone else. Vi didn't complain about this. | |
2133 *cpo-p* | |
2134 p Vi compatible Lisp indenting. When not present, a | |
2135 slightly better algorithm is used. | |
590 | 2136 *cpo-P* |
2137 P When included, a ":write" command that appends to a | |
2138 file will set the file name for the current buffer, if | |
2139 the current buffer doesn't have a file name yet and | |
2140 the 'F' flag is also included |cpo-F|. | |
164 | 2141 *cpo-q* |
2142 q When joining multiple lines leave the cursor at the | |
2143 position where it would be when joining two lines. | |
7 | 2144 *cpo-r* |
2145 r Redo ("." command) uses "/" to repeat a search | |
2146 command, instead of the actually used search string. | |
2147 *cpo-R* | |
2148 R Remove marks from filtered lines. Without this flag | |
2149 marks are kept like |:keepmarks| was used. | |
2150 *cpo-s* | |
2151 s Set buffer options when entering the buffer for the | |
2152 first time. This is like it is in Vim version 3.0. | |
10 | 2153 And it is the default. If not present the options are |
7 | 2154 set when the buffer is created. |
2155 *cpo-S* | |
2156 S Set buffer options always when entering a buffer | |
2157 (except 'readonly', 'fileformat', 'filetype' and | |
2158 'syntax'). This is the (most) Vi compatible setting. | |
2159 The options are set to the values in the current | |
2160 buffer. When you change an option and go to another | |
2161 buffer, the value is copied. Effectively makes the | |
2162 buffer options global to all buffers. | |
2163 | |
2164 's' 'S' copy buffer options | |
2165 no no when buffer created | |
2166 yes no when buffer first entered (default) | |
2167 X yes each time when buffer entered (vi comp.) | |
2168 *cpo-t* | |
2169 t Search pattern for the tag command is remembered for | |
2170 "n" command. Otherwise Vim only puts the pattern in | |
2171 the history for search pattern, but doesn't change the | |
2172 last used search pattern. | |
2173 *cpo-u* | |
10 | 2174 u Undo is Vi compatible. See |undo-two-ways|. |
7 | 2175 *cpo-v* |
2176 v Backspaced characters remain visible on the screen in | |
2177 Insert mode. Without this flag the characters are | |
2178 erased from the screen right away. With this flag the | |
2179 screen newly typed text overwrites backspaced | |
2180 characters. | |
2181 *cpo-w* | |
2182 w When using "cw" on a blank character, only change one | |
2183 character and not all blanks until the start of the | |
2184 next word. | |
2185 *cpo-W* | |
2186 W Don't overwrite a readonly file. When omitted, ":w!" | |
2187 overwrites a readonly file, if possible. | |
2188 *cpo-x* | |
2189 x <Esc> on the command-line executes the command-line. | |
2190 The default in Vim is to abandon the command-line, | |
2191 because <Esc> normally aborts a command. |c_<Esc>| | |
164 | 2192 *cpo-X* |
2193 X When using a count with "R" the replaced text is | |
2194 deleted only once. Also when repeating "R" with "." | |
2195 and a count. | |
7 | 2196 *cpo-y* |
15512 | 2197 y A yank command can be redone with ".". Think twice if |
2198 you really want to use this, it may break some | |
2199 plugins, since most people expect "." to only repeat a | |
2200 change. | |
164 | 2201 *cpo-Z* |
2202 Z When using "w!" while the 'readonly' option is set, | |
2203 don't reset 'readonly'. | |
7 | 2204 *cpo-!* |
2205 ! When redoing a filter command, use the last used | |
2206 external command, whatever it was. Otherwise the last | |
2207 used -filter- command is used. | |
2208 *cpo-$* | |
2209 $ When making a change to one line, don't redisplay the | |
2210 line, but put a '$' at the end of the changed text. | |
2211 The changed text will be overwritten when you type the | |
2212 new text. The line is redisplayed if you type any | |
2213 command that moves the cursor from the insertion | |
2214 point. | |
2215 *cpo-%* | |
2216 % Vi-compatible matching is done for the "%" command. | |
2217 Does not recognize "#if", "#endif", etc. | |
2218 Does not recognize "/*" and "*/". | |
2219 Parens inside single and double quotes are also | |
2220 counted, causing a string that contains a paren to | |
2221 disturb the matching. For example, in a line like | |
2222 "if (strcmp("foo(", s))" the first paren does not | |
2223 match the last one. When this flag is not included, | |
2224 parens inside single and double quotes are treated | |
2225 specially. When matching a paren outside of quotes, | |
2226 everything inside quotes is ignored. When matching a | |
2227 paren inside quotes, it will find the matching one (if | |
10 | 2228 there is one). This works very well for C programs. |
36 | 2229 This flag is also used for other features, such as |
2230 C-indenting. | |
161 | 2231 *cpo--* |
2232 - When included, a vertical movement command fails when | |
632 | 2233 it would go above the first line or below the last |
2234 line. Without it the cursor moves to the first or | |
2235 last line, unless it already was in that line. | |
161 | 2236 Applies to the commands "-", "k", CTRL-P, "+", "j", |
632 | 2237 CTRL-N, CTRL-J and ":1234". |
39 | 2238 *cpo-+* |
2239 + When included, a ":write file" command will reset the | |
2240 'modified' flag of the buffer, even though the buffer | |
2241 itself may still be different from its file. | |
856 | 2242 *cpo-star* |
7 | 2243 * Use ":*" in the same way as ":@". When not included, |
2244 ":*" is an alias for ":'<,'>", select the Visual area. | |
2245 *cpo-<* | |
2246 < Disable the recognition of special key codes in |<>| | |
2247 form in mappings, abbreviations, and the "to" part of | |
10 | 2248 menu commands. For example, the command |
7 | 2249 ":map X <Tab>" results in X being mapped to: |
2250 '<' included: "<Tab>" (5 characters) | |
2251 '<' excluded: "^I" (^I is a real <Tab>) | |
2252 Also see the 'k' flag above. | |
164 | 2253 *cpo->* |
2254 > When appending to a register, put a line break before | |
2255 the appended text. | |
2925 | 2256 *cpo-;* |
2257 ; When using |,| or |;| to repeat the last |t| search | |
2258 and the cursor is right in front of the searched | |
2259 character, the cursor won't move. When not included, | |
2260 the cursor would skip over it and jump to the | |
3557 | 2261 following occurrence. |
164 | 2262 |
2263 POSIX flags. These are not included in the Vi default value, except | |
2264 when $VIM_POSIX was set on startup. |posix| | |
2265 | |
2266 contains behavior ~ | |
856 | 2267 *cpo-#* |
164 | 2268 # A count before "D", "o" and "O" has no effect. |
168 | 2269 *cpo-&* |
2270 & When ":preserve" was used keep the swap file when | |
2271 exiting normally while this buffer is still loaded. | |
2272 This flag is tested when exiting. | |
2273 *cpo-\* | |
2274 \ Backslash in a [] range in a search pattern is taken | |
2275 literally, only "\]" is special See |/[]| | |
488 | 2276 '\' included: "/[ \-]" finds <Space>, '\' and '-' |
2277 '\' excluded: "/[ \-]" finds <Space> and '-' | |
2278 Also see |cpo-l|. | |
168 | 2279 *cpo-/* |
2280 / When "%" is used as the replacement string in a |:s| | |
2281 command, use the previous replacement string. |:s%| | |
164 | 2282 *cpo-{* |
2283 { The |{| and |}| commands also stop at a "{" character | |
2284 at the start of a line. | |
168 | 2285 *cpo-.* |
2286 . The ":chdir" and ":cd" commands fail if the current | |
2287 buffer is modified, unless ! is used. Vim doesn't | |
2288 need this, since it remembers the full path of an | |
2289 opened file. | |
164 | 2290 *cpo-bar* |
2291 | The value of the $LINES and $COLUMNS environment | |
2292 variables overrule the terminal size values obtained | |
2293 with system specific functions. | |
2294 | |
7 | 2295 |
2180
f60a0c9cbe6c
Add the blowfish encryption patch from Mohsin Ahmed. Needs more work.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2178
diff
changeset
|
2296 *'cryptmethod'* *'cm'* |
15192
690da0a83419
patch 8.1.0606: 'cryptmethod' defaults to a very old method
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15131
diff
changeset
|
2297 'cryptmethod' 'cm' string (default "blowfish2") |
2360
d8e4b27cef80
Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2350
diff
changeset
|
2298 global or local to buffer |global-local| |
2180
f60a0c9cbe6c
Add the blowfish encryption patch from Mohsin Ahmed. Needs more work.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2178
diff
changeset
|
2299 Method used for encryption when the buffer is written to a file: |
2184
5028c4d6d825
Fixed encryption big/little endian test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2180
diff
changeset
|
2300 *pkzip* |
2360
d8e4b27cef80
Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2350
diff
changeset
|
2301 zip PkZip compatible method. A weak kind of encryption. |
2204
c493d6bfde09
A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2184
diff
changeset
|
2302 Backwards compatible with Vim 7.2 and older. |
2184
5028c4d6d825
Fixed encryption big/little endian test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2180
diff
changeset
|
2303 *blowfish* |
6122 | 2304 blowfish Blowfish method. Medium strong encryption but it has |
2305 an implementation flaw. Requires Vim 7.3 or later, | |
2306 files can NOT be read by Vim 7.2 and older. This adds | |
2307 a "seed" to the file, every time you write the file | |
2308 the encrypted bytes will be different. | |
2309 *blowfish2* | |
2310 blowfish2 Blowfish method. Medium strong encryption. Requires | |
7876
93f747af7b58
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/5e9b2fa9bb0e6061cf18457c173cd141a5dc9c92
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7687
diff
changeset
|
2311 Vim 7.4.401 or later, files can NOT be read by Vim 7.3 |
6122 | 2312 and older. This adds a "seed" to the file, every time |
2313 you write the file the encrypted bytes will be | |
2314 different. The whole undo file is encrypted, not just | |
2315 the pieces of text. | |
2204
c493d6bfde09
A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2184
diff
changeset
|
2316 |
8748
b1a19a2f73f0
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/4f3f668c8486444e53163c29d2fc79bf47eb3c82
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8629
diff
changeset
|
2317 You should use "blowfish2", also to re-encrypt older files. |
b1a19a2f73f0
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/4f3f668c8486444e53163c29d2fc79bf47eb3c82
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8629
diff
changeset
|
2318 |
2180
f60a0c9cbe6c
Add the blowfish encryption patch from Mohsin Ahmed. Needs more work.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2178
diff
changeset
|
2319 When reading an encrypted file 'cryptmethod' will be set automatically |
2204
c493d6bfde09
A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2184
diff
changeset
|
2320 to the detected method of the file being read. Thus if you write it |
c493d6bfde09
A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2184
diff
changeset
|
2321 without changing 'cryptmethod' the same method will be used. |
c493d6bfde09
A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2184
diff
changeset
|
2322 Changing 'cryptmethod' does not mark the file as modified, you have to |
2360
d8e4b27cef80
Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2350
diff
changeset
|
2323 explicitly write it, you don't get a warning unless there are other |
d8e4b27cef80
Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2350
diff
changeset
|
2324 modifications. Also see |:X|. |
d8e4b27cef80
Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2350
diff
changeset
|
2325 |
d8e4b27cef80
Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2350
diff
changeset
|
2326 When setting the global value to an empty string, it will end up with |
15192
690da0a83419
patch 8.1.0606: 'cryptmethod' defaults to a very old method
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15131
diff
changeset
|
2327 the value "blowfish2". When setting the local value to an empty |
690da0a83419
patch 8.1.0606: 'cryptmethod' defaults to a very old method
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15131
diff
changeset
|
2328 string the buffer will use the global value. |
2360
d8e4b27cef80
Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2350
diff
changeset
|
2329 |
2204
c493d6bfde09
A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2184
diff
changeset
|
2330 When a new encryption method is added in a later version of Vim, and |
c493d6bfde09
A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2184
diff
changeset
|
2331 the current version does not recognize it, you will get *E821* . |
2360
d8e4b27cef80
Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2350
diff
changeset
|
2332 You need to edit this file with the later version of Vim. |
2180
f60a0c9cbe6c
Add the blowfish encryption patch from Mohsin Ahmed. Needs more work.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2178
diff
changeset
|
2333 |
f60a0c9cbe6c
Add the blowfish encryption patch from Mohsin Ahmed. Needs more work.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2178
diff
changeset
|
2334 |
7 | 2335 *'cscopepathcomp'* *'cspc'* |
2336 'cscopepathcomp' 'cspc' number (default 0) | |
2337 global | |
2338 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope| | |
2339 feature} | |
2340 Determines how many components of the path to show in a list of tags. | |
2341 See |cscopepathcomp|. | |
11160 | 2342 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set. |
7 | 2343 |
2344 *'cscopeprg'* *'csprg'* | |
2345 'cscopeprg' 'csprg' string (default "cscope") | |
2346 global | |
2347 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope| | |
2348 feature} | |
2349 Specifies the command to execute cscope. See |cscopeprg|. | |
2350 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
2351 security reasons. | |
2352 | |
2353 *'cscopequickfix'* *'csqf'* | |
2354 'cscopequickfix' 'csqf' string (default "") | |
2355 global | |
2356 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope| | |
2357 or |+quickfix| features} | |
2358 Specifies whether to use quickfix window to show cscope results. | |
2359 See |cscopequickfix|. | |
2360 | |
4869 | 2361 *'cscoperelative'* *'csre'* *'nocscoperelative'* *'nocsre'* |
2873 | 2362 'cscoperelative' 'csre' boolean (default off) |
2363 global | |
2364 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope| | |
2365 feature} | |
2366 In the absence of a prefix (-P) for cscope. setting this option enables | |
2367 to use the basename of cscope.out path as the prefix. | |
2368 See |cscoperelative|. | |
11160 | 2369 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
2873 | 2370 |
7 | 2371 *'cscopetag'* *'cst'* *'nocscopetag'* *'nocst'* |
2372 'cscopetag' 'cst' boolean (default off) | |
2373 global | |
2374 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope| | |
2375 feature} | |
2376 Use cscope for tag commands. See |cscope-options|. | |
2377 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
2378 | |
2379 *'cscopetagorder'* *'csto'* | |
2380 'cscopetagorder' 'csto' number (default 0) | |
2381 global | |
2382 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope| | |
2383 feature} | |
2384 Determines the order in which ":cstag" performs a search. See | |
2385 |cscopetagorder|. | |
2386 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set. | |
2387 | |
2388 *'cscopeverbose'* *'csverb'* | |
2389 *'nocscopeverbose'* *'nocsverb'* | |
2390 'cscopeverbose' 'csverb' boolean (default off) | |
2391 global | |
2392 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope| | |
2393 feature} | |
2394 Give messages when adding a cscope database. See |cscopeverbose|. | |
2395 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
2396 | |
2250
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2397 *'cursorbind'* *'crb'* *'nocursorbind'* *'nocrb'* |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2398 'cursorbind' 'crb' boolean (default off) |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2399 local to window |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2400 When this option is set, as the cursor in the current |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2401 window moves other cursorbound windows (windows that also have |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2402 this option set) move their cursors to the corresponding line and |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2403 column. This option is useful for viewing the |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2404 differences between two versions of a file (see 'diff'); in diff mode, |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2405 inserted and deleted lines (though not characters within a line) are |
2314
233eb4412f5d
Added 'colorcolumn' option. Partly by Gregor Uhlenheuer.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2302
diff
changeset
|
2406 taken into account. |
2250
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2407 |
743 | 2408 |
2409 *'cursorcolumn'* *'cuc'* *'nocursorcolumn'* *'nocuc'* | |
2410 'cursorcolumn' 'cuc' boolean (default off) | |
2411 local to window | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
2412 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| |
743 | 2413 feature} |
2414 Highlight the screen column of the cursor with CursorColumn | |
2415 |hl-CursorColumn|. Useful to align text. Will make screen redrawing | |
2416 slower. | |
826 | 2417 If you only want the highlighting in the current window you can use |
2418 these autocommands: > | |
2419 au WinLeave * set nocursorline nocursorcolumn | |
2420 au WinEnter * set cursorline cursorcolumn | |
2421 < | |
743 | 2422 |
2423 *'cursorline'* *'cul'* *'nocursorline'* *'nocul'* | |
2424 'cursorline' 'cul' boolean (default off) | |
2425 local to window | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
2426 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| |
743 | 2427 feature} |
2428 Highlight the screen line of the cursor with CursorLine | |
2429 |hl-CursorLine|. Useful to easily spot the cursor. Will make screen | |
2430 redrawing slower. | |
818 | 2431 When Visual mode is active the highlighting isn't used to make it |
825 | 2432 easier to see the selected text. |
743 | 2433 |
2434 | |
7 | 2435 *'debug'* |
2436 'debug' string (default "") | |
2437 global | |
839 | 2438 These values can be used: |
2439 msg Error messages that would otherwise be omitted will be given | |
2440 anyway. | |
2441 throw Error messages that would otherwise be omitted will be given | |
2442 anyway and also throw an exception and set |v:errmsg|. | |
2443 beep A message will be given when otherwise only a beep would be | |
2444 produced. | |
168 | 2445 The values can be combined, separated by a comma. |
839 | 2446 "msg" and "throw" are useful for debugging 'foldexpr', 'formatexpr' or |
2447 'indentexpr'. | |
7 | 2448 |
2449 *'define'* *'def'* | |
2450 'define' 'def' string (default "^\s*#\s*define") | |
2451 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
10 | 2452 Pattern to be used to find a macro definition. It is a search |
7 | 2453 pattern, just like for the "/" command. This option is used for the |
2454 commands like "[i" and "[d" |include-search|. The 'isident' option is | |
2455 used to recognize the defined name after the match: | |
2456 {match with 'define'}{non-ID chars}{defined name}{non-ID char} | |
2457 See |option-backslash| about inserting backslashes to include a space | |
2458 or backslash. | |
2459 The default value is for C programs. For C++ this value would be | |
2460 useful, to include const type declarations: > | |
2461 ^\(#\s*define\|[a-z]*\s*const\s*[a-z]*\) | |
16086 | 2462 < You can also use "\ze" just before the name and continue the pattern |
2463 to check what is following. E.g. for Javascript, if a function is | |
2464 defined with "func_name = function(args)": > | |
2465 ^\s*\ze\i\+\s*=\s*function( | |
2466 < If the function is defined with "func_name : function() {...": > | |
2467 ^\s*\ze\i\+\s*[:]\s*(*function\s*( | |
7 | 2468 < When using the ":set" command, you need to double the backslashes! |
16086 | 2469 To avoid that use `:let` with a single quote string: > |
2470 let &l:define = '^\s*\ze\k\+\s*=\s*function(' | |
16380 | 2471 < |
7 | 2472 |
2473 *'delcombine'* *'deco'* *'nodelcombine'* *'nodeco'* | |
2474 'delcombine' 'deco' boolean (default off) | |
2475 global | |
2476 If editing Unicode and this option is set, backspace and Normal mode | |
2477 "x" delete each combining character on its own. When it is off (the | |
2478 default) the character along with its combining characters are | |
2479 deleted. | |
2480 Note: When 'delcombine' is set "xx" may work different from "2x"! | |
2481 | |
2482 This is useful for Arabic, Hebrew and many other languages where one | |
2483 may have combining characters overtop of base characters, and want | |
2484 to remove only the combining ones. | |
11160 | 2485 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
7 | 2486 |
2487 *'dictionary'* *'dict'* | |
2488 'dictionary' 'dict' string (default "") | |
2489 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
2490 List of file names, separated by commas, that are used to lookup words | |
2491 for keyword completion commands |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-K|. Each file should | |
2492 contain a list of words. This can be one word per line, or several | |
2493 words per line, separated by non-keyword characters (white space is | |
2494 preferred). Maximum line length is 510 bytes. | |
13950
741b1feeac9f
patch 8.0.1845: various comment updates needed, missing white space
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13818
diff
changeset
|
2495 |
741b1feeac9f
patch 8.0.1845: various comment updates needed, missing white space
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13818
diff
changeset
|
2496 When this option is empty or an entry "spell" is present, and spell |
741b1feeac9f
patch 8.0.1845: various comment updates needed, missing white space
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13818
diff
changeset
|
2497 checking is enabled, words in the word lists for the currently active |
741b1feeac9f
patch 8.0.1845: various comment updates needed, missing white space
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13818
diff
changeset
|
2498 'spelllang' are used. See |spell|. |
741b1feeac9f
patch 8.0.1845: various comment updates needed, missing white space
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13818
diff
changeset
|
2499 |
10 | 2500 To include a comma in a file name precede it with a backslash. Spaces |
7 | 2501 after a comma are ignored, otherwise spaces are included in the file |
2502 name. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes. | |
99 | 2503 This has nothing to do with the |Dictionary| variable type. |
7 | 2504 Where to find a list of words? |
2505 - On FreeBSD, there is the file "/usr/share/dict/words". | |
2506 - In the Simtel archive, look in the "msdos/linguist" directory. | |
2507 - In "miscfiles" of the GNU collection. | |
2508 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing | |
2509 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version | |
2510 uses another default. | |
2511 Backticks cannot be used in this option for security reasons. | |
2512 | |
2513 *'diff'* *'nodiff'* | |
2514 'diff' boolean (default off) | |
2515 local to window | |
2516 {not available when compiled without the |+diff| | |
2517 feature} | |
2518 Join the current window in the group of windows that shows differences | |
10 | 2519 between files. See |vimdiff|. |
7 | 2520 |
2521 *'dex'* *'diffexpr'* | |
2522 'diffexpr' 'dex' string (default "") | |
2523 global | |
2524 {not available when compiled without the |+diff| | |
2525 feature} | |
14696
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2526 Expression which is evaluated to obtain a diff file (either ed-style |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2527 or unified-style) from two versions of a file. See |diff-diffexpr|. |
7 | 2528 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
2529 security reasons. | |
2530 | |
2531 *'dip'* *'diffopt'* | |
14702
daf8afe6279b
patch 8.1.0363: internal diff isn't used by default as advertised
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14696
diff
changeset
|
2532 'diffopt' 'dip' string (default "internal,filler") |
7 | 2533 global |
2534 {not available when compiled without the |+diff| | |
2535 feature} | |
10 | 2536 Option settings for diff mode. It can consist of the following items. |
7 | 2537 All are optional. Items must be separated by a comma. |
2538 | |
2539 filler Show filler lines, to keep the text | |
2540 synchronized with a window that has inserted | |
2541 lines at the same position. Mostly useful | |
2542 when windows are side-by-side and 'scrollbind' | |
2543 is set. | |
2544 | |
2545 context:{n} Use a context of {n} lines between a change | |
2546 and a fold that contains unchanged lines. | |
2547 When omitted a context of six lines is used. | |
15932 | 2548 When using zero the context is actually one, |
2549 since folds require a line in between, also | |
2550 for a deleted line. | |
7 | 2551 See |fold-diff|. |
2552 | |
14864 | 2553 iblank Ignore changes where lines are all blank. Adds |
2554 the "-B" flag to the "diff" command if | |
2555 'diffexpr' is empty. Check the documentation | |
2556 of the "diff" command for what this does | |
2557 exactly. | |
2558 NOTE: the diff windows will get out of sync, | |
2559 because no differences between blank lines are | |
2560 taken into account. | |
2561 | |
7 | 2562 icase Ignore changes in case of text. "a" and "A" |
2563 are considered the same. Adds the "-i" flag | |
2564 to the "diff" command if 'diffexpr' is empty. | |
2565 | |
2566 iwhite Ignore changes in amount of white space. Adds | |
2567 the "-b" flag to the "diff" command if | |
2568 'diffexpr' is empty. Check the documentation | |
2569 of the "diff" command for what this does | |
2570 exactly. It should ignore adding trailing | |
2571 white space, but not leading white space. | |
2572 | |
14864 | 2573 iwhiteall Ignore all white space changes. Adds |
2574 the "-w" flag to the "diff" command if | |
2575 'diffexpr' is empty. Check the documentation | |
2576 of the "diff" command for what this does | |
2577 exactly. | |
2578 | |
2579 iwhiteeol Ignore white space changes at end of line. | |
2580 Adds the "-Z" flag to the "diff" command if | |
2581 'diffexpr' is empty. Check the documentation | |
2582 of the "diff" command for what this does | |
2583 exactly. | |
2584 | |
766 | 2585 horizontal Start diff mode with horizontal splits (unless |
2586 explicitly specified otherwise). | |
2587 | |
2588 vertical Start diff mode with vertical splits (unless | |
2589 explicitly specified otherwise). | |
2590 | |
12971
ca3cb1997f08
patch 8.0.1361: some users don't want to diff with hidden buffers
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12968
diff
changeset
|
2591 hiddenoff Do not use diff mode for a buffer when it |
ca3cb1997f08
patch 8.0.1361: some users don't want to diff with hidden buffers
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12968
diff
changeset
|
2592 becomes hidden. |
ca3cb1997f08
patch 8.0.1361: some users don't want to diff with hidden buffers
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12968
diff
changeset
|
2593 |
766 | 2594 foldcolumn:{n} Set the 'foldcolumn' option to {n} when |
2595 starting diff mode. Without this 2 is used. | |
2596 | |
14696
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2597 internal Use the internal diff library. This is |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2598 ignored when 'diffexpr' is set. *E960* |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2599 When running out of memory when writing a |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2600 buffer this item will be ignored for diffs |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2601 involving that buffer. Set the 'verbose' |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2602 option to see when this happens. |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2603 |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2604 indent-heuristic |
15033 | 2605 Use the indent heuristic for the internal |
2606 diff library. | |
14696
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2607 |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2608 algorithm:{text} Use the specified diff algorithm with the |
15033 | 2609 internal diff engine. Currently supported |
14696
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2610 algorithms are: |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2611 myers the default algorithm |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2612 minimal spend extra time to generate the |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2613 smallest possible diff |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2614 patience patience diff algorithm |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2615 histogram histogram diff algorithm |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2616 |
7 | 2617 Examples: > |
14696
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2618 :set diffopt=internal,filler,context:4 |
7 | 2619 :set diffopt= |
14696
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2620 :set diffopt=internal,filler,foldcolumn:3 |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2621 :set diffopt-=internal " do NOT use the internal diff parser |
7 | 2622 < |
2623 *'digraph'* *'dg'* *'nodigraph'* *'nodg'* | |
2624 'digraph' 'dg' boolean (default off) | |
2625 global | |
2626 {not available when compiled without the |+digraphs| | |
2627 feature} | |
2628 Enable the entering of digraphs in Insert mode with {char1} <BS> | |
2629 {char2}. See |digraphs|. | |
2630 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
2631 | |
2632 *'directory'* *'dir'* | |
2633 'directory' 'dir' string (default for Amiga: ".,t:", | |
5555 | 2634 for MS-DOS and Win32: ".,$TEMP,c:\tmp,c:\temp" |
7 | 2635 for Unix: ".,~/tmp,/var/tmp,/tmp") |
2636 global | |
2637 List of directory names for the swap file, separated with commas. | |
2638 - The swap file will be created in the first directory where this is | |
2639 possible. | |
2640 - Empty means that no swap file will be used (recovery is | |
2641 impossible!). | |
2642 - A directory "." means to put the swap file in the same directory as | |
2643 the edited file. On Unix, a dot is prepended to the file name, so | |
2644 it doesn't show in a directory listing. On MS-Windows the "hidden" | |
2645 attribute is set and a dot prepended if possible. | |
33 | 2646 - A directory starting with "./" (or ".\" for MS-DOS et al.) means to |
7 | 2647 put the swap file relative to where the edited file is. The leading |
2648 "." is replaced with the path name of the edited file. | |
14475
dddba3937532
patch 8.1.0251: using full path is not supported for 'backupdir'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14421
diff
changeset
|
2649 - For Unix and Win32, if a directory ends in two path separators "//", |
dddba3937532
patch 8.1.0251: using full path is not supported for 'backupdir'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14421
diff
changeset
|
2650 the swap file name will be built from the complete path to the file |
dddba3937532
patch 8.1.0251: using full path is not supported for 'backupdir'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14421
diff
changeset
|
2651 with all path separators substituted to percent '%' signs. This will |
dddba3937532
patch 8.1.0251: using full path is not supported for 'backupdir'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14421
diff
changeset
|
2652 ensure file name uniqueness in the preserve directory. |
dddba3937532
patch 8.1.0251: using full path is not supported for 'backupdir'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14421
diff
changeset
|
2653 On Win32, it is also possible to end with "\\". However, When a |
dddba3937532
patch 8.1.0251: using full path is not supported for 'backupdir'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14421
diff
changeset
|
2654 separating comma is following, you must use "//", since "\\" will |
dddba3937532
patch 8.1.0251: using full path is not supported for 'backupdir'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14421
diff
changeset
|
2655 include the comma in the file name. Therefore it is recommended to |
dddba3937532
patch 8.1.0251: using full path is not supported for 'backupdir'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14421
diff
changeset
|
2656 use '//', instead of '\\'. |
7 | 2657 - Spaces after the comma are ignored, other spaces are considered part |
2658 of the directory name. To have a space at the start of a directory | |
2659 name, precede it with a backslash. | |
2660 - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with a backslash. | |
2661 - A directory name may end in an ':' or '/'. | |
2662 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. | |
2663 - Careful with '\' characters, type one before a space, type two to | |
2664 get one in the option (see |option-backslash|), for example: > | |
2665 :set dir=c:\\tmp,\ dir\\,with\\,commas,\\\ dir\ with\ spaces | |
2666 < - For backwards compatibility with Vim version 3.0 a '>' at the start | |
2667 of the option is removed. | |
2668 Using "." first in the list is recommended. This means that editing | |
2669 the same file twice will result in a warning. Using "/tmp" on Unix is | |
2670 discouraged: When the system crashes you lose the swap file. | |
2671 "/var/tmp" is often not cleared when rebooting, thus is a better | |
2672 choice than "/tmp". But it can contain a lot of files, your swap | |
2673 files get lost in the crowd. That is why a "tmp" directory in your | |
2674 home directory is tried first. | |
2675 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing | |
2676 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version | |
2677 uses another default. | |
2678 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
2679 security reasons. | |
2680 {Vi: directory to put temp file in, defaults to "/tmp"} | |
2681 | |
2682 *'display'* *'dy'* | |
9737
35ce559b8553
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/bc8801c9317eb721a2ee91322669f2dd5d136380
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9669
diff
changeset
|
2683 'display' 'dy' string (default "", set to "truncate" in |
35ce559b8553
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/bc8801c9317eb721a2ee91322669f2dd5d136380
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9669
diff
changeset
|
2684 |defaults.vim|) |
7 | 2685 global |
2686 Change the way text is displayed. This is comma separated list of | |
2687 flags: | |
2688 lastline When included, as much as possible of the last line | |
9665
b193bdb6ea25
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ad9c2a08f0509294269a2f11a59a438b944bdd5a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9533
diff
changeset
|
2689 in a window will be displayed. "@@@" is put in the |
b193bdb6ea25
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ad9c2a08f0509294269a2f11a59a438b944bdd5a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9533
diff
changeset
|
2690 last columns of the last screen line to indicate the |
b193bdb6ea25
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ad9c2a08f0509294269a2f11a59a438b944bdd5a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9533
diff
changeset
|
2691 rest of the line is not displayed. |
b193bdb6ea25
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ad9c2a08f0509294269a2f11a59a438b944bdd5a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9533
diff
changeset
|
2692 truncate Like "lastline", but "@@@" is displayed in the first |
b193bdb6ea25
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ad9c2a08f0509294269a2f11a59a438b944bdd5a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9533
diff
changeset
|
2693 column of the last screen line. Overrules "lastline". |
7 | 2694 uhex Show unprintable characters hexadecimal as <xx> |
2695 instead of using ^C and ~C. | |
2696 | |
10211
b7da8d4c594c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d07969093a9b3051511c478d71c36de6fc33c0d6
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10198
diff
changeset
|
2697 When neither "lastline" nor "truncate" is included, a last line that |
9665
b193bdb6ea25
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ad9c2a08f0509294269a2f11a59a438b944bdd5a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9533
diff
changeset
|
2698 doesn't fit is replaced with "@" lines. |
b193bdb6ea25
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ad9c2a08f0509294269a2f11a59a438b944bdd5a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9533
diff
changeset
|
2699 |
7 | 2700 *'eadirection'* *'ead'* |
2701 'eadirection' 'ead' string (default "both") | |
2702 global | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
2703 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit| |
7 | 2704 feature} |
2705 Tells when the 'equalalways' option applies: | |
2706 ver vertically, width of windows is not affected | |
2707 hor horizontally, height of windows is not affected | |
2708 both width and height of windows is affected | |
2709 | |
2710 *'ed'* *'edcompatible'* *'noed'* *'noedcompatible'* | |
2711 'edcompatible' 'ed' boolean (default off) | |
2712 global | |
2713 Makes the 'g' and 'c' flags of the ":substitute" command to be | |
2714 toggled each time the flag is given. See |complex-change|. See | |
2715 also 'gdefault' option. | |
11442 | 2716 Switching this option on may break plugins! |
7 | 2717 |
8876
47f17f66da3d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/03413f44167c4b5cd0012def9bb331e2518c83cf
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8835
diff
changeset
|
2718 *'emoji'* *'emo'* *'noemoji'* *'noemo'* |
8629
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
2719 'emoji' 'emo' boolean (default: on) |
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
2720 global |
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
2721 When on all Unicode emoji characters are considered to be full width. |
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
2722 |
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
2723 |
7 | 2724 *'encoding'* *'enc'* *E543* |
2725 'encoding' 'enc' string (default: "latin1" or value from $LANG) | |
2726 global | |
2727 Sets the character encoding used inside Vim. It applies to text in | |
2728 the buffers, registers, Strings in expressions, text stored in the | |
2729 viminfo file, etc. It sets the kind of characters which Vim can work | |
2730 with. See |encoding-names| for the possible values. | |
2731 | |
2732 NOTE: Changing this option will not change the encoding of the | |
39 | 2733 existing text in Vim. It may cause non-ASCII text to become invalid. |
7 | 2734 It should normally be kept at its default value, or set when Vim |
1152 | 2735 starts up. See |multibyte|. To reload the menus see |:menutrans|. |
7 | 2736 |
2317
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2737 This option cannot be set from a |modeline|. It would most likely |
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2738 corrupt the text. |
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2739 |
10895
c391bfbdb452
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10734
diff
changeset
|
2740 NOTE: For GTK+ 2 or later, it is highly recommended to set 'encoding' |
c391bfbdb452
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10734
diff
changeset
|
2741 to "utf-8". Although care has been taken to allow different values of |
7 | 2742 'encoding', "utf-8" is the natural choice for the environment and |
2743 avoids unnecessary conversion overhead. "utf-8" has not been made | |
10 | 2744 the default to prevent different behavior of the GUI and terminal |
7 | 2745 versions, and to avoid changing the encoding of newly created files |
2746 without your knowledge (in case 'fileencodings' is empty). | |
2747 | |
2748 The character encoding of files can be different from 'encoding'. | |
10 | 2749 This is specified with 'fileencoding'. The conversion is done with |
7 | 2750 iconv() or as specified with 'charconvert'. |
2751 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2752 If you need to know whether 'encoding' is a multi-byte encoding, you |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2753 can use: > |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2754 if has("multi_byte_encoding") |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2755 < |
7 | 2756 Normally 'encoding' will be equal to your current locale. This will |
2757 be the default if Vim recognizes your environment settings. If | |
2758 'encoding' is not set to the current locale, 'termencoding' must be | |
2759 set to convert typed and displayed text. See |encoding-table|. | |
2760 | |
2761 When you set this option, it fires the |EncodingChanged| autocommand | |
2762 event so that you can set up fonts if necessary. | |
2763 | |
2764 When the option is set, the value is converted to lowercase. Thus | |
2765 you can set it with uppercase values too. Underscores are translated | |
2766 to '-' signs. | |
2767 When the encoding is recognized, it is changed to the standard name. | |
2768 For example "Latin-1" becomes "latin1", "ISO_88592" becomes | |
2769 "iso-8859-2" and "utf8" becomes "utf-8". | |
2770 | |
2771 Note: "latin1" is also used when the encoding could not be detected. | |
2772 This only works when editing files in the same encoding! When the | |
2773 actual character set is not latin1, make sure 'fileencoding' and | |
2774 'fileencodings' are empty. When conversion is needed, switch to using | |
2775 utf-8. | |
2776 | |
2777 When "unicode", "ucs-2" or "ucs-4" is used, Vim internally uses utf-8. | |
2778 You don't notice this while editing, but it does matter for the | |
2779 |viminfo-file|. And Vim expects the terminal to use utf-8 too. Thus | |
2780 setting 'encoding' to one of these values instead of utf-8 only has | |
2781 effect for encoding used for files when 'fileencoding' is empty. | |
448 | 2782 |
2783 When 'encoding' is set to a Unicode encoding, and 'fileencodings' was | |
2784 not set yet, the default for 'fileencodings' is changed. | |
7 | 2785 |
2786 *'endofline'* *'eol'* *'noendofline'* *'noeol'* | |
2787 'endofline' 'eol' boolean (default on) | |
2788 local to buffer | |
2789 When writing a file and this option is off and the 'binary' option | |
6933 | 2790 is on, or 'fixeol' option is off, no <EOL> will be written for the |
2791 last line in the file. This option is automatically set or reset when | |
2792 starting to edit a new file, depending on whether file has an <EOL> | |
2793 for the last line in the file. Normally you don't have to set or | |
2794 reset this option. | |
2795 When 'binary' is off and 'fixeol' is on the value is not used when | |
2796 writing the file. When 'binary' is on or 'fixeol' is off it is used | |
2797 to remember the presence of a <EOL> for the last line in the file, so | |
2798 that when you write the file the situation from the original file can | |
2799 be kept. But you can change it if you want to. | |
7 | 2800 |
2801 *'equalalways'* *'ea'* *'noequalalways'* *'noea'* | |
2802 'equalalways' 'ea' boolean (default on) | |
2803 global | |
2804 When on, all the windows are automatically made the same size after | |
33 | 2805 splitting or closing a window. This also happens the moment the |
2806 option is switched on. When off, splitting a window will reduce the | |
2807 size of the current window and leave the other windows the same. When | |
2808 closing a window the extra lines are given to the window next to it | |
2809 (depending on 'splitbelow' and 'splitright'). | |
7 | 2810 When mixing vertically and horizontally split windows, a minimal size |
2811 is computed and some windows may be larger if there is room. The | |
2812 'eadirection' option tells in which direction the size is affected. | |
1354 | 2813 Changing the height and width of a window can be avoided by setting |
2814 'winfixheight' and 'winfixwidth', respectively. | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2815 If a window size is specified when creating a new window sizes are |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2816 currently not equalized (it's complicated, but may be implemented in |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2817 the future). |
7 | 2818 |
2819 *'equalprg'* *'ep'* | |
2820 'equalprg' 'ep' string (default "") | |
2821 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
2822 External program to use for "=" command. When this option is empty | |
1621 | 2823 the internal formatting functions are used; either 'lisp', 'cindent' |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2824 or 'indentexpr'. When Vim was compiled without internal formatting, |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2825 the "indent" program is used. |
10 | 2826 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See |option-backslash| |
7 | 2827 about including spaces and backslashes. |
2828 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
2829 security reasons. | |
2830 | |
2831 *'errorbells'* *'eb'* *'noerrorbells'* *'noeb'* | |
2832 'errorbells' 'eb' boolean (default off) | |
2833 global | |
2834 Ring the bell (beep or screen flash) for error messages. This only | |
2835 makes a difference for error messages, the bell will be used always | |
2836 for a lot of errors without a message (e.g., hitting <Esc> in Normal | |
10 | 2837 mode). See 'visualbell' on how to make the bell behave like a beep, |
6949 | 2838 screen flash or do nothing. See 'belloff' to finetune when to ring the |
2839 bell. | |
7 | 2840 |
2841 *'errorfile'* *'ef'* | |
2842 'errorfile' 'ef' string (Amiga default: "AztecC.Err", | |
2843 others: "errors.err") | |
2844 global | |
2845 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix| | |
2846 feature} | |
2847 Name of the errorfile for the QuickFix mode (see |:cf|). | |
2848 When the "-q" command-line argument is used, 'errorfile' is set to the | |
2849 following argument. See |-q|. | |
2850 NOT used for the ":make" command. See 'makeef' for that. | |
2851 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. | |
2852 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes. | |
2853 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
2854 security reasons. | |
2855 | |
2856 *'errorformat'* *'efm'* | |
2857 'errorformat' 'efm' string (default is very long) | |
2858 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
2859 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix| | |
2860 feature} | |
2861 Scanf-like description of the format for the lines in the error file | |
2862 (see |errorformat|). | |
2863 | |
2864 *'esckeys'* *'ek'* *'noesckeys'* *'noek'* | |
2865 'esckeys' 'ek' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off) | |
2866 global | |
2867 Function keys that start with an <Esc> are recognized in Insert | |
2868 mode. When this option is off, the cursor and function keys cannot be | |
2869 used in Insert mode if they start with an <Esc>. The advantage of | |
2870 this is that the single <Esc> is recognized immediately, instead of | |
2871 after one second. Instead of resetting this option, you might want to | |
2872 try changing the values for 'timeoutlen' and 'ttimeoutlen'. Note that | |
2873 when 'esckeys' is off, you can still map anything, but the cursor keys | |
2874 won't work by default. | |
2875 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is | |
2876 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
2877 | |
2878 *'eventignore'* *'ei'* | |
2879 'eventignore' 'ei' string (default "") | |
2880 global | |
2881 A list of autocommand event names, which are to be ignored. | |
844 | 2882 When set to "all" or when "all" is one of the items, all autocommand |
2883 events are ignored, autocommands will not be executed. | |
7 | 2884 Otherwise this is a comma separated list of event names. Example: > |
2885 :set ei=WinEnter,WinLeave | |
2886 < | |
2887 *'expandtab'* *'et'* *'noexpandtab'* *'noet'* | |
2888 'expandtab' 'et' boolean (default off) | |
2889 local to buffer | |
2890 In Insert mode: Use the appropriate number of spaces to insert a | |
10 | 2891 <Tab>. Spaces are used in indents with the '>' and '<' commands and |
7 | 2892 when 'autoindent' is on. To insert a real tab when 'expandtab' is |
2893 on, use CTRL-V<Tab>. See also |:retab| and |ins-expandtab|. | |
7147
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
2894 This option is reset when the 'paste' option is set and restored when |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
2895 the 'paste' option is reset. |
7 | 2896 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
2897 | |
2898 *'exrc'* *'ex'* *'noexrc'* *'noex'* | |
2899 'exrc' 'ex' boolean (default off) | |
2900 global | |
2901 Enables the reading of .vimrc, .exrc and .gvimrc in the current | |
10027
018fead968c1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/36f44c21da2e912c008683a0c4447fca2a071e9a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9975
diff
changeset
|
2902 directory. |
018fead968c1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/36f44c21da2e912c008683a0c4447fca2a071e9a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9975
diff
changeset
|
2903 |
018fead968c1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/36f44c21da2e912c008683a0c4447fca2a071e9a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9975
diff
changeset
|
2904 Setting this option is a potential security leak. E.g., consider |
018fead968c1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/36f44c21da2e912c008683a0c4447fca2a071e9a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9975
diff
changeset
|
2905 unpacking a package or fetching files from github, a .vimrc in there |
018fead968c1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/36f44c21da2e912c008683a0c4447fca2a071e9a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9975
diff
changeset
|
2906 might be a trojan horse. BETTER NOT SET THIS OPTION! |
018fead968c1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/36f44c21da2e912c008683a0c4447fca2a071e9a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9975
diff
changeset
|
2907 Instead, define an autocommand in your .vimrc to set options for a |
018fead968c1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/36f44c21da2e912c008683a0c4447fca2a071e9a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9975
diff
changeset
|
2908 matching directory. |
018fead968c1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/36f44c21da2e912c008683a0c4447fca2a071e9a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9975
diff
changeset
|
2909 |
018fead968c1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/36f44c21da2e912c008683a0c4447fca2a071e9a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9975
diff
changeset
|
2910 If you do switch this option on you should also consider setting the |
018fead968c1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/36f44c21da2e912c008683a0c4447fca2a071e9a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9975
diff
changeset
|
2911 'secure' option (see |initialization|). |
018fead968c1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/36f44c21da2e912c008683a0c4447fca2a071e9a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9975
diff
changeset
|
2912 Also see |.vimrc| and |gui-init|. |
7 | 2913 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
2914 security reasons. | |
2915 | |
2916 *'fileencoding'* *'fenc'* *E213* | |
2917 'fileencoding' 'fenc' string (default: "") | |
2918 local to buffer | |
2919 Sets the character encoding for the file of this buffer. | |
2317
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2920 |
7 | 2921 When 'fileencoding' is different from 'encoding', conversion will be |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2922 done when writing the file. For reading see below. |
7 | 2923 When 'fileencoding' is empty, the same value as 'encoding' will be |
2924 used (no conversion when reading or writing a file). | |
11062 | 2925 No error will be given when the value is set, only when it is used, |
2926 only when writing a file. | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2927 Conversion will also be done when 'encoding' and 'fileencoding' are |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2928 both a Unicode encoding and 'fileencoding' is not utf-8. That's |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2929 because internally Unicode is always stored as utf-8. |
7 | 2930 WARNING: Conversion can cause loss of information! When |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2931 'encoding' is "utf-8" or another Unicode encoding, conversion |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2932 is most likely done in a way that the reverse conversion |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2933 results in the same text. When 'encoding' is not "utf-8" some |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2934 characters may be lost! |
2317
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2935 |
7 | 2936 See 'encoding' for the possible values. Additionally, values may be |
2937 specified that can be handled by the converter, see | |
2938 |mbyte-conversion|. | |
2317
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2939 |
7 | 2940 When reading a file 'fileencoding' will be set from 'fileencodings'. |
2941 To read a file in a certain encoding it won't work by setting | |
1152 | 2942 'fileencoding', use the |++enc| argument. One exception: when |
2943 'fileencodings' is empty the value of 'fileencoding' is used. | |
692 | 2944 For a new file the global value of 'fileencoding' is used. |
2317
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2945 |
7 | 2946 Prepending "8bit-" and "2byte-" has no meaning here, they are ignored. |
2947 When the option is set, the value is converted to lowercase. Thus | |
2948 you can set it with uppercase values too. '_' characters are | |
2949 replaced with '-'. If a name is recognized from the list for | |
2950 'encoding', it is replaced by the standard name. For example | |
2951 "ISO8859-2" becomes "iso-8859-2". | |
2317
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2952 |
7 | 2953 When this option is set, after starting to edit a file, the 'modified' |
2954 option is set, because the file would be different when written. | |
2317
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2955 |
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2956 Keep in mind that changing 'fenc' from a modeline happens |
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2957 AFTER the text has been read, thus it applies to when the file will be |
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2958 written. If you do set 'fenc' in a modeline, you might want to set |
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2959 'nomodified' to avoid not being able to ":q". |
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2960 |
7 | 2961 This option can not be changed when 'modifiable' is off. |
2962 | |
2963 *'fe'* | |
2964 NOTE: Before version 6.0 this option specified the encoding for the | |
10 | 2965 whole of Vim, this was a mistake. Now use 'encoding' instead. The |
7 | 2966 old short name was 'fe', which is no longer used. |
2967 | |
2968 *'fileencodings'* *'fencs'* | |
39 | 2969 'fileencodings' 'fencs' string (default: "ucs-bom", |
2970 "ucs-bom,utf-8,default,latin1" when | |
2971 'encoding' is set to a Unicode value) | |
7 | 2972 global |
2973 This is a list of character encodings considered when starting to edit | |
2974 an existing file. When a file is read, Vim tries to use the first | |
2975 mentioned character encoding. If an error is detected, the next one | |
2976 in the list is tried. When an encoding is found that works, | |
10 | 2977 'fileencoding' is set to it. If all fail, 'fileencoding' is set to |
7 | 2978 an empty string, which means the value of 'encoding' is used. |
2979 WARNING: Conversion can cause loss of information! When | |
2980 'encoding' is "utf-8" (or one of the other Unicode variants) | |
2981 conversion is most likely done in a way that the reverse | |
2982 conversion results in the same text. When 'encoding' is not | |
596 | 2983 "utf-8" some non-ASCII characters may be lost! You can use |
2984 the |++bad| argument to specify what is done with characters | |
2985 that can't be converted. | |
7 | 2986 For an empty file or a file with only ASCII characters most encodings |
2987 will work and the first entry of 'fileencodings' will be used (except | |
2988 "ucs-bom", which requires the BOM to be present). If you prefer | |
2989 another encoding use an BufReadPost autocommand event to test if your | |
2990 preferred encoding is to be used. Example: > | |
2991 au BufReadPost * if search('\S', 'w') == 0 | | |
2992 \ set fenc=iso-2022-jp | endif | |
2993 < This sets 'fileencoding' to "iso-2022-jp" if the file does not contain | |
2994 non-blank characters. | |
596 | 2995 When the |++enc| argument is used then the value of 'fileencodings' is |
2996 not used. | |
692 | 2997 Note that 'fileencodings' is not used for a new file, the global value |
2998 of 'fileencoding' is used instead. You can set it with: > | |
2999 :setglobal fenc=iso-8859-2 | |
3000 < This means that a non-existing file may get a different encoding than | |
3001 an empty file. | |
7 | 3002 The special value "ucs-bom" can be used to check for a Unicode BOM |
3003 (Byte Order Mark) at the start of the file. It must not be preceded | |
3004 by "utf-8" or another Unicode encoding for this to work properly. | |
3005 An entry for an 8-bit encoding (e.g., "latin1") should be the last, | |
3006 because Vim cannot detect an error, thus the encoding is always | |
3007 accepted. | |
39 | 3008 The special value "default" can be used for the encoding from the |
3009 environment. This is the default value for 'encoding'. It is useful | |
3010 when 'encoding' is set to "utf-8" and your environment uses a | |
3011 non-latin1 encoding, such as Russian. | |
777 | 3012 When 'encoding' is "utf-8" and a file contains an illegal byte |
3013 sequence it won't be recognized as UTF-8. You can use the |8g8| | |
3014 command to find the illegal byte sequence. | |
7 | 3015 WRONG VALUES: WHAT'S WRONG: |
3016 latin1,utf-8 "latin1" will always be used | |
3017 utf-8,ucs-bom,latin1 BOM won't be recognized in an utf-8 | |
3018 file | |
3019 cp1250,latin1 "cp1250" will always be used | |
3020 If 'fileencodings' is empty, 'fileencoding' is not modified. | |
3021 See 'fileencoding' for the possible values. | |
3022 Setting this option does not have an effect until the next time a file | |
3023 is read. | |
3024 | |
3025 *'fileformat'* *'ff'* | |
15840
734b1928a5aa
patch 8.1.0927: USE_CR is never defined
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15804
diff
changeset
|
3026 'fileformat' 'ff' string (MS-Windows default: "dos", |
734b1928a5aa
patch 8.1.0927: USE_CR is never defined
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15804
diff
changeset
|
3027 Unix, macOS default: "unix") |
7 | 3028 local to buffer |
3029 This gives the <EOL> of the current buffer, which is used for | |
3030 reading/writing the buffer from/to a file: | |
3031 dos <CR> <NL> | |
3032 unix <NL> | |
3033 mac <CR> | |
3034 When "dos" is used, CTRL-Z at the end of a file is ignored. | |
3035 See |file-formats| and |file-read|. | |
3036 For the character encoding of the file see 'fileencoding'. | |
3037 When 'binary' is set, the value of 'fileformat' is ignored, file I/O | |
4264 | 3038 works like it was set to "unix". |
7 | 3039 This option is set automatically when starting to edit a file and |
3040 'fileformats' is not empty and 'binary' is off. | |
3041 When this option is set, after starting to edit a file, the 'modified' | |
3042 option is set, because the file would be different when written. | |
3043 This option can not be changed when 'modifiable' is off. | |
3044 For backwards compatibility: When this option is set to "dos", | |
3045 'textmode' is set, otherwise 'textmode' is reset. | |
3046 | |
3047 *'fileformats'* *'ffs'* | |
3048 'fileformats' 'ffs' string (default: | |
15840
734b1928a5aa
patch 8.1.0927: USE_CR is never defined
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15804
diff
changeset
|
3049 Vim+Vi MS-Windows: "dos,unix", |
734b1928a5aa
patch 8.1.0927: USE_CR is never defined
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15804
diff
changeset
|
3050 Vim Unix, macOS: "unix,dos", |
7 | 3051 Vi Cygwin: "unix,dos", |
3052 Vi others: "") | |
3053 global | |
3054 This gives the end-of-line (<EOL>) formats that will be tried when | |
3055 starting to edit a new buffer and when reading a file into an existing | |
3056 buffer: | |
3057 - When empty, the format defined with 'fileformat' will be used | |
3058 always. It is not set automatically. | |
3059 - When set to one name, that format will be used whenever a new buffer | |
10 | 3060 is opened. 'fileformat' is set accordingly for that buffer. The |
7 | 3061 'fileformats' name will be used when a file is read into an existing |
3062 buffer, no matter what 'fileformat' for that buffer is set to. | |
3063 - When more than one name is present, separated by commas, automatic | |
3064 <EOL> detection will be done when reading a file. When starting to | |
3065 edit a file, a check is done for the <EOL>: | |
3066 1. If all lines end in <CR><NL>, and 'fileformats' includes "dos", | |
3067 'fileformat' is set to "dos". | |
3068 2. If a <NL> is found and 'fileformats' includes "unix", 'fileformat' | |
10 | 3069 is set to "unix". Note that when a <NL> is found without a |
7 | 3070 preceding <CR>, "unix" is preferred over "dos". |
6647 | 3071 3. If 'fileformat' has not yet been set, and if a <CR> is found, and |
3072 if 'fileformats' includes "mac", 'fileformat' is set to "mac". | |
2587 | 3073 This means that "mac" is only chosen when: |
3074 "unix" is not present or no <NL> is found in the file, and | |
3075 "dos" is not present or no <CR><NL> is found in the file. | |
3076 Except: if "unix" was chosen, but there is a <CR> before | |
3077 the first <NL>, and there appear to be more <CR>s than <NL>s in | |
2642 | 3078 the first few lines, "mac" is used. |
7 | 3079 4. If 'fileformat' is still not set, the first name from |
3080 'fileformats' is used. | |
3081 When reading a file into an existing buffer, the same is done, but | |
3082 this happens like 'fileformat' has been set appropriately for that | |
3083 file only, the option is not changed. | |
3084 When 'binary' is set, the value of 'fileformats' is not used. | |
3085 | |
8748
b1a19a2f73f0
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/4f3f668c8486444e53163c29d2fc79bf47eb3c82
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8629
diff
changeset
|
3086 When Vim starts up with an empty buffer the first item is used. You |
b1a19a2f73f0
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/4f3f668c8486444e53163c29d2fc79bf47eb3c82
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8629
diff
changeset
|
3087 can overrule this by setting 'fileformat' in your .vimrc. |
2662 | 3088 |
7 | 3089 For systems with a Dos-like <EOL> (<CR><NL>), when reading files that |
3090 are ":source"ed and for vimrc files, automatic <EOL> detection may be | |
3091 done: | |
3092 - When 'fileformats' is empty, there is no automatic detection. Dos | |
3093 format will be used. | |
3094 - When 'fileformats' is set to one or more names, automatic detection | |
3095 is done. This is based on the first <NL> in the file: If there is a | |
3096 <CR> in front of it, Dos format is used, otherwise Unix format is | |
3097 used. | |
3098 Also see |file-formats|. | |
3099 For backwards compatibility: When this option is set to an empty | |
3100 string or one format (no comma is included), 'textauto' is reset, | |
3101 otherwise 'textauto' is set. | |
3102 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is | |
3103 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
3104 | |
4264 | 3105 *'fileignorecase'* *'fic'* *'nofileignorecase'* *'nofic'* |
3106 'fileignorecase' 'fic' boolean (default on for systems where case in file | |
3107 names is normally ignored) | |
4242 | 3108 global |
3109 When set case is ignored when using file names and directories. | |
3110 See 'wildignorecase' for only ignoring case when doing completion. | |
3111 | |
7 | 3112 *'filetype'* *'ft'* |
3113 'filetype' 'ft' string (default: "") | |
3114 local to buffer | |
3115 When this option is set, the FileType autocommand event is triggered. | |
3116 All autocommands that match with the value of this option will be | |
3117 executed. Thus the value of 'filetype' is used in place of the file | |
3118 name. | |
3119 Otherwise this option does not always reflect the current file type. | |
3120 This option is normally set when the file type is detected. To enable | |
3121 this use the ":filetype on" command. |:filetype| | |
3122 Setting this option to a different value is most useful in a modeline, | |
3123 for a file for which the file type is not automatically recognized. | |
782 | 3124 Example, for in an IDL file: |
3125 /* vim: set filetype=idl : */ ~ | |
3126 |FileType| |filetypes| | |
3127 When a dot appears in the value then this separates two filetype | |
3128 names. Example: | |
3129 /* vim: set filetype=c.doxygen : */ ~ | |
3130 This will use the "c" filetype first, then the "doxygen" filetype. | |
3131 This works both for filetype plugins and for syntax files. More than | |
3132 one dot may appear. | |
7 | 3133 This option is not copied to another buffer, independent of the 's' or |
3134 'S' flag in 'cpoptions'. | |
36 | 3135 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal. |
7 | 3136 |
3137 *'fillchars'* *'fcs'* | |
3138 'fillchars' 'fcs' string (default "vert:|,fold:-") | |
3139 global | |
3140 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| | |
3141 and |+folding| features} | |
3142 Characters to fill the statuslines and vertical separators. | |
3143 It is a comma separated list of items: | |
3144 | |
3145 item default Used for ~ | |
3146 stl:c ' ' or '^' statusline of the current window | |
8061
abd64cf67bcf
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/38a55639d603823efcf2d2fdf542dbffdeb60b75
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7876
diff
changeset
|
3147 stlnc:c ' ' or '=' statusline of the non-current windows |
7 | 3148 vert:c '|' vertical separators |:vsplit| |
3149 fold:c '-' filling 'foldtext' | |
3150 diff:c '-' deleted lines of the 'diff' option | |
3151 | |
10 | 3152 Any one that is omitted will fall back to the default. For "stl" and |
8061
abd64cf67bcf
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/38a55639d603823efcf2d2fdf542dbffdeb60b75
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7876
diff
changeset
|
3153 "stlnc" the space will be used when there is highlighting, '^' or '=' |
7 | 3154 otherwise. |
3155 | |
3156 Example: > | |
8061
abd64cf67bcf
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/38a55639d603823efcf2d2fdf542dbffdeb60b75
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7876
diff
changeset
|
3157 :set fillchars=stl:^,stlnc:=,vert:\|,fold:-,diff:- |
7 | 3158 < This is similar to the default, except that these characters will also |
3159 be used when there is highlighting. | |
3160 | |
819 | 3161 for "stl" and "stlnc" only single-byte values are supported. |
3162 | |
7 | 3163 The highlighting used for these items: |
3164 item highlight group ~ | |
3165 stl:c StatusLine |hl-StatusLine| | |
3166 stlnc:c StatusLineNC |hl-StatusLineNC| | |
3167 vert:c VertSplit |hl-VertSplit| | |
3168 fold:c Folded |hl-Folded| | |
3169 diff:c DiffDelete |hl-DiffDelete| | |
3170 | |
6933 | 3171 *'fixendofline'* *'fixeol'* *'nofixendofline'* *'nofixeol'* |
3172 'fixendofline' 'fixeol' boolean (default on) | |
3173 local to buffer | |
3174 When writing a file and this option is on, <EOL> at the end of file | |
3175 will be restored if missing. Turn this option off if you want to | |
3176 preserve the situation from the original file. | |
3177 When the 'binary' option is set the value of this option doesn't | |
3178 matter. | |
3179 See the 'endofline' option. | |
3180 | |
7 | 3181 *'fkmap'* *'fk'* *'nofkmap'* *'nofk'* |
3182 'fkmap' 'fk' boolean (default off) *E198* | |
3183 global | |
3184 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft| | |
3185 feature} | |
15850
a6ca8cf07a98
patch 8.1.0932: Farsi support is outdated and unused
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15840
diff
changeset
|
3186 This option was for using Farsi, which has been removed. See |
a6ca8cf07a98
patch 8.1.0932: Farsi support is outdated and unused
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15840
diff
changeset
|
3187 |farsi.txt|. |
7 | 3188 |
3189 *'foldclose'* *'fcl'* | |
3190 'foldclose' 'fcl' string (default "") | |
3191 global | |
3192 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3193 feature} | |
3194 When set to "all", a fold is closed when the cursor isn't in it and | |
3195 its level is higher than 'foldlevel'. Useful if you want folds to | |
3196 automatically close when moving out of them. | |
3197 | |
3198 *'foldcolumn'* *'fdc'* | |
3199 'foldcolumn' 'fdc' number (default 0) | |
3200 local to window | |
3201 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3202 feature} | |
3203 When non-zero, a column with the specified width is shown at the side | |
3204 of the window which indicates open and closed folds. The maximum | |
3205 value is 12. | |
3206 See |folding|. | |
3207 | |
3208 *'foldenable'* *'fen'* *'nofoldenable'* *'nofen'* | |
3209 'foldenable' 'fen' boolean (default on) | |
3210 local to window | |
3211 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3212 feature} | |
3213 When off, all folds are open. This option can be used to quickly | |
3214 switch between showing all text unfolded and viewing the text with | |
3215 folds (including manually opened or closed folds). It can be toggled | |
10 | 3216 with the |zi| command. The 'foldcolumn' will remain blank when |
7 | 3217 'foldenable' is off. |
3218 This option is set by commands that create a new fold or close a fold. | |
3219 See |folding|. | |
3220 | |
3221 *'foldexpr'* *'fde'* | |
3222 'foldexpr' 'fde' string (default: "0") | |
3223 local to window | |
3224 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
3225 or |+eval| features} |
7 | 3226 The expression used for when 'foldmethod' is "expr". It is evaluated |
634 | 3227 for each line to obtain its fold level. See |fold-expr|. |
782 | 3228 |
3682 | 3229 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| if set from a |
3230 modeline, see |sandbox-option|. | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
3231 This option can't be set from a |modeline| when the 'diff' option is |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
3232 on. |
634 | 3233 |
3234 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while | |
3235 evaluating 'foldexpr' |textlock|. | |
7 | 3236 |
3237 *'foldignore'* *'fdi'* | |
3238 'foldignore' 'fdi' string (default: "#") | |
3239 local to window | |
3240 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3241 feature} | |
3242 Used only when 'foldmethod' is "indent". Lines starting with | |
3243 characters in 'foldignore' will get their fold level from surrounding | |
10 | 3244 lines. White space is skipped before checking for this character. |
7 | 3245 The default "#" works well for C programs. See |fold-indent|. |
3246 | |
3247 *'foldlevel'* *'fdl'* | |
3248 'foldlevel' 'fdl' number (default: 0) | |
3249 local to window | |
3250 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3251 feature} | |
3252 Sets the fold level: Folds with a higher level will be closed. | |
3253 Setting this option to zero will close all folds. Higher numbers will | |
3254 close fewer folds. | |
3255 This option is set by commands like |zm|, |zM| and |zR|. | |
3256 See |fold-foldlevel|. | |
3257 | |
3258 *'foldlevelstart'* *'fdls'* | |
3259 'foldlevelstart' 'fdls' number (default: -1) | |
3260 global | |
3261 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3262 feature} | |
3263 Sets 'foldlevel' when starting to edit another buffer in a window. | |
3264 Useful to always start editing with all folds closed (value zero), | |
3265 some folds closed (one) or no folds closed (99). | |
3266 This is done before reading any modeline, thus a setting in a modeline | |
10 | 3267 overrules this option. Starting to edit a file for |diff-mode| also |
7 | 3268 ignores this option and closes all folds. |
3269 It is also done before BufReadPre autocommands, to allow an autocmd to | |
3270 overrule the 'foldlevel' value for specific files. | |
3271 When the value is negative, it is not used. | |
3272 | |
3273 *'foldmarker'* *'fmr'* *E536* | |
3274 'foldmarker' 'fmr' string (default: "{{{,}}}") | |
3275 local to window | |
3276 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3277 feature} | |
3278 The start and end marker used when 'foldmethod' is "marker". There | |
3279 must be one comma, which separates the start and end marker. The | |
3280 marker is a literal string (a regular expression would be too slow). | |
3281 See |fold-marker|. | |
3282 | |
3283 *'foldmethod'* *'fdm'* | |
3284 'foldmethod' 'fdm' string (default: "manual") | |
3285 local to window | |
3286 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3287 feature} | |
3288 The kind of folding used for the current window. Possible values: | |
3289 |fold-manual| manual Folds are created manually. | |
3290 |fold-indent| indent Lines with equal indent form a fold. | |
3291 |fold-expr| expr 'foldexpr' gives the fold level of a line. | |
3292 |fold-marker| marker Markers are used to specify folds. | |
3293 |fold-syntax| syntax Syntax highlighting items specify folds. | |
3294 |fold-diff| diff Fold text that is not changed. | |
3295 | |
3296 *'foldminlines'* *'fml'* | |
3297 'foldminlines' 'fml' number (default: 1) | |
3298 local to window | |
3299 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3300 feature} | |
2709 | 3301 Sets the number of screen lines above which a fold can be displayed |
3302 closed. Also for manually closed folds. With the default value of | |
3303 one a fold can only be closed if it takes up two or more screen lines. | |
3304 Set to zero to be able to close folds of just one screen line. | |
2826 | 3305 Note that this only has an effect on what is displayed. After using |
7 | 3306 "zc" to close a fold, which is displayed open because it's smaller |
3307 than 'foldminlines', a following "zc" may close a containing fold. | |
3308 | |
3309 *'foldnestmax'* *'fdn'* | |
3310 'foldnestmax' 'fdn' number (default: 20) | |
3311 local to window | |
3312 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3313 feature} | |
3314 Sets the maximum nesting of folds for the "indent" and "syntax" | |
3315 methods. This avoids that too many folds will be created. Using more | |
3316 than 20 doesn't work, because the internal limit is 20. | |
3317 | |
3318 *'foldopen'* *'fdo'* | |
3319 'foldopen' 'fdo' string (default: "block,hor,mark,percent,quickfix, | |
3320 search,tag,undo") | |
3321 global | |
3322 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3323 feature} | |
3324 Specifies for which type of commands folds will be opened, if the | |
3325 command moves the cursor into a closed fold. It is a comma separated | |
3326 list of items. | |
2625 | 3327 NOTE: When the command is part of a mapping this option is not used. |
3328 Add the |zv| command to the mapping to get the same effect. | |
3329 (rationale: the mapping may want to control opening folds itself) | |
3330 | |
7 | 3331 item commands ~ |
3332 all any | |
3333 block "(", "{", "[[", "[{", etc. | |
3334 hor horizontal movements: "l", "w", "fx", etc. | |
3335 insert any command in Insert mode | |
3336 jump far jumps: "G", "gg", etc. | |
3337 mark jumping to a mark: "'m", CTRL-O, etc. | |
3338 percent "%" | |
3339 quickfix ":cn", ":crew", ":make", etc. | |
3340 search search for a pattern: "/", "n", "*", "gd", etc. | |
3341 (not for a search pattern in a ":" command) | |
819 | 3342 Also for |[s| and |]s|. |
7 | 3343 tag jumping to a tag: ":ta", CTRL-T, etc. |
3344 undo undo or redo: "u" and CTRL-R | |
3345 When a movement command is used for an operator (e.g., "dl" or "y%") | |
3346 this option is not used. This means the operator will include the | |
3347 whole closed fold. | |
3348 Note that vertical movements are not here, because it would make it | |
3349 very difficult to move onto a closed fold. | |
3350 In insert mode the folds containing the cursor will always be open | |
3351 when text is inserted. | |
3352 To close folds you can re-apply 'foldlevel' with the |zx| command or | |
3353 set the 'foldclose' option to "all". | |
3354 | |
3355 *'foldtext'* *'fdt'* | |
3356 'foldtext' 'fdt' string (default: "foldtext()") | |
3357 local to window | |
3358 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3359 feature} | |
3360 An expression which is used to specify the text displayed for a closed | |
3361 fold. See |fold-foldtext|. | |
3362 | |
3682 | 3363 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| if set from a |
3364 modeline, see |sandbox-option|. | |
634 | 3365 |
3366 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while | |
3367 evaluating 'foldtext' |textlock|. | |
3368 | |
9286
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3369 *'formatexpr'* *'fex'* |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3370 'formatexpr' 'fex' string (default "") |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3371 local to buffer |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3372 {not available when compiled without the |+eval| |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3373 feature} |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3374 Expression which is evaluated to format a range of lines for the |gq| |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3375 operator or automatic formatting (see 'formatoptions'). When this |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3376 option is empty 'formatprg' is used. |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3377 |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3378 The |v:lnum| variable holds the first line to be formatted. |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3379 The |v:count| variable holds the number of lines to be formatted. |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3380 The |v:char| variable holds the character that is going to be |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3381 inserted if the expression is being evaluated due to |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3382 automatic formatting. This can be empty. Don't insert |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3383 it yet! |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3384 |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3385 Example: > |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3386 :set formatexpr=mylang#Format() |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3387 < This will invoke the mylang#Format() function in the |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3388 autoload/mylang.vim file in 'runtimepath'. |autoload| |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3389 |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3390 The expression is also evaluated when 'textwidth' is set and adding |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3391 text beyond that limit. This happens under the same conditions as |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3392 when internal formatting is used. Make sure the cursor is kept in the |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3393 same spot relative to the text then! The |mode()| function will |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3394 return "i" or "R" in this situation. |
13341
acd7eaa13d2b
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13314
diff
changeset
|
3395 |
9286
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3396 When the expression evaluates to non-zero Vim will fall back to using |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3397 the internal format mechanism. |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3398 |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3399 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3400 modeline, see |sandbox-option|. That stops the option from working, |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3401 since changing the buffer text is not allowed. |
11160 | 3402 NOTE: This option is set to "" when 'compatible' is set. |
9286
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3403 |
41 | 3404 *'formatlistpat'* *'flp'* |
3405 'formatlistpat' 'flp' string (default: "^\s*\d\+[\]:.)}\t ]\s*") | |
3406 local to buffer | |
3407 A pattern that is used to recognize a list header. This is used for | |
3408 the "n" flag in 'formatoptions'. | |
3409 The pattern must match exactly the text that will be the indent for | |
140 | 3410 the line below it. You can use |/\ze| to mark the end of the match |
41 | 3411 while still checking more characters. There must be a character |
3412 following the pattern, when it matches the whole line it is handled | |
3413 like there is no match. | |
3414 The default recognizes a number, followed by an optional punctuation | |
3415 character and white space. | |
3416 | |
16443
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
3417 *'formatoptions'* *'fo'* |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
3418 'formatoptions' 'fo' string (Vim default: "tcq", Vi default: "vt") |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
3419 local to buffer |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
3420 This is a sequence of letters which describes how automatic |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
3421 formatting is to be done. See |fo-table|. When the 'paste' option is |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
3422 on, no formatting is done (like 'formatoptions' is empty). Commas can |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
3423 be inserted for readability. |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
3424 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
3425 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|. |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
3426 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
3427 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
3428 |
7 | 3429 *'formatprg'* *'fp'* |
3430 'formatprg' 'fp' string (default "") | |
10579
688b97124d23
patch 8.0.0179: cannot have a local value for 'formatprg'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10498
diff
changeset
|
3431 global or local to buffer |global-local| |
7 | 3432 The name of an external program that will be used to format the lines |
667 | 3433 selected with the |gq| operator. The program must take the input on |
7 | 3434 stdin and produce the output on stdout. The Unix program "fmt" is |
557 | 3435 such a program. |
667 | 3436 If the 'formatexpr' option is not empty it will be used instead. |
3437 Otherwise, if 'formatprg' option is an empty string, the internal | |
3438 format function will be used |C-indenting|. | |
557 | 3439 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See |option-backslash| |
3440 about including spaces and backslashes. | |
3682 | 3441 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
3442 security reasons. | |
667 | 3443 |
7196
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
3444 *'fsync'* *'fs'* *'nofsync'* *'nofs'* |
36 | 3445 'fsync' 'fs' boolean (default on) |
3446 global | |
3447 When on, the library function fsync() will be called after writing a | |
3448 file. This will flush a file to disk, ensuring that it is safely | |
3449 written even on filesystems which do metadata-only journaling. This | |
3450 will force the harddrive to spin up on Linux systems running in laptop | |
3451 mode, so it may be undesirable in some situations. Be warned that | |
3452 turning this off increases the chances of data loss after a crash. On | |
3453 systems without an fsync() implementation, this variable is always | |
3454 off. | |
3455 Also see 'swapsync' for controlling fsync() on swap files. | |
12865
ebb4f6c93598
patch 8.0.1309: cannot use 'balloonexpr' in a terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12826
diff
changeset
|
3456 'fsync' also applies to |writefile()|, unless a flag is used to |
ebb4f6c93598
patch 8.0.1309: cannot use 'balloonexpr' in a terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12826
diff
changeset
|
3457 overrule it. |
36 | 3458 |
7 | 3459 *'gdefault'* *'gd'* *'nogdefault'* *'nogd'* |
3460 'gdefault' 'gd' boolean (default off) | |
3461 global | |
3462 When on, the ":substitute" flag 'g' is default on. This means that | |
3463 all matches in a line are substituted instead of one. When a 'g' flag | |
3464 is given to a ":substitute" command, this will toggle the substitution | |
3465 of all or one match. See |complex-change|. | |
3466 | |
3467 command 'gdefault' on 'gdefault' off ~ | |
3468 :s/// subst. all subst. one | |
3469 :s///g subst. one subst. all | |
3470 :s///gg subst. all subst. one | |
3471 | |
3472 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
11516
80491a71c716
patch 8.0.0641: cannot set a separate highlighting for the quickfix line
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11473
diff
changeset
|
3473 DEPRECATED: Setting this option may break plugins that are not aware |
80491a71c716
patch 8.0.0641: cannot set a separate highlighting for the quickfix line
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11473
diff
changeset
|
3474 of this option. Also, many users get confused that adding the /g flag |
80491a71c716
patch 8.0.0641: cannot set a separate highlighting for the quickfix line
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11473
diff
changeset
|
3475 has the opposite effect of that it normally does. |
7 | 3476 |
3477 *'grepformat'* *'gfm'* | |
6213 | 3478 'grepformat' 'gfm' string (default "%f:%l:%m,%f:%l%m,%f %l%m") |
7 | 3479 global |
3480 Format to recognize for the ":grep" command output. | |
3481 This is a scanf-like string that uses the same format as the | |
3482 'errorformat' option: see |errorformat|. | |
3483 | |
3484 *'grepprg'* *'gp'* | |
3485 'grepprg' 'gp' string (default "grep -n ", | |
3486 Unix: "grep -n $* /dev/null", | |
3487 Win32: "findstr /n" or "grep -n", | |
3488 VMS: "SEARCH/NUMBERS ") | |
3489 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
233 | 3490 Program to use for the |:grep| command. This option may contain '%' |
7 | 3491 and '#' characters, which are expanded like when used in a command- |
3492 line. The placeholder "$*" is allowed to specify where the arguments | |
3493 will be included. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See | |
3494 |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes. | |
3495 When your "grep" accepts the "-H" argument, use this to make ":grep" | |
3496 also work well with a single file: > | |
3497 :set grepprg=grep\ -nH | |
161 | 3498 < Special value: When 'grepprg' is set to "internal" the |:grep| command |
657 | 3499 works like |:vimgrep|, |:lgrep| like |:lvimgrep|, |:grepadd| like |
3500 |:vimgrepadd| and |:lgrepadd| like |:lvimgrepadd|. | |
41 | 3501 See also the section |:make_makeprg|, since most of the comments there |
7 | 3502 apply equally to 'grepprg'. |
3503 For Win32, the default is "findstr /n" if "findstr.exe" can be found, | |
3504 otherwise it's "grep -n". | |
3505 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
3506 security reasons. | |
3507 | |
3508 *'guicursor'* *'gcr'* *E545* *E546* *E548* *E549* | |
3509 'guicursor' 'gcr' string (default "n-v-c:block-Cursor/lCursor, | |
3510 ve:ver35-Cursor, | |
3511 o:hor50-Cursor, | |
3512 i-ci:ver25-Cursor/lCursor, | |
3513 r-cr:hor20-Cursor/lCursor, | |
3514 sm:block-Cursor | |
3515 -blinkwait175-blinkoff150-blinkon175", | |
3516 for MS-DOS and Win32 console: | |
3517 "n-v-c:block,o:hor50,i-ci:hor15, | |
3518 r-cr:hor30,sm:block") | |
3519 global | |
3520 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled, and | |
3521 for MS-DOS and Win32 console} | |
3522 This option tells Vim what the cursor should look like in different | |
10 | 3523 modes. It fully works in the GUI. In an MSDOS or Win32 console, only |
7 | 3524 the height of the cursor can be changed. This can be done by |
3525 specifying a block cursor, or a percentage for a vertical or | |
3526 horizontal cursor. | |
6727 | 3527 For a console the 't_SI', 't_SR', and 't_EI' escape sequences are |
3528 used. | |
7 | 3529 |
10 | 3530 The option is a comma separated list of parts. Each part consist of a |
7 | 3531 mode-list and an argument-list: |
3532 mode-list:argument-list,mode-list:argument-list,.. | |
3533 The mode-list is a dash separated list of these modes: | |
3534 n Normal mode | |
3535 v Visual mode | |
3536 ve Visual mode with 'selection' "exclusive" (same as 'v', | |
3537 if not specified) | |
3538 o Operator-pending mode | |
3539 i Insert mode | |
3540 r Replace mode | |
3541 c Command-line Normal (append) mode | |
3542 ci Command-line Insert mode | |
3543 cr Command-line Replace mode | |
3544 sm showmatch in Insert mode | |
3545 a all modes | |
3546 The argument-list is a dash separated list of these arguments: | |
3547 hor{N} horizontal bar, {N} percent of the character height | |
3548 ver{N} vertical bar, {N} percent of the character width | |
3549 block block cursor, fills the whole character | |
3550 [only one of the above three should be present] | |
3551 blinkwait{N} *cursor-blinking* | |
3552 blinkon{N} | |
3553 blinkoff{N} | |
3554 blink times for cursor: blinkwait is the delay before | |
3555 the cursor starts blinking, blinkon is the time that | |
3556 the cursor is shown and blinkoff is the time that the | |
3557 cursor is not shown. The times are in msec. When one | |
3558 of the numbers is zero, there is no blinking. The | |
3559 default is: "blinkwait700-blinkon400-blinkoff250". | |
3560 These numbers are used for a missing entry. This | |
3561 means that blinking is enabled by default. To switch | |
3562 blinking off you can use "blinkon0". The cursor only | |
3563 blinks when Vim is waiting for input, not while | |
3564 executing a command. | |
3565 To make the cursor blink in an xterm, see | |
3566 |xterm-blink|. | |
3567 {group-name} | |
3568 a highlight group name, that sets the color and font | |
3569 for the cursor | |
3570 {group-name}/{group-name} | |
3571 Two highlight group names, the first is used when | |
3572 no language mappings are used, the other when they | |
3573 are. |language-mapping| | |
3574 | |
3575 Examples of parts: | |
3576 n-c-v:block-nCursor in Normal, Command-line and Visual mode, use a | |
3577 block cursor with colors from the "nCursor" | |
3578 highlight group | |
3579 i-ci:ver30-iCursor-blinkwait300-blinkon200-blinkoff150 | |
3580 In Insert and Command-line Insert mode, use a | |
3581 30% vertical bar cursor with colors from the | |
3582 "iCursor" highlight group. Blink a bit | |
3583 faster. | |
3584 | |
3585 The 'a' mode is different. It will set the given argument-list for | |
3586 all modes. It does not reset anything to defaults. This can be used | |
3587 to do a common setting for all modes. For example, to switch off | |
3588 blinking: "a:blinkon0" | |
3589 | |
3590 Examples of cursor highlighting: > | |
3591 :highlight Cursor gui=reverse guifg=NONE guibg=NONE | |
3592 :highlight Cursor gui=NONE guifg=bg guibg=fg | |
3593 < | |
3594 *'guifont'* *'gfn'* | |
2908 | 3595 *E235* *E596* |
7 | 3596 'guifont' 'gfn' string (default "") |
3597 global | |
3598 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled} | |
3599 This is a list of fonts which will be used for the GUI version of Vim. | |
16439
9d20e26dc13c
patch 8.1.1224: MS-Windows: cannot specify font weight
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16427
diff
changeset
|
3600 In its simplest form the value is just one font name. |
9d20e26dc13c
patch 8.1.1224: MS-Windows: cannot specify font weight
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16427
diff
changeset
|
3601 See |gui-font| for the details. |
7 | 3602 |
3603 *'guifontset'* *'gfs'* | |
3604 *E250* *E252* *E234* *E597* *E598* | |
3605 'guifontset' 'gfs' string (default "") | |
3606 global | |
3607 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled and | |
3608 with the |+xfontset| feature} | |
10895
c391bfbdb452
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10734
diff
changeset
|
3609 {not available in the GTK+ GUI} |
7 | 3610 When not empty, specifies two (or more) fonts to be used. The first |
3611 one for normal English, the second one for your special language. See | |
3612 |xfontset|. | |
16439
9d20e26dc13c
patch 8.1.1224: MS-Windows: cannot specify font weight
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16427
diff
changeset
|
3613 |
7 | 3614 *'guifontwide'* *'gfw'* *E231* *E533* *E534* |
3615 'guifontwide' 'gfw' string (default "") | |
3616 global | |
3617 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled} | |
3618 When not empty, specifies a comma-separated list of fonts to be used | |
3619 for double-width characters. The first font that can be loaded is | |
16439
9d20e26dc13c
patch 8.1.1224: MS-Windows: cannot specify font weight
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16427
diff
changeset
|
3620 used. See |gui-fontwide|. |
4055 | 3621 |
7 | 3622 *'guiheadroom'* *'ghr'* |
3623 'guiheadroom' 'ghr' number (default 50) | |
3624 global | |
16443
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
3625 - {only for GTK and X11 GUI} |
7 | 3626 The number of pixels subtracted from the screen height when fitting |
3627 the GUI window on the screen. Set this before the GUI is started, | |
3628 e.g., in your |gvimrc| file. When zero, the whole screen height will | |
10 | 3629 be used by the window. When positive, the specified number of pixel |
7 | 3630 lines will be left for window decorations and other items on the |
3631 screen. Set it to a negative value to allow windows taller than the | |
3632 screen. | |
3633 | |
3634 *'guioptions'* *'go'* | |
14945 | 3635 'guioptions' 'go' string (default "egmrLtT" (MS-Windows, |
3636 "t" is removed in |defaults.vim|), | |
9669
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
3637 "aegimrLtT" (GTK, Motif and Athena), |
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
3638 ) |
7 | 3639 global |
3640 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled} | |
8 | 3641 This option only has an effect in the GUI version of Vim. It is a |
7 | 3642 sequence of letters which describes what components and options of the |
3643 GUI should be used. | |
3644 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the | |
3645 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|. | |
3646 | |
13470
6faef782f50b
patch 8.0.1609: shell commands in the GUI use a dumb terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13437
diff
changeset
|
3647 Valid characters are as follows: |
6faef782f50b
patch 8.0.1609: shell commands in the GUI use a dumb terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13437
diff
changeset
|
3648 *'go-!'* |
6faef782f50b
patch 8.0.1609: shell commands in the GUI use a dumb terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13437
diff
changeset
|
3649 '!' External commands are executed in a terminal window. Without |
6faef782f50b
patch 8.0.1609: shell commands in the GUI use a dumb terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13437
diff
changeset
|
3650 this flag the MS-Windows GUI will open a console window to |
6faef782f50b
patch 8.0.1609: shell commands in the GUI use a dumb terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13437
diff
changeset
|
3651 execute the command. The Unix GUI will simulate a dumb |
6faef782f50b
patch 8.0.1609: shell commands in the GUI use a dumb terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13437
diff
changeset
|
3652 terminal to list the command output. |
6faef782f50b
patch 8.0.1609: shell commands in the GUI use a dumb terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13437
diff
changeset
|
3653 The terminal window will be positioned at the bottom, and grow |
6faef782f50b
patch 8.0.1609: shell commands in the GUI use a dumb terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13437
diff
changeset
|
3654 upwards as needed. |
14999 | 3655 *'go-a'* |
7 | 3656 'a' Autoselect: If present, then whenever VISUAL mode is started, |
3657 or the Visual area extended, Vim tries to become the owner of | |
3658 the windowing system's global selection. This means that the | |
3659 Visually highlighted text is available for pasting into other | |
3660 applications as well as into Vim itself. When the Visual mode | |
3661 ends, possibly due to an operation on the text, or when an | |
3662 application wants to paste the selection, the highlighted text | |
3663 is automatically yanked into the "* selection register. | |
3664 Thus the selection is still available for pasting into other | |
3665 applications after the VISUAL mode has ended. | |
3666 If not present, then Vim won't become the owner of the | |
3667 windowing system's global selection unless explicitly told to | |
3668 by a yank or delete operation for the "* register. | |
3669 The same applies to the modeless selection. | |
3674 | 3670 *'go-P'* |
3671 'P' Like autoselect but using the "+ register instead of the "* | |
8629
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
3672 register. |
1152 | 3673 *'go-A'* |
10 | 3674 'A' Autoselect for the modeless selection. Like 'a', but only |
7 | 3675 applies to the modeless selection. |
3676 | |
3677 'guioptions' autoselect Visual autoselect modeless ~ | |
3678 "" - - | |
3679 "a" yes yes | |
3680 "A" - yes | |
3681 "aA" yes yes | |
3682 | |
1152 | 3683 *'go-c'* |
7 | 3684 'c' Use console dialogs instead of popup dialogs for simple |
3685 choices. | |
1152 | 3686 *'go-e'* |
697 | 3687 'e' Add tab pages when indicated with 'showtabline'. |
688 | 3688 'guitablabel' can be used to change the text in the labels. |
3689 When 'e' is missing a non-GUI tab pages line may be used. | |
857 | 3690 The GUI tabs are only supported on some systems, currently |
1621 | 3691 GTK, Motif, Mac OS/X and MS-Windows. |
1152 | 3692 *'go-f'* |
7 | 3693 'f' Foreground: Don't use fork() to detach the GUI from the shell |
3694 where it was started. Use this for programs that wait for the | |
3695 editor to finish (e.g., an e-mail program). Alternatively you | |
3696 can use "gvim -f" or ":gui -f" to start the GUI in the | |
3697 foreground. |gui-fork| | |
3698 Note: Set this option in the vimrc file. The forking may have | |
819 | 3699 happened already when the |gvimrc| file is read. |
1152 | 3700 *'go-i'* |
7 | 3701 'i' Use a Vim icon. For GTK with KDE it is used in the left-upper |
3702 corner of the window. It's black&white on non-GTK, because of | |
3703 limitations of X11. For a color icon, see |X11-icon|. | |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
3704 *'go-m'* |
7 | 3705 'm' Menu bar is present. |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
3706 *'go-M'* |
10 | 3707 'M' The system menu "$VIMRUNTIME/menu.vim" is not sourced. Note |
7 | 3708 that this flag must be added in the .vimrc file, before |
819 | 3709 switching on syntax or filetype recognition (when the |gvimrc| |
7 | 3710 file is sourced the system menu has already been loaded; the |
12756
3b26420fc639
Long overdue runtime update.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12744
diff
changeset
|
3711 `:syntax on` and `:filetype on` commands load the menu too). |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
3712 *'go-g'* |
7 | 3713 'g' Grey menu items: Make menu items that are not active grey. If |
3714 'g' is not included inactive menu items are not shown at all. | |
3715 Exception: Athena will always use grey menu items. | |
1152 | 3716 *'go-t'* |
7 | 3717 't' Include tearoff menu items. Currently only works for Win32, |
3718 GTK+, and Motif 1.2 GUI. | |
1152 | 3719 *'go-T'* |
236 | 3720 'T' Include Toolbar. Currently only in Win32, GTK+, Motif, Photon |
856 | 3721 and Athena GUIs. |
1152 | 3722 *'go-r'* |
7 | 3723 'r' Right-hand scrollbar is always present. |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
3724 *'go-R'* |
7 | 3725 'R' Right-hand scrollbar is present when there is a vertically |
3726 split window. | |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
3727 *'go-l'* |
7 | 3728 'l' Left-hand scrollbar is always present. |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
3729 *'go-L'* |
7 | 3730 'L' Left-hand scrollbar is present when there is a vertically |
3731 split window. | |
1152 | 3732 *'go-b'* |
7 | 3733 'b' Bottom (horizontal) scrollbar is present. Its size depends on |
3734 the longest visible line, or on the cursor line if the 'h' | |
3735 flag is included. |gui-horiz-scroll| | |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
3736 *'go-h'* |
7 | 3737 'h' Limit horizontal scrollbar size to the length of the cursor |
3738 line. Reduces computations. |gui-horiz-scroll| | |
3739 | |
3740 And yes, you may even have scrollbars on the left AND the right if | |
3741 you really want to :-). See |gui-scrollbars| for more information. | |
3742 | |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
3743 *'go-v'* |
7 | 3744 'v' Use a vertical button layout for dialogs. When not included, |
3745 a horizontal layout is preferred, but when it doesn't fit a | |
3746 vertical layout is used anyway. | |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
3747 *'go-p'* |
7 | 3748 'p' Use Pointer callbacks for X11 GUI. This is required for some |
3749 window managers. If the cursor is not blinking or hollow at | |
3750 the right moment, try adding this flag. This must be done | |
819 | 3751 before starting the GUI. Set it in your |gvimrc|. Adding or |
7 | 3752 removing it after the GUI has started has no effect. |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
3753 *'go-F'* |
10 | 3754 'F' Add a footer. Only for Motif. See |gui-footer|. |
12802
29a728529f92
patch 8.0.1278: GUI window always resizes when adding scrollbar
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12785
diff
changeset
|
3755 *'go-k'* |
29a728529f92
patch 8.0.1278: GUI window always resizes when adding scrollbar
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12785
diff
changeset
|
3756 'k' Keep the GUI window size when adding/removing a scrollbar, or |
29a728529f92
patch 8.0.1278: GUI window always resizes when adding scrollbar
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12785
diff
changeset
|
3757 toolbar, tabline, etc. Instead, the behavior is similar to |
29a728529f92
patch 8.0.1278: GUI window always resizes when adding scrollbar
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12785
diff
changeset
|
3758 when the window is maximized and will adjust 'lines' and |
29a728529f92
patch 8.0.1278: GUI window always resizes when adding scrollbar
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12785
diff
changeset
|
3759 'columns' to fit to the window. Without the 'k' flag Vim will |
12865
ebb4f6c93598
patch 8.0.1309: cannot use 'balloonexpr' in a terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12826
diff
changeset
|
3760 try to keep 'lines' and 'columns' the same when adding and |
12802
29a728529f92
patch 8.0.1278: GUI window always resizes when adding scrollbar
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12785
diff
changeset
|
3761 removing GUI components. |
1152 | 3762 |
7 | 3763 *'guipty'* *'noguipty'* |
3764 'guipty' boolean (default on) | |
3765 global | |
3766 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled} | |
3767 Only in the GUI: If on, an attempt is made to open a pseudo-tty for | |
3768 I/O to/from shell commands. See |gui-pty|. | |
3769 | |
688 | 3770 *'guitablabel'* *'gtl'* |
3771 'guitablabel' 'gtl' string (default empty) | |
3772 global | |
692 | 3773 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled and |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
3774 with the |+windows| feature} |
688 | 3775 When nonempty describes the text to use in a label of the GUI tab |
857 | 3776 pages line. When empty and when the result is empty Vim will use a |
3777 default label. See |setting-guitablabel| for more info. | |
688 | 3778 |
692 | 3779 The format of this option is like that of 'statusline'. |
839 | 3780 'guitabtooltip' is used for the tooltip, see below. |
10449
222b1432814e
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/5162822914372fc916a93f85848c0c82209e7cec
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10272
diff
changeset
|
3781 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a |
222b1432814e
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/5162822914372fc916a93f85848c0c82209e7cec
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10272
diff
changeset
|
3782 modeline, see |sandbox-option|. |
692 | 3783 |
688 | 3784 Only used when the GUI tab pages line is displayed. 'e' must be |
3785 present in 'guioptions'. For the non-GUI tab pages line 'tabline' is | |
3786 used. | |
3787 | |
839 | 3788 *'guitabtooltip'* *'gtt'* |
3789 'guitabtooltip' 'gtt' string (default empty) | |
3790 global | |
3791 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled and | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
3792 with the |+windows| feature} |
839 | 3793 When nonempty describes the text to use in a tooltip for the GUI tab |
3794 pages line. When empty Vim will use a default tooltip. | |
3795 This option is otherwise just like 'guitablabel' above. | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
3796 You can include a line break. Simplest method is to use |:let|: > |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
3797 :let &guitabtooltip = "line one\nline two" |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
3798 < |
839 | 3799 |
7 | 3800 *'helpfile'* *'hf'* |
3801 'helpfile' 'hf' string (default (MSDOS) "$VIMRUNTIME\doc\help.txt" | |
3802 (others) "$VIMRUNTIME/doc/help.txt") | |
3803 global | |
3804 Name of the main help file. All distributed help files should be | |
3805 placed together in one directory. Additionally, all "doc" directories | |
3806 in 'runtimepath' will be used. | |
3807 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. For example: | |
3808 "$VIMRUNTIME/doc/help.txt". If $VIMRUNTIME is not set, $VIM is also | |
10 | 3809 tried. Also see |$VIMRUNTIME| and |option-backslash| about including |
7 | 3810 spaces and backslashes. |
3811 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
3812 security reasons. | |
3813 | |
3814 *'helpheight'* *'hh'* | |
3815 'helpheight' 'hh' number (default 20) | |
3816 global | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
3817 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| |
7 | 3818 feature} |
3819 Minimal initial height of the help window when it is opened with the | |
3820 ":help" command. The initial height of the help window is half of the | |
3821 current window, or (when the 'ea' option is on) the same as other | |
3822 windows. When the height is less than 'helpheight', the height is | |
3823 set to 'helpheight'. Set to zero to disable. | |
3824 | |
3825 *'helplang'* *'hlg'* | |
3826 'helplang' 'hlg' string (default: messages language or empty) | |
3827 global | |
3828 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_lang| | |
3829 feature} | |
3830 Comma separated list of languages. Vim will use the first language | |
3831 for which the desired help can be found. The English help will always | |
3832 be used as a last resort. You can add "en" to prefer English over | |
3833 another language, but that will only find tags that exist in that | |
3834 language and not in the English help. | |
3835 Example: > | |
3836 :set helplang=de,it | |
3837 < This will first search German, then Italian and finally English help | |
3838 files. | |
3839 When using |CTRL-]| and ":help!" in a non-English help file Vim will | |
3840 try to find the tag in the current language before using this option. | |
3841 See |help-translated|. | |
3842 | |
3843 *'hidden'* *'hid'* *'nohidden'* *'nohid'* | |
3844 'hidden' 'hid' boolean (default off) | |
3845 global | |
3846 When off a buffer is unloaded when it is |abandon|ed. When on a | |
3847 buffer becomes hidden when it is |abandon|ed. If the buffer is still | |
3848 displayed in another window, it does not become hidden, of course. | |
3849 The commands that move through the buffer list sometimes make a buffer | |
3850 hidden although the 'hidden' option is off: When the buffer is | |
3851 modified, 'autowrite' is off or writing is not possible, and the '!' | |
10 | 3852 flag was used. See also |windows.txt|. |
12 | 3853 To only make one buffer hidden use the 'bufhidden' option. |
7 | 3854 This option is set for one command with ":hide {command}" |:hide|. |
3855 WARNING: It's easy to forget that you have changes in hidden buffers. | |
3856 Think twice when using ":q!" or ":qa!". | |
3857 | |
3858 *'highlight'* *'hl'* | |
3859 'highlight' 'hl' string (default (as a single string): | |
9877
7da89d9c744b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/58b853460add42098ab08017df9e030fb14fd34b
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9860
diff
changeset
|
3860 "8:SpecialKey,~:EndOfBuffer,@:NonText, |
7da89d9c744b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/58b853460add42098ab08017df9e030fb14fd34b
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9860
diff
changeset
|
3861 d:Directory,e:ErrorMsg,i:IncSearch, |
7da89d9c744b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/58b853460add42098ab08017df9e030fb14fd34b
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9860
diff
changeset
|
3862 l:Search,m:MoreMsg,M:ModeMsg,n:LineNr, |
7da89d9c744b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/58b853460add42098ab08017df9e030fb14fd34b
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9860
diff
changeset
|
3863 N:CursorLineNr,r:Question,s:StatusLine, |
7da89d9c744b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/58b853460add42098ab08017df9e030fb14fd34b
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9860
diff
changeset
|
3864 S:StatusLineNC,c:VertSplit,t:Title, |
15194 | 3865 v:Visual,V:VisualNOS,w:WarningMsg, |
3866 W:WildMenu,f:Folded,F:FoldColumn, | |
3867 A:DiffAdd,C:DiffChange,D:DiffDelete, | |
3868 T:DiffText,>:SignColumn,-:Conceal, | |
15281 | 3869 B:SpellBad,P:SpellCap,R:SpellRare, |
15194 | 3870 L:SpellLocal,+:Pmenu,=:PmenuSel, |
11516
80491a71c716
patch 8.0.0641: cannot set a separate highlighting for the quickfix line
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11473
diff
changeset
|
3871 x:PmenuSbar,X:PmenuThumb,*:TabLine, |
80491a71c716
patch 8.0.0641: cannot set a separate highlighting for the quickfix line
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11473
diff
changeset
|
3872 #:TabLineSel,_:TabLineFill,!:CursorColumn, |
11914 | 3873 .:CursorLine,o:ColorColumn,q:QuickFixLine, |
12254 | 3874 z:StatusLineTerm,Z:StatusLineTermNC") |
7 | 3875 global |
3876 This option can be used to set highlighting mode for various | |
3877 occasions. It is a comma separated list of character pairs. The | |
3878 first character in a pair gives the occasion, the second the mode to | |
10 | 3879 use for that occasion. The occasions are: |
7 | 3880 |hl-SpecialKey| 8 Meta and special keys listed with ":map" |
9877
7da89d9c744b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/58b853460add42098ab08017df9e030fb14fd34b
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9860
diff
changeset
|
3881 |hl-EndOfBuffer| ~ lines after the last line in the buffer |
7da89d9c744b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/58b853460add42098ab08017df9e030fb14fd34b
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9860
diff
changeset
|
3882 |hl-NonText| @ '@' at the end of the window and |
7 | 3883 characters from 'showbreak' |
3884 |hl-Directory| d directories in CTRL-D listing and other special | |
3885 things in listings | |
3886 |hl-ErrorMsg| e error messages | |
3887 h (obsolete, ignored) | |
3888 |hl-IncSearch| i 'incsearch' highlighting | |
3889 |hl-Search| l last search pattern highlighting (see 'hlsearch') | |
3890 |hl-MoreMsg| m |more-prompt| | |
3891 |hl-ModeMsg| M Mode (e.g., "-- INSERT --") | |
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
3892 |hl-LineNr| n line number for ":number" and ":#" commands, and |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
3893 when 'number' or 'relativenumber' option is set. |
4073 | 3894 |hl-CursorLineNr| N like n for when 'cursorline' or 'relativenumber' is |
3895 set. | |
7 | 3896 |hl-Question| r |hit-enter| prompt and yes/no questions |
3897 |hl-StatusLine| s status line of current window |status-line| | |
12785 | 3898 |hl-StatusLineNC| S status lines of not-current windows |
7 | 3899 |hl-Title| t Titles for output from ":set all", ":autocmd" etc. |
3900 |hl-VertSplit| c column used to separate vertically split windows | |
3901 |hl-Visual| v Visual mode | |
3902 |hl-VisualNOS| V Visual mode when Vim does is "Not Owning the | |
3903 Selection" Only X11 Gui's |gui-x11| and | |
3904 |xterm-clipboard|. | |
3905 |hl-WarningMsg| w warning messages | |
3906 |hl-WildMenu| W wildcard matches displayed for 'wildmenu' | |
3907 |hl-Folded| f line used for closed folds | |
3908 |hl-FoldColumn| F 'foldcolumn' | |
386 | 3909 |hl-DiffAdd| A added line in diff mode |
3910 |hl-DiffChange| C changed line in diff mode | |
3911 |hl-DiffDelete| D deleted line in diff mode | |
3912 |hl-DiffText| T inserted text in diff mode | |
7 | 3913 |hl-SignColumn| > column used for |signs| |
15194 | 3914 |hl-Conceal| - the placeholders used for concealed characters |
3915 (see 'conceallevel') | |
221 | 3916 |hl-SpellBad| B misspelled word |spell| |
2337
a0f87fc19d1d
Better conceal in help. (partly by Dominique Pelle)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2324
diff
changeset
|
3917 |hl-SpellCap| P word that should start with capital |spell| |
221 | 3918 |hl-SpellRare| R rare word |spell| |
3919 |hl-SpellLocal| L word from other region |spell| | |
15194 | 3920 |hl-Pmenu| + popup menu normal line |
3921 |hl-PmenuSel| = popup menu selected line | |
3922 |hl-PmenuSbar| x popup menu scrollbar | |
3923 |hl-PmenuThumb| X popup menu scrollbar thumb | |
7 | 3924 |
3925 The display modes are: | |
3926 r reverse (termcap entry "mr" and "me") | |
3927 i italic (termcap entry "ZH" and "ZR") | |
3928 b bold (termcap entry "md" and "me") | |
3929 s standout (termcap entry "so" and "se") | |
3930 u underline (termcap entry "us" and "ue") | |
205 | 3931 c undercurl (termcap entry "Cs" and "Ce") |
12317
2a8890b80923
patch 8.0.1038: strike-through text not supported
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12293
diff
changeset
|
3932 t strikethrough (termcap entry "Ts" and "Te") |
7 | 3933 n no highlighting |
3934 - no highlighting | |
3935 : use a highlight group | |
3936 The default is used for occasions that are not included. | |
3937 If you want to change what the display modes do, see |dos-colors| | |
3938 for an example. | |
3939 When using the ':' display mode, this must be followed by the name of | |
3940 a highlight group. A highlight group can be used to define any type | |
3941 of highlighting, including using color. See |:highlight| on how to | |
3942 define one. The default uses a different group for each occasion. | |
3943 See |highlight-default| for the default highlight groups. | |
3944 | |
3945 *'history'* *'hi'* | |
9669
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
3946 'history' 'hi' number (Vim default: 50, Vi default: 0, |
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
3947 set to 200 in |defaults.vim|) |
7 | 3948 global |
3949 A history of ":" commands, and a history of previous search patterns | |
5991 | 3950 is remembered. This option decides how many entries may be stored in |
7 | 3951 each of these histories (see |cmdline-editing|). |
5991 | 3952 The maximum value is 10000. |
7 | 3953 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is |
3954 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
3955 | |
3956 *'hkmap'* *'hk'* *'nohkmap'* *'nohk'* | |
3957 'hkmap' 'hk' boolean (default off) | |
3958 global | |
3959 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft| | |
3960 feature} | |
3961 When on, the keyboard is mapped for the Hebrew character set. | |
3962 Normally you would set 'allowrevins' and use CTRL-_ in insert mode to | |
3963 toggle this option. See |rileft.txt|. | |
3964 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
3965 | |
3966 *'hkmapp'* *'hkp'* *'nohkmapp'* *'nohkp'* | |
3967 'hkmapp' 'hkp' boolean (default off) | |
3968 global | |
3969 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft| | |
3970 feature} | |
3971 When on, phonetic keyboard mapping is used. 'hkmap' must also be on. | |
3972 This is useful if you have a non-Hebrew keyboard. | |
3973 See |rileft.txt|. | |
3974 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
3975 | |
11160 | 3976 *'hlsearch'* *'hls'* *'nohlsearch'* *'nohls'* |
3977 'hlsearch' 'hls' boolean (default off) | |
3978 global | |
3979 {not available when compiled without the | |
3980 |+extra_search| feature} | |
3981 When there is a previous search pattern, highlight all its matches. | |
3982 The type of highlighting used can be set with the 'l' occasion in the | |
3983 'highlight' option. This uses the "Search" highlight group by | |
3984 default. Note that only the matching text is highlighted, any offsets | |
3985 are not applied. | |
3986 See also: 'incsearch' and |:match|. | |
3987 When you get bored looking at the highlighted matches, you can turn it | |
3988 off with |:nohlsearch|. This does not change the option value, as | |
3989 soon as you use a search command, the highlighting comes back. | |
3990 'redrawtime' specifies the maximum time spent on finding matches. | |
3991 When the search pattern can match an end-of-line, Vim will try to | |
3992 highlight all of the matched text. However, this depends on where the | |
3993 search starts. This will be the first line in the window or the first | |
3994 line below a closed fold. A match in a previous line which is not | |
3995 drawn may not continue in a newly drawn line. | |
3996 You can specify whether the highlight status is restored on startup | |
3997 with the 'h' flag in 'viminfo' |viminfo-h|. | |
3998 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
3999 | |
7 | 4000 *'icon'* *'noicon'* |
4001 'icon' boolean (default off, on when title can be restored) | |
4002 global | |
4003 {not available when compiled without the |+title| | |
4004 feature} | |
4005 When on, the icon text of the window will be set to the value of | |
4006 'iconstring' (if it is not empty), or to the name of the file | |
4007 currently being edited. Only the last part of the name is used. | |
4008 Overridden by the 'iconstring' option. | |
4009 Only works if the terminal supports setting window icons (currently | |
4010 only X11 GUI and terminals with a non-empty 't_IS' option - these are | |
4011 Unix xterm and iris-ansi by default, where 't_IS' is taken from the | |
4012 builtin termcap). | |
4013 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original icon will be | |
233 | 4014 restored if possible |X11|. See |X11-icon| for changing the icon on |
7 | 4015 X11. |
6259 | 4016 For MS-Windows the icon can be changed, see |windows-icon|. |
7 | 4017 |
4018 *'iconstring'* | |
4019 'iconstring' string (default "") | |
4020 global | |
4021 {not available when compiled without the |+title| | |
4022 feature} | |
4023 When this option is not empty, it will be used for the icon text of | |
4024 the window. This happens only when the 'icon' option is on. | |
4025 Only works if the terminal supports setting window icon text | |
4026 (currently only X11 GUI and terminals with a non-empty 't_IS' option). | |
4027 Does not work for MS Windows. | |
4028 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original icon will be | |
4029 restored if possible |X11|. | |
4030 When this option contains printf-style '%' items, they will be | |
10 | 4031 expanded according to the rules used for 'statusline'. See |
7 | 4032 'titlestring' for example settings. |
4033 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline| feature} | |
4034 | |
4035 *'ignorecase'* *'ic'* *'noignorecase'* *'noic'* | |
4036 'ignorecase' 'ic' boolean (default off) | |
4037 global | |
4038 Ignore case in search patterns. Also used when searching in the tags | |
4039 file. | |
7266
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
4040 Also see 'smartcase' and 'tagcase'. |
7 | 4041 Can be overruled by using "\c" or "\C" in the pattern, see |
4042 |/ignorecase|. | |
4043 | |
5008
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4044 *'imactivatefunc'* *'imaf'* |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4045 'imactivatefunc' 'imaf' string (default "") |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4046 global |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4047 This option specifies a function that will be called to |
12936
c53a80f39a52
patch 8.0.1344: using 'imactivatefunc' in the GUI does not work
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12934
diff
changeset
|
4048 activate or deactivate the Input Method. |
c53a80f39a52
patch 8.0.1344: using 'imactivatefunc' in the GUI does not work
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12934
diff
changeset
|
4049 It is not used in the GUI. |
5008
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4050 |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4051 Example: > |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4052 function ImActivateFunc(active) |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4053 if a:active |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4054 ... do something |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4055 else |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4056 ... do something |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4057 endif |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4058 " return value is not used |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4059 endfunction |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4060 set imactivatefunc=ImActivateFunc |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4061 < |
7 | 4062 *'imactivatekey'* *'imak'* |
4063 'imactivatekey' 'imak' string (default "") | |
4064 global | |
4065 {only available when compiled with |+xim| and | |
2209
d0ddf7ba1630
Included the patch to support netbeans in a terminal.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2207
diff
changeset
|
4066 |+GUI_GTK|} *E599* |
7 | 4067 Specifies the key that your Input Method in X-Windows uses for |
4068 activation. When this is specified correctly, vim can fully control | |
4069 IM with 'imcmdline', 'iminsert' and 'imsearch'. | |
4070 You can't use this option to change the activation key, the option | |
4071 tells Vim what the key is. | |
4072 Format: | |
4073 [MODIFIER_FLAG-]KEY_STRING | |
4074 | |
4075 These characters can be used for MODIFIER_FLAG (case is ignored): | |
4076 S Shift key | |
4077 L Lock key | |
4078 C Control key | |
4079 1 Mod1 key | |
4080 2 Mod2 key | |
4081 3 Mod3 key | |
4082 4 Mod4 key | |
4083 5 Mod5 key | |
4084 Combinations are allowed, for example "S-C-space" or "SC-space" are | |
4085 both shift+ctrl+space. | |
4086 See <X11/keysymdef.h> and XStringToKeysym for KEY_STRING. | |
4087 | |
4088 Example: > | |
4089 :set imactivatekey=S-space | |
4090 < "S-space" means shift+space. This is the activation key for kinput2 + | |
4091 canna (Japanese), and ami (Korean). | |
4092 | |
4093 *'imcmdline'* *'imc'* *'noimcmdline'* *'noimc'* | |
4094 'imcmdline' 'imc' boolean (default off) | |
4095 global | |
4096 When set the Input Method is always on when starting to edit a command | |
4097 line, unless entering a search pattern (see 'imsearch' for that). | |
4098 Setting this option is useful when your input method allows entering | |
4099 English characters directly, e.g., when it's used to type accented | |
4100 characters with dead keys. | |
4101 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4102 *'imdisable'* *'imd'* *'noimdisable'* *'noimd'* |
7 | 4103 'imdisable' 'imd' boolean (default off, on for some systems (SGI)) |
4104 global | |
4105 When set the Input Method is never used. This is useful to disable | |
4106 the IM when it doesn't work properly. | |
4107 Currently this option is on by default for SGI/IRIX machines. This | |
4108 may change in later releases. | |
4109 | |
4110 *'iminsert'* *'imi'* | |
12469
61d910f0999d
patch 8.0.1114: default for 'iminsert' is annoying
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12317
diff
changeset
|
4111 'iminsert' 'imi' number (default 0) |
7 | 4112 local to buffer |
4113 Specifies whether :lmap or an Input Method (IM) is to be used in | |
4114 Insert mode. Valid values: | |
4115 0 :lmap is off and IM is off | |
4116 1 :lmap is ON and IM is off | |
4117 2 :lmap is off and IM is ON | |
4118 To always reset the option to zero when leaving Insert mode with <Esc> | |
4119 this can be used: > | |
4120 :inoremap <ESC> <ESC>:set iminsert=0<CR> | |
4121 < This makes :lmap and IM turn off automatically when leaving Insert | |
4122 mode. | |
4123 Note that this option changes when using CTRL-^ in Insert mode | |
4124 |i_CTRL-^|. | |
4125 The value is set to 1 when setting 'keymap' to a valid keymap name. | |
4126 It is also used for the argument of commands like "r" and "f". | |
4127 The value 0 may not work correctly with Athena and Motif with some XIM | |
4128 methods. Use 'imdisable' to disable XIM then. | |
4129 | |
12920
327e1264b9bf
patch 8.0.1336: cannot use imactivatefunc() unless compiled with +xim
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12865
diff
changeset
|
4130 You can set 'imactivatefunc' and 'imstatusfunc' to handle IME/XIM |
14519 | 4131 via external command if Vim is not compiled with the |+xim|, |
12920
327e1264b9bf
patch 8.0.1336: cannot use imactivatefunc() unless compiled with +xim
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12865
diff
changeset
|
4132 |+multi_byte_ime| or |global-ime|. |
327e1264b9bf
patch 8.0.1336: cannot use imactivatefunc() unless compiled with +xim
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12865
diff
changeset
|
4133 |
7 | 4134 *'imsearch'* *'ims'* |
12469
61d910f0999d
patch 8.0.1114: default for 'iminsert' is annoying
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12317
diff
changeset
|
4135 'imsearch' 'ims' number (default -1) |
7 | 4136 local to buffer |
4137 Specifies whether :lmap or an Input Method (IM) is to be used when | |
4138 entering a search pattern. Valid values: | |
4139 -1 the value of 'iminsert' is used, makes it look like | |
4140 'iminsert' is also used when typing a search pattern | |
4141 0 :lmap is off and IM is off | |
4142 1 :lmap is ON and IM is off | |
4143 2 :lmap is off and IM is ON | |
4144 Note that this option changes when using CTRL-^ in Command-line mode | |
4145 |c_CTRL-^|. | |
4146 The value is set to 1 when it is not -1 and setting the 'keymap' | |
4147 option to a valid keymap name. | |
4148 The value 0 may not work correctly with Athena and Motif with some XIM | |
4149 methods. Use 'imdisable' to disable XIM then. | |
4150 | |
5008
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4151 *'imstatusfunc'* *'imsf'* |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4152 'imstatusfunc' 'imsf' string (default "") |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4153 global |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4154 This option specifies a function that is called to obtain the status |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4155 of Input Method. It must return a positive number when IME is active. |
12936
c53a80f39a52
patch 8.0.1344: using 'imactivatefunc' in the GUI does not work
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12934
diff
changeset
|
4156 It is not used in the GUI. |
5008
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4157 |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4158 Example: > |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4159 function ImStatusFunc() |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4160 let is_active = ...do something |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4161 return is_active ? 1 : 0 |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4162 endfunction |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4163 set imstatusfunc=ImStatusFunc |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4164 < |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4165 NOTE: This function is invoked very often. Keep it fast. |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4166 |
12293
1ff5e5dfa9b0
patch 8.0.1026: GTK on-the-spot input has problems
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12254
diff
changeset
|
4167 *'imstyle'* *'imst'* |
1ff5e5dfa9b0
patch 8.0.1026: GTK on-the-spot input has problems
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12254
diff
changeset
|
4168 'imstyle' 'imst' number (default 1) |
1ff5e5dfa9b0
patch 8.0.1026: GTK on-the-spot input has problems
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12254
diff
changeset
|
4169 global |
1ff5e5dfa9b0
patch 8.0.1026: GTK on-the-spot input has problems
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12254
diff
changeset
|
4170 {only available when compiled with |+xim| and |
1ff5e5dfa9b0
patch 8.0.1026: GTK on-the-spot input has problems
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12254
diff
changeset
|
4171 |+GUI_GTK|} |
12499 | 4172 This option specifies the input style of Input Method: |
4173 0 use on-the-spot style | |
4174 1 over-the-spot style | |
12293
1ff5e5dfa9b0
patch 8.0.1026: GTK on-the-spot input has problems
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12254
diff
changeset
|
4175 See: |xim-input-style| |
1ff5e5dfa9b0
patch 8.0.1026: GTK on-the-spot input has problems
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12254
diff
changeset
|
4176 |
12559 | 4177 For a long time on-the-spot style had been used in the GTK version of |
4178 vim, however, it is known that it causes troubles when using mappings, | |
12293
1ff5e5dfa9b0
patch 8.0.1026: GTK on-the-spot input has problems
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12254
diff
changeset
|
4179 |single-repeat|, etc. Therefore over-the-spot style becomes the |
1ff5e5dfa9b0
patch 8.0.1026: GTK on-the-spot input has problems
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12254
diff
changeset
|
4180 default now. This should work fine for most people, however if you |
1ff5e5dfa9b0
patch 8.0.1026: GTK on-the-spot input has problems
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12254
diff
changeset
|
4181 have any problem with it, try using on-the-spot style. |
1ff5e5dfa9b0
patch 8.0.1026: GTK on-the-spot input has problems
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12254
diff
changeset
|
4182 |
7 | 4183 *'include'* *'inc'* |
4184 'include' 'inc' string (default "^\s*#\s*include") | |
4185 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
4186 {not available when compiled without the | |
4187 |+find_in_path| feature} | |
10 | 4188 Pattern to be used to find an include command. It is a search |
7 | 4189 pattern, just like for the "/" command (See |pattern|). The default |
4190 value is for C programs. This option is used for the commands "[i", | |
532 | 4191 "]I", "[d", etc. |
4192 Normally the 'isfname' option is used to recognize the file name that | |
534 | 4193 comes after the matched pattern. But if "\zs" appears in the pattern |
4194 then the text matched from "\zs" to the end, or until "\ze" if it | |
4195 appears, is used as the file name. Use this to include characters | |
4196 that are not in 'isfname', such as a space. You can then use | |
4197 'includeexpr' to process the matched text. | |
532 | 4198 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes. |
7 | 4199 |
4200 *'includeexpr'* *'inex'* | |
4201 'includeexpr' 'inex' string (default "") | |
4202 local to buffer | |
4203 {not available when compiled without the | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
4204 |+find_in_path| or |+eval| features} |
7 | 4205 Expression to be used to transform the string found with the 'include' |
10 | 4206 option to a file name. Mostly useful to change "." to "/" for Java: > |
7 | 4207 :set includeexpr=substitute(v:fname,'\\.','/','g') |
4208 < The "v:fname" variable will be set to the file name that was detected. | |
634 | 4209 |
7 | 4210 Also used for the |gf| command if an unmodified file name can't be |
10 | 4211 found. Allows doing "gf" on the name after an 'include' statement. |
7 | 4212 Also used for |<cfile>|. |
4213 | |
3682 | 4214 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a |
4215 modeline, see |sandbox-option|. | |
634 | 4216 |
4217 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while | |
4218 evaluating 'includeexpr' |textlock|. | |
4219 | |
7 | 4220 *'incsearch'* *'is'* *'noincsearch'* *'nois'* |
9669
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
4221 'incsearch' 'is' boolean (default off, set in |defaults.vim| if the |
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
4222 +reltime feature is supported) |
7 | 4223 global |
4224 {not available when compiled without the | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
4225 |+extra_search| features} |
17 | 4226 While typing a search command, show where the pattern, as it was typed |
4227 so far, matches. The matched string is highlighted. If the pattern | |
4228 is invalid or not found, nothing is shown. The screen will be updated | |
4229 often, this is only useful on fast terminals. | |
14637 | 4230 Also applies to the pattern in commands: > |
4231 :global | |
4232 :lvimgrep | |
4233 :lvimgrepadd | |
4234 :smagic | |
4235 :snomagic | |
4236 :sort | |
4237 :substitute | |
4238 :vglobal | |
4239 :vimgrep | |
4240 :vimgrepadd | |
4241 < Note that the match will be shown, but the cursor will return to its | |
17 | 4242 original position when no match is found and when pressing <Esc>. You |
4243 still need to finish the search command with <Enter> to move the | |
4244 cursor to the match. | |
10261
bdd7fc1a38c0
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/dc08328821a2c11e33dfb1980332e4923ec64fca
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10244
diff
changeset
|
4245 You can use the CTRL-G and CTRL-T keys to move to the next and |
bdd7fc1a38c0
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/dc08328821a2c11e33dfb1980332e4923ec64fca
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10244
diff
changeset
|
4246 previous match. |c_CTRL-G| |c_CTRL-T| |
1521 | 4247 When compiled with the |+reltime| feature Vim only searches for about |
4248 half a second. With a complicated pattern and/or a lot of text the | |
4249 match may not be found. This is to avoid that Vim hangs while you | |
4250 are typing the pattern. | |
17 | 4251 The highlighting can be set with the 'i' flag in 'highlight'. |
12968 | 4252 When 'hlsearch' is on, all matched strings are highlighted too while |
4253 typing a search command. See also: 'hlsearch'. | |
14519 | 4254 If you don't want to turn 'hlsearch' on, but want to highlight all |
4255 matches while searching, you can turn on and off 'hlsearch' with | |
4256 autocmd. Example: > | |
12720
37c384802df4
patch 8.0.1238: incremental search only shows one match
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12608
diff
changeset
|
4257 augroup vimrc-incsearch-highlight |
37c384802df4
patch 8.0.1238: incremental search only shows one match
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12608
diff
changeset
|
4258 autocmd! |
12744
0c704288ced4
patch 8.0.1250: 'hlsearch' highlighting not removed after incsearch
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12720
diff
changeset
|
4259 autocmd CmdlineEnter /,\? :set hlsearch |
0c704288ced4
patch 8.0.1250: 'hlsearch' highlighting not removed after incsearch
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12720
diff
changeset
|
4260 autocmd CmdlineLeave /,\? :set nohlsearch |
12720
37c384802df4
patch 8.0.1238: incremental search only shows one match
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12608
diff
changeset
|
4261 augroup END |
37c384802df4
patch 8.0.1238: incremental search only shows one match
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12608
diff
changeset
|
4262 < |
772 | 4263 CTRL-L can be used to add one character from after the current match |
2302
488be8cbe19c
Make CTRL-L in command line mode respect 'ignorecase' and 'smartcase'. (Martin
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2301
diff
changeset
|
4264 to the command line. If 'ignorecase' and 'smartcase' are set and the |
488be8cbe19c
Make CTRL-L in command line mode respect 'ignorecase' and 'smartcase'. (Martin
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2301
diff
changeset
|
4265 command line has no uppercase characters, the added character is |
488be8cbe19c
Make CTRL-L in command line mode respect 'ignorecase' and 'smartcase'. (Martin
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2301
diff
changeset
|
4266 converted to lowercase. |
772 | 4267 CTRL-R CTRL-W can be used to add the word at the end of the current |
4268 match, excluding the characters that were already typed. | |
7 | 4269 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
4270 | |
4271 *'indentexpr'* *'inde'* | |
4272 'indentexpr' 'inde' string (default "") | |
4273 local to buffer | |
4274 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent| | |
4275 or |+eval| features} | |
4276 Expression which is evaluated to obtain the proper indent for a line. | |
4277 It is used when a new line is created, for the |=| operator and | |
4278 in Insert mode as specified with the 'indentkeys' option. | |
4279 When this option is not empty, it overrules the 'cindent' and | |
2833 | 4280 'smartindent' indenting. When 'lisp' is set, this option is |
4281 overridden by the Lisp indentation algorithm. | |
7 | 4282 When 'paste' is set this option is not used for indenting. |
4283 The expression is evaluated with |v:lnum| set to the line number for | |
534 | 4284 which the indent is to be computed. The cursor is also in this line |
7 | 4285 when the expression is evaluated (but it may be moved around). |
4286 The expression must return the number of spaces worth of indent. It | |
4287 can return "-1" to keep the current indent (this means 'autoindent' is | |
4288 used for the indent). | |
4289 Functions useful for computing the indent are |indent()|, |cindent()| | |
4290 and |lispindent()|. | |
4291 The evaluation of the expression must not have side effects! It must | |
4292 not change the text, jump to another window, etc. Afterwards the | |
4293 cursor position is always restored, thus the cursor may be moved. | |
4294 Normally this option would be set to call a function: > | |
4295 :set indentexpr=GetMyIndent() | |
4296 < Error messages will be suppressed, unless the 'debug' option contains | |
4297 "msg". | |
634 | 4298 See |indent-expression|. |
11160 | 4299 NOTE: This option is set to "" when 'compatible' is set. |
7 | 4300 |
3682 | 4301 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a |
4302 modeline, see |sandbox-option|. | |
634 | 4303 |
4304 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while | |
4305 evaluating 'indentexpr' |textlock|. | |
4306 | |
4307 | |
7 | 4308 *'indentkeys'* *'indk'* |
15701
9cd11f6beb70
patch 8.1.0858: 'indentkeys' and 'cinkeys' defaults are different
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15512
diff
changeset
|
4309 'indentkeys' 'indk' string (default "0{,0},0),0],:,0#,!^F,o,O,e") |
7 | 4310 local to buffer |
4311 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent| | |
4312 feature} | |
4313 A list of keys that, when typed in Insert mode, cause reindenting of | |
4314 the current line. Only happens if 'indentexpr' isn't empty. | |
4315 The format is identical to 'cinkeys', see |indentkeys-format|. | |
4316 See |C-indenting| and |indent-expression|. | |
4317 | |
4318 *'infercase'* *'inf'* *'noinfercase'* *'noinf'* | |
4319 'infercase' 'inf' boolean (default off) | |
4320 local to buffer | |
4321 When doing keyword completion in insert mode |ins-completion|, and | |
1621 | 4322 'ignorecase' is also on, the case of the match is adjusted depending |
4323 on the typed text. If the typed text contains a lowercase letter | |
4324 where the match has an upper case letter, the completed part is made | |
4325 lowercase. If the typed text has no lowercase letters and the match | |
4326 has a lowercase letter where the typed text has an uppercase letter, | |
4327 and there is a letter before it, the completed part is made uppercase. | |
4328 With 'noinfercase' the match is used as-is. | |
7 | 4329 |
4330 *'insertmode'* *'im'* *'noinsertmode'* *'noim'* | |
4331 'insertmode' 'im' boolean (default off) | |
4332 global | |
4333 Makes Vim work in a way that Insert mode is the default mode. Useful | |
4334 if you want to use Vim as a modeless editor. Used for |evim|. | |
4335 These Insert mode commands will be useful: | |
4336 - Use the cursor keys to move around. | |
9887
b4da19b7539f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/dc1f1645cb495fa6bfbe216d7359f23539a0e25d
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9877
diff
changeset
|
4337 - Use CTRL-O to execute one Normal mode command |i_CTRL-O|. When |
7 | 4338 this is a mapping, it is executed as if 'insertmode' was off. |
4339 Normal mode remains active until the mapping is finished. | |
4340 - Use CTRL-L to execute a number of Normal mode commands, then use | |
477 | 4341 <Esc> to get back to Insert mode. Note that CTRL-L moves the cursor |
4342 left, like <Esc> does when 'insertmode' isn't set. |i_CTRL-L| | |
7 | 4343 |
4344 These items change when 'insertmode' is set: | |
4345 - when starting to edit of a file, Vim goes to Insert mode. | |
4346 - <Esc> in Insert mode is a no-op and beeps. | |
4347 - <Esc> in Normal mode makes Vim go to Insert mode. | |
4348 - CTRL-L in Insert mode is a command, it is not inserted. | |
4349 - CTRL-Z in Insert mode suspends Vim, see |CTRL-Z|. *i_CTRL-Z* | |
4350 However, when <Esc> is used inside a mapping, it behaves like | |
4351 'insertmode' was not set. This was done to be able to use the same | |
4352 mappings with 'insertmode' set or not set. | |
4353 When executing commands with |:normal| 'insertmode' is not used. | |
4354 | |
4355 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
4356 | |
4357 *'isfname'* *'isf'* | |
4358 'isfname' 'isf' string (default for MS-DOS, Win32 and OS/2: | |
4359 "@,48-57,/,\,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,{,},[,],:,@-@,!,~,=" | |
4360 for AMIGA: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,$,:" | |
4361 for VMS: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,<,>,[,],:,;,~" | |
4362 for OS/390: "@,240-249,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,~,=" | |
4363 otherwise: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,~,=") | |
4364 global | |
4365 The characters specified by this option are included in file names and | |
4366 path names. Filenames are used for commands like "gf", "[i" and in | |
10 | 4367 the tags file. It is also used for "\f" in a |pattern|. |
7 | 4368 Multi-byte characters 256 and above are always included, only the |
4369 characters up to 255 are specified with this option. | |
4370 For UTF-8 the characters 0xa0 to 0xff are included as well. | |
1621 | 4371 Think twice before adding white space to this option. Although a |
4372 space may appear inside a file name, the effect will be that Vim | |
4373 doesn't know where a file name starts or ends when doing completion. | |
4374 It most likely works better without a space in 'isfname'. | |
7 | 4375 |
4376 Note that on systems using a backslash as path separator, Vim tries to | |
4377 do its best to make it work as you would expect. That is a bit | |
4378 tricky, since Vi originally used the backslash to escape special | |
4379 characters. Vim will not remove a backslash in front of a normal file | |
4380 name character on these systems, but it will on Unix and alikes. The | |
4381 '&' and '^' are not included by default, because these are special for | |
4382 cmd.exe. | |
4383 | |
4384 The format of this option is a list of parts, separated with commas. | |
10 | 4385 Each part can be a single character number or a range. A range is two |
4386 character numbers with '-' in between. A character number can be a | |
7 | 4387 decimal number between 0 and 255 or the ASCII character itself (does |
4388 not work for digits). Example: | |
4389 "_,-,128-140,#-43" (include '_' and '-' and the range | |
4390 128 to 140 and '#' to 43) | |
4391 If a part starts with '^', the following character number or range | |
4392 will be excluded from the option. The option is interpreted from left | |
4393 to right. Put the excluded character after the range where it is | |
4394 included. To include '^' itself use it as the last character of the | |
4395 option or the end of a range. Example: | |
4396 "^a-z,#,^" (exclude 'a' to 'z', include '#' and '^') | |
4397 If the character is '@', all characters where isalpha() returns TRUE | |
4398 are included. Normally these are the characters a to z and A to Z, | |
4399 plus accented characters. To include '@' itself use "@-@". Examples: | |
4400 "@,^a-z" All alphabetic characters, excluding lower | |
1621 | 4401 case ASCII letters. |
7 | 4402 "a-z,A-Z,@-@" All letters plus the '@' character. |
4403 A comma can be included by using it where a character number is | |
4404 expected. Example: | |
4405 "48-57,,,_" Digits, comma and underscore. | |
4406 A comma can be excluded by prepending a '^'. Example: | |
4407 " -~,^,,9" All characters from space to '~', excluding | |
4408 comma, plus <Tab>. | |
4409 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes. | |
4410 | |
4411 *'isident'* *'isi'* | |
4412 'isident' 'isi' string (default for MS-DOS, Win32 and OS/2: | |
4413 "@,48-57,_,128-167,224-235" | |
4414 otherwise: "@,48-57,_,192-255") | |
4415 global | |
4416 The characters given by this option are included in identifiers. | |
4417 Identifiers are used in recognizing environment variables and after a | |
4418 match of the 'define' option. It is also used for "\i" in a | |
233 | 4419 |pattern|. See 'isfname' for a description of the format of this |
14864 | 4420 option. For '@' only characters up to 255 are used. |
7 | 4421 Careful: If you change this option, it might break expanding |
10 | 4422 environment variables. E.g., when '/' is included and Vim tries to |
7 | 4423 expand "$HOME/.viminfo". Maybe you should change 'iskeyword' instead. |
4424 | |
4425 *'iskeyword'* *'isk'* | |
4426 'iskeyword' 'isk' string (Vim default for MS-DOS and Win32: | |
4427 "@,48-57,_,128-167,224-235" | |
4428 otherwise: "@,48-57,_,192-255" | |
4429 Vi default: "@,48-57,_") | |
4430 local to buffer | |
4431 Keywords are used in searching and recognizing with many commands: | |
10 | 4432 "w", "*", "[i", etc. It is also used for "\k" in a |pattern|. See |
14864 | 4433 'isfname' for a description of the format of this option. For '@' |
4434 characters above 255 check the "word" character class. | |
4435 For C programs you could use "a-z,A-Z,48-57,_,.,-,>". | |
7 | 4436 For a help file it is set to all non-blank printable characters except |
4437 '*', '"' and '|' (so that CTRL-] on a command finds the help for that | |
4438 command). | |
4439 When the 'lisp' option is on the '-' character is always included. | |
7687
61354fabf8a2
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/b8060fe862f684b591f9ac679eac5b2594d6c5a0
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7538
diff
changeset
|
4440 This option also influences syntax highlighting, unless the syntax |
61354fabf8a2
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/b8060fe862f684b591f9ac679eac5b2594d6c5a0
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7538
diff
changeset
|
4441 uses |:syn-iskeyword|. |
7 | 4442 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is |
4443 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
4444 | |
4445 *'isprint'* *'isp'* | |
4446 'isprint' 'isp' string (default for MS-DOS, Win32, OS/2 and Macintosh: | |
4447 "@,~-255"; otherwise: "@,161-255") | |
4448 global | |
4449 The characters given by this option are displayed directly on the | |
4450 screen. It is also used for "\p" in a |pattern|. The characters from | |
4451 space (ASCII 32) to '~' (ASCII 126) are always displayed directly, | |
4452 even when they are not included in 'isprint' or excluded. See | |
4453 'isfname' for a description of the format of this option. | |
4454 | |
4455 Non-printable characters are displayed with two characters: | |
4456 0 - 31 "^@" - "^_" | |
4457 32 - 126 always single characters | |
4458 127 "^?" | |
4459 128 - 159 "~@" - "~_" | |
4460 160 - 254 "| " - "|~" | |
4461 255 "~?" | |
4462 When 'encoding' is a Unicode one, illegal bytes from 128 to 255 are | |
4463 displayed as <xx>, with the hexadecimal value of the byte. | |
4464 When 'display' contains "uhex" all unprintable characters are | |
4465 displayed as <xx>. | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4466 The SpecialKey highlighting will be used for unprintable characters. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4467 |hl-SpecialKey| |
7 | 4468 |
4469 Multi-byte characters 256 and above are always included, only the | |
4470 characters up to 255 are specified with this option. When a character | |
4471 is printable but it is not available in the current font, a | |
4472 replacement character will be shown. | |
4473 Unprintable and zero-width Unicode characters are displayed as <xxxx>. | |
4474 There is no option to specify these characters. | |
4475 | |
4476 *'joinspaces'* *'js'* *'nojoinspaces'* *'nojs'* | |
4477 'joinspaces' 'js' boolean (default on) | |
4478 global | |
4479 Insert two spaces after a '.', '?' and '!' with a join command. | |
4480 When 'cpoptions' includes the 'j' flag, only do this after a '.'. | |
4481 Otherwise only one space is inserted. | |
4482 NOTE: This option is set when 'compatible' is set. | |
4483 | |
4484 *'key'* | |
4485 'key' string (default "") | |
4486 local to buffer | |
2283
7e1bd501306d
Mainly documentation updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2265
diff
changeset
|
4487 {only available when compiled with the |+cryptv| |
7e1bd501306d
Mainly documentation updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2265
diff
changeset
|
4488 feature} |
7 | 4489 The key that is used for encrypting and decrypting the current buffer. |
2180
f60a0c9cbe6c
Add the blowfish encryption patch from Mohsin Ahmed. Needs more work.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2178
diff
changeset
|
4490 See |encryption| and 'cryptmethod'. |
7 | 4491 Careful: Do not set the key value by hand, someone might see the typed |
4492 key. Use the |:X| command. But you can make 'key' empty: > | |
4493 :set key= | |
4494 < It is not possible to get the value of this option with ":set key" or | |
4495 "echo &key". This is to avoid showing it to someone who shouldn't | |
4496 know. It also means you cannot see it yourself once you have set it, | |
4497 be careful not to make a typing error! | |
2698
b6471224d2af
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2681
diff
changeset
|
4498 You can use "&key" in an expression to detect whether encryption is |
b6471224d2af
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2681
diff
changeset
|
4499 enabled. When 'key' is set it returns "*****" (five stars). |
7 | 4500 |
4501 *'keymap'* *'kmp'* *E544* | |
4502 'keymap' 'kmp' string (default "") | |
4503 local to buffer | |
4504 {only available when compiled with the |+keymap| | |
4505 feature} | |
4506 Name of a keyboard mapping. See |mbyte-keymap|. | |
4507 Setting this option to a valid keymap name has the side effect of | |
4508 setting 'iminsert' to one, so that the keymap becomes effective. | |
4509 'imsearch' is also set to one, unless it was -1 | |
36 | 4510 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal. |
7 | 4511 |
4512 *'keymodel'* *'km'* | |
4513 'keymodel' 'km' string (default "") | |
4514 global | |
4515 List of comma separated words, which enable special things that keys | |
4516 can do. These values can be used: | |
4517 startsel Using a shifted special key starts selection (either | |
4518 Select mode or Visual mode, depending on "key" being | |
4519 present in 'selectmode'). | |
4520 stopsel Using a not-shifted special key stops selection. | |
4521 Special keys in this context are the cursor keys, <End>, <Home>, | |
4522 <PageUp> and <PageDown>. | |
4523 The 'keymodel' option is set by the |:behave| command. | |
4524 | |
4525 *'keywordprg'* *'kp'* | |
4526 'keywordprg' 'kp' string (default "man" or "man -s", DOS: ":help", | |
9098
0d52ddff8db4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/2ff8b64679242e73248774a388d54931c9ce49bd
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9097
diff
changeset
|
4527 VMS: "help") |
7 | 4528 global or local to buffer |global-local| |
4529 Program to use for the |K| command. Environment variables are | |
4530 expanded |:set_env|. ":help" may be used to access the Vim internal | |
4531 help. (Note that previously setting the global option to the empty | |
4532 value did this, which is now deprecated.) | |
9098
0d52ddff8db4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/2ff8b64679242e73248774a388d54931c9ce49bd
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9097
diff
changeset
|
4533 When the first character is ":", the command is invoked as a Vim |
0d52ddff8db4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/2ff8b64679242e73248774a388d54931c9ce49bd
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9097
diff
changeset
|
4534 Ex command prefixed with [count]. |
0d52ddff8db4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/2ff8b64679242e73248774a388d54931c9ce49bd
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9097
diff
changeset
|
4535 When "man", "man -s" or an Ex command is used, Vim will automatically |
0d52ddff8db4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/2ff8b64679242e73248774a388d54931c9ce49bd
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9097
diff
changeset
|
4536 translate a count for the "K" command and pass it as the first |
0d52ddff8db4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/2ff8b64679242e73248774a388d54931c9ce49bd
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9097
diff
changeset
|
4537 argument. For "man -s" the "-s" is removed when there is no count. |
7 | 4538 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes. |
4539 Example: > | |
4540 :set keywordprg=man\ -s | |
4541 < This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
4542 security reasons. | |
4543 | |
4544 *'langmap'* *'lmap'* *E357* *E358* | |
4545 'langmap' 'lmap' string (default "") | |
4546 global | |
4547 {only available when compiled with the |+langmap| | |
4548 feature} | |
4549 This option allows switching your keyboard into a special language | |
10 | 4550 mode. When you are typing text in Insert mode the characters are |
7477
05cf4cc72a9f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/fa7353428f705f7a13465a1943dddeede4083023
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7272
diff
changeset
|
4551 inserted directly. When in Normal mode the 'langmap' option takes |
7 | 4552 care of translating these special characters to the original meaning |
4553 of the key. This means you don't have to change the keyboard mode to | |
4554 be able to execute Normal mode commands. | |
4555 This is the opposite of the 'keymap' option, where characters are | |
4556 mapped in Insert mode. | |
9975
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
4557 Also consider resetting 'langremap' to avoid 'langmap' applies to |
6369 | 4558 characters resulting from a mapping. |
5908 | 4559 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
4560 security reasons. | |
7 | 4561 |
699 | 4562 Example (for Greek, in UTF-8): *greek* > |
4563 :set langmap=ΑA,ΒB,ΨC,ΔD,ΕE,ΦF,ΓG,ΗH,ΙI,ΞJ,ΚK,ΛL,ΜM,ΝN,ΟO,ΠP,QQ,ΡR,ΣS,ΤT,ΘU,ΩV,WW,ΧX,ΥY,ΖZ,αa,βb,ψc,δd,εe,φf,γg,ηh,ιi,ξj,κk,λl,μm,νn,οo,πp,qq,ρr,σs,τt,θu,ωv,ςw,χx,υy,ζz | |
7 | 4564 < Example (exchanges meaning of z and y for commands): > |
4565 :set langmap=zy,yz,ZY,YZ | |
4566 < | |
4567 The 'langmap' option is a list of parts, separated with commas. Each | |
4568 part can be in one of two forms: | |
4569 1. A list of pairs. Each pair is a "from" character immediately | |
4570 followed by the "to" character. Examples: "aA", "aAbBcC". | |
4571 2. A list of "from" characters, a semi-colon and a list of "to" | |
4572 characters. Example: "abc;ABC" | |
4573 Example: "aA,fgh;FGH,cCdDeE" | |
4574 Special characters need to be preceded with a backslash. These are | |
4575 ";", ',' and backslash itself. | |
4576 | |
4577 This will allow you to activate vim actions without having to switch | |
4578 back and forth between the languages. Your language characters will | |
4579 be understood as normal vim English characters (according to the | |
4580 langmap mappings) in the following cases: | |
4581 o Normal/Visual mode (commands, buffer/register names, user mappings) | |
4582 o Insert/Replace Mode: Register names after CTRL-R | |
4583 o Insert/Replace Mode: Mappings | |
4584 Characters entered in Command-line mode will NOT be affected by | |
4585 this option. Note that this option can be changed at any time | |
4586 allowing to switch between mappings for different languages/encodings. | |
4587 Use a mapping to avoid having to type it each time! | |
4588 | |
4589 *'langmenu'* *'lm'* | |
4590 'langmenu' 'lm' string (default "") | |
4591 global | |
4592 {only available when compiled with the |+menu| and | |
4593 |+multi_lang| features} | |
4594 Language to use for menu translation. Tells which file is loaded | |
4595 from the "lang" directory in 'runtimepath': > | |
4596 "lang/menu_" . &langmenu . ".vim" | |
4597 < (without the spaces). For example, to always use the Dutch menus, no | |
4598 matter what $LANG is set to: > | |
4599 :set langmenu=nl_NL.ISO_8859-1 | |
4600 < When 'langmenu' is empty, |v:lang| is used. | |
36 | 4601 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal. |
7 | 4602 If your $LANG is set to a non-English language but you do want to use |
4603 the English menus: > | |
4604 :set langmenu=none | |
4605 < This option must be set before loading menus, switching on filetype | |
4606 detection or syntax highlighting. Once the menus are defined setting | |
4607 this option has no effect. But you could do this: > | |
4608 :source $VIMRUNTIME/delmenu.vim | |
4609 :set langmenu=de_DE.ISO_8859-1 | |
4610 :source $VIMRUNTIME/menu.vim | |
4611 < Warning: This deletes all menus that you defined yourself! | |
4612 | |
7196
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
4613 *'langnoremap'* *'lnr'* *'nolangnoremap'* *'nolnr'* |
9669
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
4614 'langnoremap' 'lnr' boolean (default off, set in |defaults.vim|) |
6339 | 4615 global |
4616 {only available when compiled with the |+langmap| | |
4617 feature} | |
9975
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
4618 This is just like 'langremap' but with the value inverted. It only |
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
4619 exists for backwards compatibility. When setting 'langremap' then |
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
4620 'langnoremap' is set to the inverted value, and the other way around. |
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
4621 |
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
4622 *'langremap'* *'lrm'* *'nolangremap'* *'nolrm'* |
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
4623 'langremap' 'lrm' boolean (default on, reset in |defaults.vim|) |
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
4624 global |
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
4625 {only available when compiled with the |+langmap| |
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
4626 feature} |
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
4627 When off, setting 'langmap' does not apply to characters resulting from |
6339 | 4628 a mapping. This basically means, if you noticed that setting |
9975
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
4629 'langmap' disables some of your mappings, try resetting this option. |
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
4630 This option defaults to on for backwards compatibility. Set it off if |
6339 | 4631 that works for you to avoid mappings to break. |
4632 | |
7 | 4633 *'laststatus'* *'ls'* |
4634 'laststatus' 'ls' number (default 1) | |
4635 global | |
4636 The value of this option influences when the last window will have a | |
4637 status line: | |
4638 0: never | |
4639 1: only if there are at least two windows | |
4640 2: always | |
4641 The screen looks nicer with a status line if you have several | |
4642 windows, but it takes another screen line. |status-line| | |
4643 | |
4644 *'lazyredraw'* *'lz'* *'nolazyredraw'* *'nolz'* | |
4645 'lazyredraw' 'lz' boolean (default off) | |
4646 global | |
4647 When this option is set, the screen will not be redrawn while | |
4648 executing macros, registers and other commands that have not been | |
10 | 4649 typed. Also, updating the window title is postponed. To force an |
7 | 4650 update use |:redraw|. |
4651 | |
4652 *'linebreak'* *'lbr'* *'nolinebreak'* *'nolbr'* | |
4653 'linebreak' 'lbr' boolean (default off) | |
4654 local to window | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
4655 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak| |
7 | 4656 feature} |
6009 | 4657 If on, Vim will wrap long lines at a character in 'breakat' rather |
7 | 4658 than at the last character that fits on the screen. Unlike |
4659 'wrapmargin' and 'textwidth', this does not insert <EOL>s in the file, | |
6009 | 4660 it only affects the way the file is displayed, not its contents. |
4661 If 'breakindent' is set, line is visually indented. Then, the value | |
4662 of 'showbreak' is used to put in front of wrapped lines. This option | |
6026 | 4663 is not used when the 'wrap' option is off. |
7 | 4664 Note that <Tab> characters after an <EOL> are mostly not displayed |
4665 with the right amount of white space. | |
4666 | |
4667 *'lines'* *E593* | |
4668 'lines' number (default 24 or terminal height) | |
4669 global | |
4670 Number of lines of the Vim window. | |
4671 Normally you don't need to set this. It is done automatically by the | |
161 | 4672 terminal initialization code. Also see |posix-screen-size|. |
7 | 4673 When Vim is running in the GUI or in a resizable window, setting this |
4674 option will cause the window size to be changed. When you only want | |
4675 to use the size for the GUI, put the command in your |gvimrc| file. | |
4676 Vim limits the number of lines to what fits on the screen. You can | |
4677 use this command to get the tallest window possible: > | |
4678 :set lines=999 | |
571 | 4679 < Minimum value is 2, maximum value is 1000. |
9887
b4da19b7539f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/dc1f1645cb495fa6bfbe216d7359f23539a0e25d
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9877
diff
changeset
|
4680 If you get fewer lines than expected, check the 'guiheadroom' option. |
7 | 4681 When you set this option and Vim is unable to change the physical |
4682 number of lines of the display, the display may be messed up. | |
4683 | |
4684 *'linespace'* *'lsp'* | |
4685 'linespace' 'lsp' number (default 0, 1 for Win32 GUI) | |
4686 global | |
4687 {only in the GUI} | |
4688 Number of pixel lines inserted between characters. Useful if the font | |
4689 uses the full character cell height, making lines touch each other. | |
4690 When non-zero there is room for underlining. | |
180 | 4691 With some fonts there can be too much room between lines (to have |
4692 space for ascents and descents). Then it makes sense to set | |
4693 'linespace' to a negative value. This may cause display problems | |
4694 though! | |
7 | 4695 |
4696 *'lisp'* *'nolisp'* | |
4697 'lisp' boolean (default off) | |
4698 local to buffer | |
4699 {not available when compiled without the |+lispindent| | |
4700 feature} | |
4701 Lisp mode: When <Enter> is typed in insert mode set the indent for | |
4702 the next line to Lisp standards (well, sort of). Also happens with | |
4703 "cc" or "S". 'autoindent' must also be on for this to work. The 'p' | |
4704 flag in 'cpoptions' changes the method of indenting: Vi compatible or | |
4705 better. Also see 'lispwords'. | |
4706 The '-' character is included in keyword characters. Redefines the | |
4707 "=" operator to use this same indentation algorithm rather than | |
4708 calling an external program if 'equalprg' is empty. | |
4709 This option is not used when 'paste' is set. | |
4710 {Vi: Does it a little bit differently} | |
4711 | |
4712 *'lispwords'* *'lw'* | |
4713 'lispwords' 'lw' string (default is very long) | |
5712 | 4714 global or local to buffer |global-local| |
7 | 4715 {not available when compiled without the |+lispindent| |
4716 feature} | |
4717 Comma separated list of words that influence the Lisp indenting. | |
4718 |'lisp'| | |
4719 | |
4720 *'list'* *'nolist'* | |
4721 'list' boolean (default off) | |
4722 local to window | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4723 List mode: Show tabs as CTRL-I is displayed, display $ after end of |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4724 line. Useful to see the difference between tabs and spaces and for |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4725 trailing blanks. Further changed by the 'listchars' option. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4726 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4727 The cursor is displayed at the start of the space a Tab character |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4728 occupies, not at the end as usual in Normal mode. To get this cursor |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4729 position while displaying Tabs with spaces, use: > |
5161
f7add3891e95
Updated runtime files. Fix NL translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5146
diff
changeset
|
4730 :set list lcs=tab:\ \ |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4731 < |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4732 Note that list mode will also affect formatting (set with 'textwidth' |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4733 or 'wrapmargin') when 'cpoptions' includes 'L'. See 'listchars' for |
7 | 4734 changing the way tabs are displayed. |
4735 | |
4736 *'listchars'* *'lcs'* | |
4737 'listchars' 'lcs' string (default "eol:$") | |
4738 global | |
2458 | 4739 Strings to use in 'list' mode and for the |:list| command. It is a |
4740 comma separated list of string settings. | |
6777 | 4741 *lcs-eol* |
7 | 4742 eol:c Character to show at the end of each line. When |
4743 omitted, there is no extra character at the end of the | |
4744 line. | |
6777 | 4745 *lcs-tab* |
15502
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4746 tab:xy[z] Two or three characters to be used to show a tab. |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4747 The third character is optional. |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4748 |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4749 tab:xy The 'x' is always used, then 'y' as many times as will |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4750 fit. Thus "tab:>-" displays: |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4751 > |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4752 >- |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4753 >-- |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4754 etc. |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4755 |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4756 tab:xyz The 'z' is always used, then 'x' is prepended, and |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4757 then 'y' is used as many times as will fit. Thus |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4758 "tab:<->" displays: |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4759 > |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4760 <> |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4761 <-> |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4762 <--> |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4763 etc. |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4764 |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4765 When "tab:" is omitted, a tab is shown as ^I. |
6777 | 4766 *lcs-space* |
4767 space:c Character to show for a space. When omitted, spaces | |
4768 are left blank. | |
4769 *lcs-trail* | |
10 | 4770 trail:c Character to show for trailing spaces. When omitted, |
6777 | 4771 trailing spaces are blank. Overrides the "space" |
4772 setting for trailing spaces. | |
4773 *lcs-extends* | |
7 | 4774 extends:c Character to show in the last column, when 'wrap' is |
4775 off and the line continues beyond the right of the | |
4776 screen. | |
6777 | 4777 *lcs-precedes* |
7 | 4778 precedes:c Character to show in the first column, when 'wrap' |
4779 is off and there is text preceding the character | |
4780 visible in the first column. | |
6777 | 4781 *lcs-conceal* |
2250
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
4782 conceal:c Character to show in place of concealed text, when |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
4783 'conceallevel' is set to 1. |
6777 | 4784 *lcs-nbsp* |
6801 | 4785 nbsp:c Character to show for a non-breakable space character |
4786 (0xA0 (160 decimal) and U+202F). Left blank when | |
4787 omitted. | |
7 | 4788 |
10 | 4789 The characters ':' and ',' should not be used. UTF-8 characters can |
7 | 4790 be used when 'encoding' is "utf-8", otherwise only printable |
819 | 4791 characters are allowed. All characters must be single width. |
7 | 4792 |
4793 Examples: > | |
4794 :set lcs=tab:>-,trail:- | |
12 | 4795 :set lcs=tab:>-,eol:<,nbsp:% |
7 | 4796 :set lcs=extends:>,precedes:< |
4797 < The "NonText" highlighting will be used for "eol", "extends" and | |
6777 | 4798 "precedes". "SpecialKey" for "nbsp", "space", "tab" and "trail". |
1152 | 4799 |hl-NonText| |hl-SpecialKey| |
7 | 4800 |
4801 *'lpl'* *'nolpl'* *'loadplugins'* *'noloadplugins'* | |
4802 'loadplugins' 'lpl' boolean (default on) | |
4803 global | |
4804 When on the plugin scripts are loaded when starting up |load-plugins|. | |
4805 This option can be reset in your |vimrc| file to disable the loading | |
4806 of plugins. | |
11666
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
4807 Note that using the "-u NONE", "-u DEFAULTS" and "--noplugin" command |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
4808 line arguments reset this option. See |-u| and |--noplugin|. |
7 | 4809 |
7196
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
4810 *'luadll'* |
8629
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
4811 'luadll' string (default depends on the build) |
7528
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
4812 global |
7196
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
4813 {only available when compiled with the |+lua/dyn| |
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
4814 feature} |
7528
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
4815 Specifies the name of the Lua shared library. The default is |
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
4816 DYNAMIC_LUA_DLL, which was specified at compile time. |
8951
0bdeaf7092bc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/aa3b15dbebf333282503d6031e2f9ba6ee4398ed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8876
diff
changeset
|
4817 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. |
7196
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
4818 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
4819 security reasons. |
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
4820 |
842 | 4821 *'macatsui'* *'nomacatsui'* |
4822 'macatsui' boolean (default on) | |
4823 global | |
4824 {only available in Mac GUI version} | |
4825 This is a workaround for when drawing doesn't work properly. When set | |
4826 and compiled with multi-byte support ATSUI text drawing is used. When | |
4827 not set ATSUI text drawing is not used. Switch this option off when | |
4828 you experience drawing problems. In a future version the problems may | |
4829 be solved and this option becomes obsolete. Therefore use this method | |
4830 to unset it: > | |
4831 if exists('&macatsui') | |
4832 set nomacatsui | |
4833 endif | |
1152 | 4834 < Another option to check if you have drawing problems is |
4835 'termencoding'. | |
4836 | |
7 | 4837 *'magic'* *'nomagic'* |
4838 'magic' boolean (default on) | |
4839 global | |
4840 Changes the special characters that can be used in search patterns. | |
4841 See |pattern|. | |
10140
b11ceef7116e
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/64d8e25bf6efe5f18b032563521c3ce278c316ab
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10027
diff
changeset
|
4842 WARNING: Switching this option off most likely breaks plugins! That |
b11ceef7116e
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/64d8e25bf6efe5f18b032563521c3ce278c316ab
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10027
diff
changeset
|
4843 is because many patterns assume it's on and will fail when it's off. |
b11ceef7116e
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/64d8e25bf6efe5f18b032563521c3ce278c316ab
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10027
diff
changeset
|
4844 Only switch it off when working with old Vi scripts. In any other |
b11ceef7116e
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/64d8e25bf6efe5f18b032563521c3ce278c316ab
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10027
diff
changeset
|
4845 situation write patterns that work when 'magic' is on. Include "\M" |
b11ceef7116e
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/64d8e25bf6efe5f18b032563521c3ce278c316ab
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10027
diff
changeset
|
4846 when you want to |/\M|. |
7 | 4847 |
4848 *'makeef'* *'mef'* | |
4849 'makeef' 'mef' string (default: "") | |
4850 global | |
4851 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix| | |
4852 feature} | |
4853 Name of the errorfile for the |:make| command (see |:make_makeprg|) | |
4854 and the |:grep| command. | |
4855 When it is empty, an internally generated temp file will be used. | |
4856 When "##" is included, it is replaced by a number to make the name | |
4857 unique. This makes sure that the ":make" command doesn't overwrite an | |
4858 existing file. | |
4859 NOT used for the ":cf" command. See 'errorfile' for that. | |
4860 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. | |
4861 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes. | |
4862 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
4863 security reasons. | |
4864 | |
11063
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4865 *'makeencoding'* *'menc'* |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4866 'makeencoding' 'menc' string (default "") |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4867 global or local to buffer |global-local| |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4868 Encoding used for reading the output of external commands. When empty, |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4869 encoding is not converted. |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4870 This is used for `:make`, `:lmake`, `:grep`, `:lgrep`, `:grepadd`, |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4871 `:lgrepadd`, `:cfile`, `:cgetfile`, `:caddfile`, `:lfile`, `:lgetfile`, |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4872 and `:laddfile`. |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4873 |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4874 This would be mostly useful when you use MS-Windows and set 'encoding' |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4875 to "utf-8". If |+iconv| is enabled and GNU libiconv is used, setting |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4876 'makeencoding' to "char" has the same effect as setting to the system |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4877 locale encoding. Example: > |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4878 :set encoding=utf-8 |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4879 :set makeencoding=char " system locale is used |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4880 < |
7 | 4881 *'makeprg'* *'mp'* |
4882 'makeprg' 'mp' string (default "make", VMS: "MMS") | |
4883 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
1152 | 4884 Program to use for the ":make" command. See |:make_makeprg|. |
13341
acd7eaa13d2b
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13314
diff
changeset
|
4885 This option may contain '%' and '#' characters (see |:_%| and |:_#|), |
acd7eaa13d2b
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13314
diff
changeset
|
4886 which are expanded to the current and alternate file name. Use |::S| |
5690 | 4887 to escape file names in case they contain special characters. |
1152 | 4888 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See |option-backslash| |
4889 about including spaces and backslashes. | |
4890 Note that a '|' must be escaped twice: once for ":set" and once for | |
4891 the interpretation of a command. When you use a filter called | |
4892 "myfilter" do it like this: > | |
7 | 4893 :set makeprg=gmake\ \\\|\ myfilter |
4894 < The placeholder "$*" can be given (even multiple times) to specify | |
4895 where the arguments will be included, for example: > | |
4896 :set makeprg=latex\ \\\\nonstopmode\ \\\\input\\{$*} | |
4897 < This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
4898 security reasons. | |
4899 | |
4900 *'matchpairs'* *'mps'* | |
4901 'matchpairs' 'mps' string (default "(:),{:},[:]") | |
4902 local to buffer | |
4903 Characters that form pairs. The |%| command jumps from one to the | |
4073 | 4904 other. |
4905 Only character pairs are allowed that are different, thus you cannot | |
4906 jump between two double quotes. | |
4907 The characters must be separated by a colon. | |
1152 | 4908 The pairs must be separated by a comma. Example for including '<' and |
4909 '>' (HTML): > | |
7 | 4910 :set mps+=<:> |
4911 | |
4912 < A more exotic example, to jump between the '=' and ';' in an | |
4913 assignment, useful for languages like C and Java: > | |
4914 :au FileType c,cpp,java set mps+==:; | |
4915 | |
4916 < For a more advanced way of using "%", see the matchit.vim plugin in | |
12756
3b26420fc639
Long overdue runtime update.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12744
diff
changeset
|
4917 the $VIMRUNTIME/pack/dist/opt/matchit directory. |add-local-help| |
7 | 4918 |
4919 *'matchtime'* *'mat'* | |
4920 'matchtime' 'mat' number (default 5) | |
4921 global | |
16443
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
4922 {in Nvi} |
7 | 4923 Tenths of a second to show the matching paren, when 'showmatch' is |
4924 set. Note that this is not in milliseconds, like other options that | |
4925 set a time. This is to be compatible with Nvi. | |
4926 | |
714 | 4927 *'maxcombine'* *'mco'* |
4928 'maxcombine' 'mco' number (default 2) | |
4929 global | |
4930 The maximum number of combining characters supported for displaying. | |
4931 Only used when 'encoding' is "utf-8". | |
4932 The default is OK for most languages. Hebrew may require 4. | |
4933 Maximum value is 6. | |
4934 Even when this option is set to 2 you can still edit text with more | |
4935 combining characters, you just can't see them. Use |g8| or |ga|. | |
4936 See |mbyte-combining|. | |
4937 | |
7 | 4938 *'maxfuncdepth'* *'mfd'* |
4939 'maxfuncdepth' 'mfd' number (default 100) | |
4940 global | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
4941 {not available when compiled without the |+eval| |
1152 | 4942 feature} |
7 | 4943 Maximum depth of function calls for user functions. This normally |
4944 catches endless recursion. When using a recursive function with | |
4945 more depth, set 'maxfuncdepth' to a bigger number. But this will use | |
4946 more memory, there is the danger of failing when memory is exhausted. | |
10498
883396809b45
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/bc2eada5424bff06f7eb77c032ecc067da52b846
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10449
diff
changeset
|
4947 Increasing this limit above 200 also changes the maximum for Ex |
14006 | 4948 command recursion, see |E169|. |
7 | 4949 See also |:function|. |
4950 | |
4951 *'maxmapdepth'* *'mmd'* *E223* | |
4952 'maxmapdepth' 'mmd' number (default 1000) | |
4953 global | |
4954 Maximum number of times a mapping is done without resulting in a | |
4955 character to be used. This normally catches endless mappings, like | |
4956 ":map x y" with ":map y x". It still does not catch ":map g wg", | |
4957 because the 'w' is used before the next mapping is done. See also | |
4958 |key-mapping|. | |
4959 | |
4960 *'maxmem'* *'mm'* | |
4961 'maxmem' 'mm' number (default between 256 to 5120 (system | |
4962 dependent) or half the amount of memory | |
4963 available) | |
4964 global | |
4965 Maximum amount of memory (in Kbyte) to use for one buffer. When this | |
4966 limit is reached allocating extra memory for a buffer will cause | |
13314
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
4967 other memory to be freed. |
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
4968 The maximum usable value is about 2000000. Use this to work without a |
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
4969 limit. |
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
4970 The value is ignored when 'swapfile' is off. |
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
4971 Also see 'maxmemtot'. |
7 | 4972 |
189 | 4973 *'maxmempattern'* *'mmp'* |
4974 'maxmempattern' 'mmp' number (default 1000) | |
4975 global | |
4976 Maximum amount of memory (in Kbyte) to use for pattern matching. | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4977 The maximum value is about 2000000. Use this to work without a limit. |
189 | 4978 *E363* |
1152 | 4979 When Vim runs into the limit it gives an error message and mostly |
4980 behaves like CTRL-C was typed. | |
189 | 4981 Running into the limit often means that the pattern is very |
4982 inefficient or too complex. This may already happen with the pattern | |
4983 "\(.\)*" on a very long line. ".*" works much better. | |
14298
4a588e3afd4a
Update runtime files, add Danish translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14249
diff
changeset
|
4984 Might also happen on redraw, when syntax rules try to match a complex |
4a588e3afd4a
Update runtime files, add Danish translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14249
diff
changeset
|
4985 text structure. |
4a588e3afd4a
Update runtime files, add Danish translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14249
diff
changeset
|
4986 Vim may run out of memory before hitting the 'maxmempattern' limit, in |
4a588e3afd4a
Update runtime files, add Danish translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14249
diff
changeset
|
4987 which case you get an "Out of memory" error instead. |
189 | 4988 |
7 | 4989 *'maxmemtot'* *'mmt'* |
4990 'maxmemtot' 'mmt' number (default between 2048 and 10240 (system | |
4991 dependent) or half the amount of memory | |
4992 available) | |
4993 global | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4994 Maximum amount of memory in Kbyte to use for all buffers together. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4995 The maximum usable value is about 2000000 (2 Gbyte). Use this to work |
7477
05cf4cc72a9f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/fa7353428f705f7a13465a1943dddeede4083023
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7272
diff
changeset
|
4996 without a limit. |
05cf4cc72a9f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/fa7353428f705f7a13465a1943dddeede4083023
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7272
diff
changeset
|
4997 On 64 bit machines higher values might work. But hey, do you really |
05cf4cc72a9f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/fa7353428f705f7a13465a1943dddeede4083023
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7272
diff
changeset
|
4998 need more than 2 Gbyte for text editing? Keep in mind that text is |
8951
0bdeaf7092bc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/aa3b15dbebf333282503d6031e2f9ba6ee4398ed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8876
diff
changeset
|
4999 stored in the swap file, one can edit files > 2 Gbyte anyway. We do |
7477
05cf4cc72a9f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/fa7353428f705f7a13465a1943dddeede4083023
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7272
diff
changeset
|
5000 need the memory to store undo info. |
13314
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
5001 Buffers with 'swapfile' off still count to the total amount of memory |
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
5002 used. |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
5003 Also see 'maxmem'. |
7 | 5004 |
5005 *'menuitems'* *'mis'* | |
5006 'menuitems' 'mis' number (default 25) | |
5007 global | |
5008 {not available when compiled without the |+menu| | |
5009 feature} | |
5010 Maximum number of items to use in a menu. Used for menus that are | |
5011 generated from a list of items, e.g., the Buffers menu. Changing this | |
5012 option has no direct effect, the menu must be refreshed first. | |
5013 | |
484 | 5014 *'mkspellmem'* *'msm'* |
5015 'mkspellmem' 'msm' string (default "460000,2000,500") | |
5016 global | |
5017 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| | |
5018 feature} | |
5019 Parameters for |:mkspell|. This tunes when to start compressing the | |
5020 word tree. Compression can be slow when there are many words, but | |
5021 it's needed to avoid running out of memory. The amount of memory used | |
5022 per word depends very much on how similar the words are, that's why | |
5023 this tuning is complicated. | |
5024 | |
5025 There are three numbers, separated by commas: | |
5026 {start},{inc},{added} | |
5027 | |
5028 For most languages the uncompressed word tree fits in memory. {start} | |
5029 gives the amount of memory in Kbyte that can be used before any | |
5030 compression is done. It should be a bit smaller than the amount of | |
5031 memory that is available to Vim. | |
5032 | |
5033 When going over the {start} limit the {inc} number specifies the | |
5034 amount of memory in Kbyte that can be allocated before another | |
5035 compression is done. A low number means compression is done after | |
5036 less words are added, which is slow. A high number means more memory | |
5037 will be allocated. | |
5038 | |
5039 After doing compression, {added} times 1024 words can be added before | |
5040 the {inc} limit is ignored and compression is done when any extra | |
5041 amount of memory is needed. A low number means there is a smaller | |
5042 chance of hitting the {inc} limit, less memory is used but it's | |
5043 slower. | |
5044 | |
5045 The languages for which these numbers are important are Italian and | |
5046 Hungarian. The default works for when you have about 512 Mbyte. If | |
5047 you have 1 Gbyte you could use: > | |
5048 :set mkspellmem=900000,3000,800 | |
5049 < If you have less than 512 Mbyte |:mkspell| may fail for some | |
5050 languages, no matter what you set 'mkspellmem' to. | |
5051 | |
7 | 5052 *'modeline'* *'ml'* *'nomodeline'* *'noml'* |
1111 | 5053 'modeline' 'ml' boolean (Vim default: on (off for root), |
5054 Vi default: off) | |
7 | 5055 local to buffer |
5056 *'modelines'* *'mls'* | |
5057 'modelines' 'mls' number (default 5) | |
5058 global | |
5059 If 'modeline' is on 'modelines' gives the number of lines that is | |
5060 checked for set commands. If 'modeline' is off or 'modelines' is zero | |
5061 no lines are checked. See |modeline|. | |
5062 NOTE: 'modeline' is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is | |
5063 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
5064 | |
5065 *'modifiable'* *'ma'* *'nomodifiable'* *'noma'* | |
5066 'modifiable' 'ma' boolean (default on) | |
5067 local to buffer | |
16443
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
5068 *E21* |
7 | 5069 When off the buffer contents cannot be changed. The 'fileformat' and |
5070 'fileencoding' options also can't be changed. | |
10617 | 5071 Can be reset on startup with the |-M| command line argument. |
7 | 5072 |
5073 *'modified'* *'mod'* *'nomodified'* *'nomod'* | |
5074 'modified' 'mod' boolean (default off) | |
5075 local to buffer | |
5076 When on, the buffer is considered to be modified. This option is set | |
5077 when: | |
5078 1. A change was made to the text since it was last written. Using the | |
5079 |undo| command to go back to the original text will reset the | |
5080 option. But undoing changes that were made before writing the | |
5081 buffer will set the option again, since the text is different from | |
5082 when it was written. | |
5083 2. 'fileformat' or 'fileencoding' is different from its original | |
5084 value. The original value is set when the buffer is read or | |
5085 written. A ":set nomodified" command also resets the original | |
5086 values to the current values and the 'modified' option will be | |
5087 reset. | |
8748
b1a19a2f73f0
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/4f3f668c8486444e53163c29d2fc79bf47eb3c82
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8629
diff
changeset
|
5088 Similarly for 'eol' and 'bomb'. |
3082 | 5089 This option is not set when a change is made to the buffer as the |
5090 result of a BufNewFile, BufRead/BufReadPost, BufWritePost, | |
5091 FileAppendPost or VimLeave autocommand event. See |gzip-example| for | |
5092 an explanation. | |
7 | 5093 When 'buftype' is "nowrite" or "nofile" this option may be set, but |
5094 will be ignored. | |
13437 | 5095 Note that the text may actually be the same, e.g. 'modified' is set |
5096 when using "rA" on an "A". | |
7 | 5097 |
5098 *'more'* *'nomore'* | |
5099 'more' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off) | |
5100 global | |
5101 When on, listings pause when the whole screen is filled. You will get | |
5102 the |more-prompt|. When this option is off there are no pauses, the | |
5103 listing continues until finished. | |
5104 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is | |
5105 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
5106 | |
5107 *'mouse'* *E538* | |
9669
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
5108 'mouse' string (default "", "a" for GUI, MS-DOS and Win32, |
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
5109 set to "a" in |defaults.vim|) |
7 | 5110 global |
5111 Enable the use of the mouse. Only works for certain terminals | |
1621 | 5112 (xterm, MS-DOS, Win32 |win32-mouse|, QNX pterm, *BSD console with |
5113 sysmouse and Linux console with gpm). For using the mouse in the | |
5114 GUI, see |gui-mouse|. | |
7 | 5115 The mouse can be enabled for different modes: |
12826 | 5116 n Normal mode and Terminal modes |
7 | 5117 v Visual mode |
5118 i Insert mode | |
5119 c Command-line mode | |
5120 h all previous modes when editing a help file | |
5121 a all previous modes | |
5122 r for |hit-enter| and |more-prompt| prompt | |
14864 | 5123 Normally you would enable the mouse in all five modes with: > |
7 | 5124 :set mouse=a |
5125 < When the mouse is not enabled, the GUI will still use the mouse for | |
5126 modeless selection. This doesn't move the text cursor. | |
5127 | |
5128 See |mouse-using|. Also see |'clipboard'|. | |
5129 | |
5130 Note: When enabling the mouse in a terminal, copy/paste will use the | |
10 | 5131 "* register if there is access to an X-server. The xterm handling of |
7 | 5132 the mouse buttons can still be used by keeping the shift key pressed. |
5133 Also see the 'clipboard' option. | |
5134 | |
5135 *'mousefocus'* *'mousef'* *'nomousefocus'* *'nomousef'* | |
5136 'mousefocus' 'mousef' boolean (default off) | |
5137 global | |
5138 {only works in the GUI} | |
5139 The window that the mouse pointer is on is automatically activated. | |
5140 When changing the window layout or window focus in another way, the | |
5141 mouse pointer is moved to the window with keyboard focus. Off is the | |
5142 default because it makes using the pull down menus a little goofy, as | |
5143 a pointer transit may activate a window unintentionally. | |
5144 | |
5145 *'mousehide'* *'mh'* *'nomousehide'* *'nomh'* | |
5146 'mousehide' 'mh' boolean (default on) | |
5147 global | |
5148 {only works in the GUI} | |
5149 When on, the mouse pointer is hidden when characters are typed. | |
5150 The mouse pointer is restored when the mouse is moved. | |
5151 | |
5152 *'mousemodel'* *'mousem'* | |
5153 'mousemodel' 'mousem' string (default "extend", "popup" for MS-DOS and Win32) | |
5154 global | |
5155 Sets the model to use for the mouse. The name mostly specifies what | |
5156 the right mouse button is used for: | |
5157 extend Right mouse button extends a selection. This works | |
5158 like in an xterm. | |
5159 popup Right mouse button pops up a menu. The shifted left | |
5160 mouse button extends a selection. This works like | |
233 | 5161 with Microsoft Windows. |
7 | 5162 popup_setpos Like "popup", but the cursor will be moved to the |
5163 position where the mouse was clicked, and thus the | |
5164 selected operation will act upon the clicked object. | |
5165 If clicking inside a selection, that selection will | |
233 | 5166 be acted upon, i.e. no cursor move. This implies of |
7 | 5167 course, that right clicking outside a selection will |
5168 end Visual mode. | |
5169 Overview of what button does what for each model: | |
5170 mouse extend popup(_setpos) ~ | |
5171 left click place cursor place cursor | |
5172 left drag start selection start selection | |
5173 shift-left search word extend selection | |
5174 right click extend selection popup menu (place cursor) | |
5175 right drag extend selection - | |
5176 middle click paste paste | |
5177 | |
5178 In the "popup" model the right mouse button produces a pop-up menu. | |
5179 You need to define this first, see |popup-menu|. | |
13437 | 5180 In a terminal the popup menu works if Vim is compiled with the |
5181 |+insert_expand| option. | |
7 | 5182 |
5183 Note that you can further refine the meaning of buttons with mappings. | |
5184 See |gui-mouse-mapping|. But mappings are NOT used for modeless | |
5185 selection (because that's handled in the GUI code directly). | |
5186 | |
5187 The 'mousemodel' option is set by the |:behave| command. | |
5188 | |
5189 *'mouseshape'* *'mouses'* *E547* | |
15932 | 5190 'mouseshape' 'mouses' string (default "i-r:beam,s:updown,sd:udsizing, |
5191 vs:leftright,vd:lrsizing,m:no, | |
5192 ml:up-arrow,v:rightup-arrow") | |
7 | 5193 global |
5194 {only available when compiled with the |+mouseshape| | |
5195 feature} | |
5196 This option tells Vim what the mouse pointer should look like in | |
5197 different modes. The option is a comma separated list of parts, much | |
5198 like used for 'guicursor'. Each part consist of a mode/location-list | |
5199 and an argument-list: | |
5200 mode-list:shape,mode-list:shape,.. | |
5201 The mode-list is a dash separated list of these modes/locations: | |
5202 In a normal window: ~ | |
5203 n Normal mode | |
5204 v Visual mode | |
5205 ve Visual mode with 'selection' "exclusive" (same as 'v', | |
5206 if not specified) | |
5207 o Operator-pending mode | |
5208 i Insert mode | |
5209 r Replace mode | |
5210 | |
5211 Others: ~ | |
5212 c appending to the command-line | |
5213 ci inserting in the command-line | |
5214 cr replacing in the command-line | |
5215 m at the 'Hit ENTER' or 'More' prompts | |
5216 ml idem, but cursor in the last line | |
5217 e any mode, pointer below last window | |
5218 s any mode, pointer on a status line | |
5219 sd any mode, while dragging a status line | |
5220 vs any mode, pointer on a vertical separator line | |
5221 vd any mode, while dragging a vertical separator line | |
5222 a everywhere | |
5223 | |
5224 The shape is one of the following: | |
5225 avail name looks like ~ | |
5226 w x arrow Normal mouse pointer | |
5227 w x blank no pointer at all (use with care!) | |
5228 w x beam I-beam | |
5229 w x updown up-down sizing arrows | |
5230 w x leftright left-right sizing arrows | |
5231 w x busy The system's usual busy pointer | |
5232 w x no The system's usual 'no input' pointer | |
5233 x udsizing indicates up-down resizing | |
5234 x lrsizing indicates left-right resizing | |
5235 x crosshair like a big thin + | |
5236 x hand1 black hand | |
5237 x hand2 white hand | |
5238 x pencil what you write with | |
5239 x question big ? | |
5240 x rightup-arrow arrow pointing right-up | |
5241 w x up-arrow arrow pointing up | |
5242 x <number> any X11 pointer number (see X11/cursorfont.h) | |
5243 | |
5244 The "avail" column contains a 'w' if the shape is available for Win32, | |
5245 x for X11. | |
5246 Any modes not specified or shapes not available use the normal mouse | |
5247 pointer. | |
5248 | |
5249 Example: > | |
5250 :set mouseshape=s:udsizing,m:no | |
5251 < will make the mouse turn to a sizing arrow over the status lines and | |
5252 indicate no input when the hit-enter prompt is displayed (since | |
5253 clicking the mouse has no effect in this state.) | |
5254 | |
5255 *'mousetime'* *'mouset'* | |
5256 'mousetime' 'mouset' number (default 500) | |
5257 global | |
5258 Only for GUI, MS-DOS, Win32 and Unix with xterm. Defines the maximum | |
5259 time in msec between two mouse clicks for the second click to be | |
5260 recognized as a multi click. | |
5261 | |
12608
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5262 *'mzschemedll'* |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5263 'mzschemedll' string (default depends on the build) |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5264 global |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5265 {only available when compiled with the |+mzscheme/dyn| |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5266 feature} |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5267 Specifies the name of the MzScheme shared library. The default is |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5268 DYNAMIC_MZSCH_DLL which was specified at compile time. |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5269 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. |
12785 | 5270 The value must be set in the |vimrc| script or earlier. In the |
12756
3b26420fc639
Long overdue runtime update.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12744
diff
changeset
|
5271 startup, before the |load-plugins| step. |
12608
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5272 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5273 security reasons. |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5274 |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5275 *'mzschemegcdll'* |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5276 'mzschemegcdll' string (default depends on the build) |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5277 global |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5278 {only available when compiled with the |+mzscheme/dyn| |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5279 feature} |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5280 Specifies the name of the MzScheme GC shared library. The default is |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5281 DYNAMIC_MZGC_DLL which was specified at compile time. |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5282 The value can be equal to 'mzschemedll' if it includes the GC code. |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5283 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5284 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5285 security reasons. |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5286 |
14 | 5287 *'mzquantum'* *'mzq'* |
5288 'mzquantum' 'mzq' number (default 100) | |
5289 global | |
5290 {not available when compiled without the |+mzscheme| | |
5291 feature} | |
5292 The number of milliseconds between polls for MzScheme threads. | |
5293 Negative or zero value means no thread scheduling. | |
11160 | 5294 NOTE: This option is set to the Vim default value when 'compatible' |
5295 is reset. | |
14 | 5296 |
7 | 5297 *'nrformats'* *'nf'* |
9669
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
5298 'nrformats' 'nf' string (default "bin,octal,hex", |
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
5299 set to "bin,hex" in |defaults.vim|) |
7 | 5300 local to buffer |
5301 This defines what bases Vim will consider for numbers when using the | |
5302 CTRL-A and CTRL-X commands for adding to and subtracting from a number | |
5303 respectively; see |CTRL-A| for more info on these commands. | |
625 | 5304 alpha If included, single alphabetical characters will be |
7 | 5305 incremented or decremented. This is useful for a list with a |
8629
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
5306 letter index a), b), etc. *octal-nrformats* |
625 | 5307 octal If included, numbers that start with a zero will be considered |
7 | 5308 to be octal. Example: Using CTRL-A on "007" results in "010". |
625 | 5309 hex If included, numbers starting with "0x" or "0X" will be |
7 | 5310 considered to be hexadecimal. Example: Using CTRL-X on |
5311 "0x100" results in "0x0ff". | |
7528
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
5312 bin If included, numbers starting with "0b" or "0B" will be |
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
5313 considered to be binary. Example: Using CTRL-X on |
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
5314 "0b1000" subtracts one, resulting in "0b0111". |
7 | 5315 Numbers which simply begin with a digit in the range 1-9 are always |
5316 considered decimal. This also happens for numbers that are not | |
5317 recognized as octal or hex. | |
5318 | |
5319 *'number'* *'nu'* *'nonumber'* *'nonu'* | |
5320 'number' 'nu' boolean (default off) | |
5321 local to window | |
5322 Print the line number in front of each line. When the 'n' option is | |
5323 excluded from 'cpoptions' a wrapped line will not use the column of | |
5324 line numbers (this is the default when 'compatible' isn't set). | |
13 | 5325 The 'numberwidth' option can be used to set the room used for the line |
5326 number. | |
7 | 5327 When a long, wrapped line doesn't start with the first character, '-' |
5328 characters are put before the number. | |
3445 | 5329 See |hl-LineNr| and |hl-CursorLineNr| for the highlighting used for |
5330 the number. | |
4780 | 5331 *number_relativenumber* |
5332 The 'relativenumber' option changes the displayed number to be | |
5333 relative to the cursor. Together with 'number' there are these | |
5334 four combinations (cursor in line 3): | |
5335 | |
8629
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
5336 'nonu' 'nu' 'nonu' 'nu' |
4780 | 5337 'nornu' 'nornu' 'rnu' 'rnu' |
5338 | |
5339 |apple | 1 apple | 2 apple | 2 apple | |
5340 |pear | 2 pear | 1 pear | 1 pear | |
5341 |nobody | 3 nobody | 0 nobody |3 nobody | |
5342 |there | 4 there | 1 there | 1 there | |
7 | 5343 |
13 | 5344 *'numberwidth'* *'nuw'* |
5345 'numberwidth' 'nuw' number (Vim default: 4 Vi default: 8) | |
5346 local to window | |
14 | 5347 {only available when compiled with the |+linebreak| |
5348 feature} | |
13 | 5349 Minimal number of columns to use for the line number. Only relevant |
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5350 when the 'number' or 'relativenumber' option is set or printing lines |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5351 with a line number. Since one space is always between the number and |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5352 the text, there is one less character for the number itself. |
13 | 5353 The value is the minimum width. A bigger width is used when needed to |
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5354 fit the highest line number in the buffer respectively the number of |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5355 rows in the window, depending on whether 'number' or 'relativenumber' |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5356 is set. Thus with the Vim default of 4 there is room for a line number |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5357 up to 999. When the buffer has 1000 lines five columns will be used. |
13 | 5358 The minimum value is 1, the maximum value is 10. |
11160 | 5359 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is |
5360 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
13 | 5361 |
523 | 5362 *'omnifunc'* *'ofu'* |
5363 'omnifunc' 'ofu' string (default: empty) | |
502 | 5364 local to buffer |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
5365 {not available when compiled without the |+eval| |
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
5366 or |+insert_expand| features} |
623 | 5367 This option specifies a function to be used for Insert mode omni |
5368 completion with CTRL-X CTRL-O. |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-O| | |
648 | 5369 See |complete-functions| for an explanation of how the function is |
5370 invoked and what it should return. | |
1004 | 5371 This option is usually set by a filetype plugin: |
859 | 5372 |:filetype-plugin-on| |
3682 | 5373 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
5374 security reasons. | |
502 | 5375 |
5376 | |
1152 | 5377 *'opendevice'* *'odev'* *'noopendevice'* *'noodev'* |
1004 | 5378 'opendevice' 'odev' boolean (default off) |
5379 global | |
5380 {only for MS-DOS, MS-Windows and OS/2} | |
5381 Enable reading and writing from devices. This may get Vim stuck on a | |
5382 device that can be opened but doesn't actually do the I/O. Therefore | |
5383 it is off by default. | |
5384 Note that on MS-Windows editing "aux.h", "lpt1.txt" and the like also | |
5385 result in editing a device. | |
5386 | |
5387 | |
593 | 5388 *'operatorfunc'* *'opfunc'* |
5389 'operatorfunc' 'opfunc' string (default: empty) | |
5390 global | |
5391 This option specifies a function to be called by the |g@| operator. | |
5392 See |:map-operator| for more info and an example. | |
5393 | |
5394 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
5395 security reasons. | |
5396 | |
5397 | |
2908 | 5398 *'osfiletype'* *'oft'* |
5399 'osfiletype' 'oft' string (default: "") | |
7 | 5400 local to buffer |
2908 | 5401 This option was supported on RISC OS, which has been removed. |
5402 | |
7 | 5403 |
8182
95d59081580f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/f6fee0e2d4341c0c2f5339c1268e5877fafd07cf
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8148
diff
changeset
|
5404 *'packpath'* *'pp'* |
95d59081580f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/f6fee0e2d4341c0c2f5339c1268e5877fafd07cf
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8148
diff
changeset
|
5405 'packpath' 'pp' string (default: see 'runtimepath') |
95d59081580f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/f6fee0e2d4341c0c2f5339c1268e5877fafd07cf
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8148
diff
changeset
|
5406 Directories used to find packages. See |packages|. |
95d59081580f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/f6fee0e2d4341c0c2f5339c1268e5877fafd07cf
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8148
diff
changeset
|
5407 |
95d59081580f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/f6fee0e2d4341c0c2f5339c1268e5877fafd07cf
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8148
diff
changeset
|
5408 |
7 | 5409 *'paragraphs'* *'para'* |
1564 | 5410 'paragraphs' 'para' string (default "IPLPPPQPP TPHPLIPpLpItpplpipbp") |
7 | 5411 global |
5412 Specifies the nroff macros that separate paragraphs. These are pairs | |
5413 of two letters (see |object-motions|). | |
5414 | |
5415 *'paste'* *'nopaste'* | |
5416 'paste' boolean (default off) | |
5417 global | |
10 | 5418 Put Vim in Paste mode. This is useful if you want to cut or copy |
5419 some text from one window and paste it in Vim. This will avoid | |
7 | 5420 unexpected effects. |
5421 Setting this option is useful when using Vim in a terminal, where Vim | |
10 | 5422 cannot distinguish between typed text and pasted text. In the GUI, Vim |
7 | 5423 knows about pasting and will mostly do the right thing without 'paste' |
5424 being set. The same is true for a terminal where Vim handles the | |
5425 mouse clicks itself. | |
148 | 5426 This option is reset when starting the GUI. Thus if you set it in |
5427 your .vimrc it will work in a terminal, but not in the GUI. Setting | |
5428 'paste' in the GUI has side effects: e.g., the Paste toolbar button | |
5429 will no longer work in Insert mode, because it uses a mapping. | |
7 | 5430 When the 'paste' option is switched on (also when it was already on): |
5431 - mapping in Insert mode and Command-line mode is disabled | |
5432 - abbreviations are disabled | |
5433 - 'autoindent' is reset | |
7147
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
5434 - 'expandtab' is reset |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
5435 - 'formatoptions' is used like it is empty |
7 | 5436 - 'revins' is reset |
5437 - 'ruler' is reset | |
5438 - 'showmatch' is reset | |
7147
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
5439 - 'smartindent' is reset |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
5440 - 'smarttab' is reset |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
5441 - 'softtabstop' is set to 0 |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
5442 - 'textwidth' is set to 0 |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
5443 - 'wrapmargin' is set to 0 |
7 | 5444 These options keep their value, but their effect is disabled: |
7147
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
5445 - 'cindent' |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
5446 - 'indentexpr' |
7 | 5447 - 'lisp' |
5448 NOTE: When you start editing another file while the 'paste' option is | |
5449 on, settings from the modelines or autocommands may change the | |
5450 settings again, causing trouble when pasting text. You might want to | |
5451 set the 'paste' option again. | |
5452 When the 'paste' option is reset the mentioned options are restored to | |
5453 the value before the moment 'paste' was switched from off to on. | |
5454 Resetting 'paste' before ever setting it does not have any effect. | |
5455 Since mapping doesn't work while 'paste' is active, you need to use | |
5456 the 'pastetoggle' option to toggle the 'paste' option with some key. | |
5457 | |
5458 *'pastetoggle'* *'pt'* | |
5459 'pastetoggle' 'pt' string (default "") | |
5460 global | |
5461 When non-empty, specifies the key sequence that toggles the 'paste' | |
5462 option. This is like specifying a mapping: > | |
5463 :map {keys} :set invpaste<CR> | |
5464 < Where {keys} is the value of 'pastetoggle'. | |
5465 The difference is that it will work even when 'paste' is set. | |
5466 'pastetoggle' works in Insert mode and Normal mode, but not in | |
5467 Command-line mode. | |
5468 Mappings are checked first, thus overrule 'pastetoggle'. However, | |
5469 when 'paste' is on mappings are ignored in Insert mode, thus you can do | |
5470 this: > | |
5471 :map <F10> :set paste<CR> | |
5472 :map <F11> :set nopaste<CR> | |
5473 :imap <F10> <C-O>:set paste<CR> | |
5474 :imap <F11> <nop> | |
5475 :set pastetoggle=<F11> | |
5476 < This will make <F10> start paste mode and <F11> stop paste mode. | |
5477 Note that typing <F10> in paste mode inserts "<F10>", since in paste | |
5478 mode everything is inserted literally, except the 'pastetoggle' key | |
5479 sequence. | |
1621 | 5480 When the value has several bytes 'ttimeoutlen' applies. |
7 | 5481 |
5482 *'pex'* *'patchexpr'* | |
5483 'patchexpr' 'pex' string (default "") | |
5484 global | |
5485 {not available when compiled without the |+diff| | |
5486 feature} | |
5487 Expression which is evaluated to apply a patch to a file and generate | |
10 | 5488 the resulting new version of the file. See |diff-patchexpr|. |
7 | 5489 |
6091
7090d7f160f7
Update runtime files. Add vroom file support.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
6032
diff
changeset
|
5490 *'patchmode'* *'pm'* *E205* *E206* |
7 | 5491 'patchmode' 'pm' string (default "") |
5492 global | |
5493 When non-empty the oldest version of a file is kept. This can be used | |
5494 to keep the original version of a file if you are changing files in a | |
5495 source distribution. Only the first time that a file is written a | |
5496 copy of the original file will be kept. The name of the copy is the | |
5497 name of the original file with the string in the 'patchmode' option | |
5498 appended. This option should start with a dot. Use a string like | |
13100
656ab57d1ddc
update a few runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13051
diff
changeset
|
5499 ".orig" or ".org". 'backupdir' must not be empty for this to work |
656ab57d1ddc
update a few runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13051
diff
changeset
|
5500 (Detail: The backup file is renamed to the patchmode file after the |
656ab57d1ddc
update a few runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13051
diff
changeset
|
5501 new file has been successfully written, that's why it must be possible |
656ab57d1ddc
update a few runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13051
diff
changeset
|
5502 to write a backup file). If there was no file to be backed up, an |
656ab57d1ddc
update a few runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13051
diff
changeset
|
5503 empty file is created. |
7 | 5504 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a patchmode file is not made. |
5505 Using 'patchmode' for compressed files appends the extension at the | |
5506 end (e.g., "file.gz.orig"), thus the resulting name isn't always | |
5507 recognized as a compressed file. | |
36 | 5508 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal. |
7 | 5509 |
3224 | 5510 *'path'* *'pa'* *E343* *E345* *E347* *E854* |
7 | 5511 'path' 'pa' string (default on Unix: ".,/usr/include,," |
5512 on OS/2: ".,/emx/include,," | |
5513 other systems: ".,,") | |
5514 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
5515 This is a list of directories which will be searched when using the | |
1668 | 5516 |gf|, [f, ]f, ^Wf, |:find|, |:sfind|, |:tabfind| and other commands, |
5517 provided that the file being searched for has a relative path (not | |
5518 starting with "/", "./" or "../"). The directories in the 'path' | |
5519 option may be relative or absolute. | |
7 | 5520 - Use commas to separate directory names: > |
5521 :set path=.,/usr/local/include,/usr/include | |
5522 < - Spaces can also be used to separate directory names (for backwards | |
5523 compatibility with version 3.0). To have a space in a directory | |
5524 name, precede it with an extra backslash, and escape the space: > | |
5525 :set path=.,/dir/with\\\ space | |
5526 < - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with an extra | |
5527 backslash: > | |
5528 :set path=.,/dir/with\\,comma | |
5529 < - To search relative to the directory of the current file, use: > | |
5530 :set path=. | |
5531 < - To search in the current directory use an empty string between two | |
5532 commas: > | |
5533 :set path=,, | |
5534 < - A directory name may end in a ':' or '/'. | |
5535 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. | |
5536 - When using |netrw.vim| URLs can be used. For example, adding | |
5537 "http://www.vim.org" will make ":find index.html" work. | |
1668 | 5538 - Search upwards and downwards in a directory tree using "*", "**" and |
5539 ";". See |file-searching| for info and syntax. | |
7 | 5540 {not available when compiled without the |+path_extra| feature} |
5541 - Careful with '\' characters, type two to get one in the option: > | |
5542 :set path=.,c:\\include | |
5543 < Or just use '/' instead: > | |
5544 :set path=.,c:/include | |
5545 < Don't forget "." or files won't even be found in the same directory as | |
5546 the file! | |
10 | 5547 The maximum length is limited. How much depends on the system, mostly |
7 | 5548 it is something like 256 or 1024 characters. |
5549 You can check if all the include files are found, using the value of | |
5550 'path', see |:checkpath|. | |
5551 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing | |
5552 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version | |
5553 uses another default. To remove the current directory use: > | |
5554 :set path-= | |
5555 < To add the current directory use: > | |
5556 :set path+= | |
5557 < To use an environment variable, you probably need to replace the | |
5558 separator. Here is an example to append $INCL, in which directory | |
5559 names are separated with a semi-colon: > | |
5560 :let &path = &path . "," . substitute($INCL, ';', ',', 'g') | |
5561 < Replace the ';' with a ':' or whatever separator is used. Note that | |
5562 this doesn't work when $INCL contains a comma or white space. | |
5563 | |
12499 | 5564 *'perldll'* |
5565 'perldll' string (default depends on the build) | |
5566 global | |
5567 {only available when compiled with the |+perl/dyn| | |
5568 feature} | |
5569 Specifies the name of the Perl shared library. The default is | |
5570 DYNAMIC_PERL_DLL, which was specified at compile time. | |
5571 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. | |
5572 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
5573 security reasons. | |
5574 | |
7 | 5575 *'preserveindent'* *'pi'* *'nopreserveindent'* *'nopi'* |
5576 'preserveindent' 'pi' boolean (default off) | |
5577 local to buffer | |
5578 When changing the indent of the current line, preserve as much of the | |
5579 indent structure as possible. Normally the indent is replaced by a | |
5580 series of tabs followed by spaces as required (unless |'expandtab'| is | |
5581 enabled, in which case only spaces are used). Enabling this option | |
5582 means the indent will preserve as many existing characters as possible | |
5583 for indenting, and only add additional tabs or spaces as required. | |
1621 | 5584 'expandtab' does not apply to the preserved white space, a Tab remains |
5585 a Tab. | |
7 | 5586 NOTE: When using ">>" multiple times the resulting indent is a mix of |
5587 tabs and spaces. You might not like this. | |
11160 | 5588 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
7 | 5589 Also see 'copyindent'. |
5590 Use |:retab| to clean up white space. | |
5591 | |
5592 *'previewheight'* *'pvh'* | |
5593 'previewheight' 'pvh' number (default 12) | |
5594 global | |
5595 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| or | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
5596 |+quickfix| features} |
7 | 5597 Default height for a preview window. Used for |:ptag| and associated |
5598 commands. Used for |CTRL-W_}| when no count is given. | |
5599 | |
5600 *'previewwindow'* *'nopreviewwindow'* | |
5601 *'pvw'* *'nopvw'* *E590* | |
5602 'previewwindow' 'pvw' boolean (default off) | |
5603 local to window | |
5604 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| or | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
5605 |+quickfix| features} |
10 | 5606 Identifies the preview window. Only one window can have this option |
7 | 5607 set. It's normally not set directly, but by using one of the commands |
5608 |:ptag|, |:pedit|, etc. | |
5609 | |
5610 *'printdevice'* *'pdev'* | |
5611 'printdevice' 'pdev' string (default empty) | |
5612 global | |
5613 {only available when compiled with the |+printer| | |
5614 feature} | |
15 | 5615 The name of the printer to be used for |:hardcopy|. |
5616 See |pdev-option|. | |
36 | 5617 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
5618 security reasons. | |
15 | 5619 |
5620 *'printencoding'* *'penc'* | |
14864 | 5621 'printencoding' 'penc' string (default empty, except for some systems) |
7 | 5622 global |
5623 {only available when compiled with the |+printer| | |
5624 and |+postscript| features} | |
15 | 5625 Sets the character encoding used when printing. |
5626 See |penc-option|. | |
7 | 5627 |
5628 *'printexpr'* *'pexpr'* | |
14864 | 5629 'printexpr' 'pexpr' string (default: see below) |
7 | 5630 global |
5631 {only available when compiled with the |+printer| | |
5632 and |+postscript| features} | |
15 | 5633 Expression used to print the PostScript produced with |:hardcopy|. |
5634 See |pexpr-option|. | |
10449
222b1432814e
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/5162822914372fc916a93f85848c0c82209e7cec
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10272
diff
changeset
|
5635 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
222b1432814e
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/5162822914372fc916a93f85848c0c82209e7cec
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10272
diff
changeset
|
5636 security reasons. |
15 | 5637 |
5638 *'printfont'* *'pfn'* | |
7 | 5639 'printfont' 'pfn' string (default "courier") |
5640 global | |
5641 {only available when compiled with the |+printer| | |
5642 feature} | |
15 | 5643 The name of the font that will be used for |:hardcopy|. |
5644 See |pfn-option|. | |
7 | 5645 |
5646 *'printheader'* *'pheader'* | |
5647 'printheader' 'pheader' string (default "%<%f%h%m%=Page %N") | |
5648 global | |
5649 {only available when compiled with the |+printer| | |
5650 feature} | |
15 | 5651 The format of the header produced in |:hardcopy| output. |
5652 See |pheader-option|. | |
5653 | |
5654 *'printmbcharset'* *'pmbcs'* | |
5655 'printmbcharset' 'pmbcs' string (default "") | |
5656 global | |
15878 | 5657 {only available when compiled with the |+printer| |
5658 and |+postscript| features} | |
15 | 5659 The CJK character set to be used for CJK output from |:hardcopy|. |
5660 See |pmbcs-option|. | |
5661 | |
5662 *'printmbfont'* *'pmbfn'* | |
5663 'printmbfont' 'pmbfn' string (default "") | |
5664 global | |
15878 | 5665 {only available when compiled with the |+printer| |
5666 and |+postscript| features} | |
15 | 5667 List of font names to be used for CJK output from |:hardcopy|. |
5668 See |pmbfn-option|. | |
7 | 5669 |
5670 *'printoptions'* *'popt'* | |
5671 'printoptions' 'popt' string (default "") | |
5672 global | |
5673 {only available when compiled with |+printer| feature} | |
15 | 5674 List of items that control the format of the output of |:hardcopy|. |
5675 See |popt-option|. | |
5676 | |
168 | 5677 *'prompt'* *'noprompt'* |
5678 'prompt' boolean (default on) | |
5679 global | |
5680 When on a ":" prompt is used in Ex mode. | |
5681 | |
766 | 5682 *'pumheight'* *'ph'* |
5683 'pumheight' 'ph' number (default 0) | |
5684 global | |
5685 {not available when compiled without the | |
5686 |+insert_expand| feature} | |
853 | 5687 Determines the maximum number of items to show in the popup menu for |
5688 Insert mode completion. When zero as much space as available is used. | |
766 | 5689 |ins-completion-menu|. |
5690 | |
13234
6e972d830e13
patch 8.0.1491: the minimum width of the popup menu is hard coded
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13231
diff
changeset
|
5691 *'pumwidth'* *'pw'* |
13314
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
5692 'pumwidth' 'pw' number (default 15) |
13234
6e972d830e13
patch 8.0.1491: the minimum width of the popup menu is hard coded
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13231
diff
changeset
|
5693 global |
6e972d830e13
patch 8.0.1491: the minimum width of the popup menu is hard coded
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13231
diff
changeset
|
5694 {not available when compiled without the |
6e972d830e13
patch 8.0.1491: the minimum width of the popup menu is hard coded
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13231
diff
changeset
|
5695 |+insert_expand| feature} |
13341
acd7eaa13d2b
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13314
diff
changeset
|
5696 Determines the minimum width to use for the popup menu for Insert mode |
13314
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
5697 completion. |ins-completion-menu|. |
13234
6e972d830e13
patch 8.0.1491: the minimum width of the popup menu is hard coded
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13231
diff
changeset
|
5698 |
7228
873eae260c97
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/b4ff518d95aa57c2f8c0568c915035bef849581b
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7218
diff
changeset
|
5699 *'pythondll'* |
8629
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
5700 'pythondll' string (default depends on the build) |
7528
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
5701 global |
7228
873eae260c97
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/b4ff518d95aa57c2f8c0568c915035bef849581b
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7218
diff
changeset
|
5702 {only available when compiled with the |+python/dyn| |
873eae260c97
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/b4ff518d95aa57c2f8c0568c915035bef849581b
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7218
diff
changeset
|
5703 feature} |
7528
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
5704 Specifies the name of the Python 2.x shared library. The default is |
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
5705 DYNAMIC_PYTHON_DLL, which was specified at compile time. |
8951
0bdeaf7092bc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/aa3b15dbebf333282503d6031e2f9ba6ee4398ed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8876
diff
changeset
|
5706 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. |
7228
873eae260c97
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/b4ff518d95aa57c2f8c0568c915035bef849581b
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7218
diff
changeset
|
5707 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
873eae260c97
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/b4ff518d95aa57c2f8c0568c915035bef849581b
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7218
diff
changeset
|
5708 security reasons. |
873eae260c97
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/b4ff518d95aa57c2f8c0568c915035bef849581b
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7218
diff
changeset
|
5709 |
13154
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5710 *'pythonhome'* |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5711 'pythonhome' string (default "") |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5712 global |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5713 {only available when compiled with the |+python/dyn| |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5714 feature} |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5715 Specifies the name of the Python 2.x home directory. When 'pythonhome' |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5716 and the PYTHONHOME environment variable are not set, PYTHON_HOME, |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5717 which was specified at compile time, will be used for the Python 2.x |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5718 home directory. |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5719 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5720 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5721 security reasons. |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5722 |
7218
36dc8df8560f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0796c0625fa4b9eb2f47fe8c976b78523924e1fb
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7196
diff
changeset
|
5723 *'pythonthreedll'* |
7528
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
5724 'pythonthreedll' string (default depends on the build) |
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
5725 global |
7196
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
5726 {only available when compiled with the |+python3/dyn| |
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
5727 feature} |
7528
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
5728 Specifies the name of the Python 3 shared library. The default is |
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
5729 DYNAMIC_PYTHON3_DLL, which was specified at compile time. |
8951
0bdeaf7092bc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/aa3b15dbebf333282503d6031e2f9ba6ee4398ed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8876
diff
changeset
|
5730 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. |
7196
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
5731 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
5732 security reasons. |
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
5733 |
13154
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5734 *'pythonthreehome'* |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5735 'pythonthreehome' string (default "") |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5736 global |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5737 {only available when compiled with the |+python3/dyn| |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5738 feature} |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5739 Specifies the name of the Python 3 home directory. When |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5740 'pythonthreehome' and the PYTHONHOME environment variable are not set, |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5741 PYTHON3_HOME, which was specified at compile time, will be used for |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5742 the Python 3 home directory. |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5743 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5744 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5745 security reasons. |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5746 |
10722
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5747 *'pyxversion'* *'pyx'* |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5748 'pyxversion' 'pyx' number (default depends on the build) |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5749 global |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5750 {only available when compiled with the |+python| or |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5751 the |+python3| feature} |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5752 Specifies the python version used for pyx* functions and commands |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5753 |python_x|. The default value is as follows: |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5754 |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5755 Compiled with Default ~ |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5756 |+python| and |+python3| 0 |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5757 only |+python| 2 |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5758 only |+python3| 3 |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5759 |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5760 Available values are 0, 2 and 3. |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5761 If 'pyxversion' is 0, it is set to 2 or 3 after the first execution of |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5762 any python2/3 commands or functions. E.g. `:py` sets to 2, and `:py3` |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5763 sets to 3. `:pyx` sets it to 3 if Python 3 is available, otherwise sets |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5764 to 2 if Python 2 is available. |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5765 See also: |has-pythonx| |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5766 |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5767 If Vim is compiled with only |+python| or |+python3| setting |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5768 'pyxversion' has no effect. The pyx* functions and commands are |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5769 always the same as the compiled version. |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5770 |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5771 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5772 security reasons. |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5773 |
140 | 5774 *'quoteescape'* *'qe'* |
12 | 5775 'quoteescape' 'qe' string (default "\") |
5776 local to buffer | |
5777 The characters that are used to escape quotes in a string. Used for | |
5778 objects like a', a" and a` |a'|. | |
5779 When one of the characters in this option is found inside a string, | |
5780 the following character will be skipped. The default value makes the | |
5781 text "foo\"bar\\" considered to be one string. | |
5782 | |
7 | 5783 *'readonly'* *'ro'* *'noreadonly'* *'noro'* |
5784 'readonly' 'ro' boolean (default off) | |
5785 local to buffer | |
5786 If on, writes fail unless you use a '!'. Protects you from | |
5787 accidentally overwriting a file. Default on when Vim is started | |
5788 in read-only mode ("vim -R") or when the executable is called "view". | |
164 | 5789 When using ":w!" the 'readonly' option is reset for the current |
5790 buffer, unless the 'Z' flag is in 'cpoptions'. | |
16443
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
5791 When using the ":view" command the 'readonly' option is set for the |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
5792 newly edited buffer. |
10617 | 5793 See 'modifiable' for disallowing changes to the buffer. |
7 | 5794 |
1521 | 5795 *'redrawtime'* *'rdt'* |
5796 'redrawtime' 'rdt' number (default 2000) | |
5797 global | |
5798 {only available when compiled with the |+reltime| | |
5799 feature} | |
5800 The time in milliseconds for redrawing the display. This applies to | |
13818
28ac7914b2b6
Update runtime files and translations
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13742
diff
changeset
|
5801 searching for patterns for 'hlsearch', |:match| highlighting and syntax |
11529
998d2cf59caa
patch 8.0.0647: syntax highlighting can make cause a freeze
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11516
diff
changeset
|
5802 highlighting. |
1521 | 5803 When redrawing takes more than this many milliseconds no further |
11529
998d2cf59caa
patch 8.0.0647: syntax highlighting can make cause a freeze
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11516
diff
changeset
|
5804 matches will be highlighted. |
998d2cf59caa
patch 8.0.0647: syntax highlighting can make cause a freeze
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11516
diff
changeset
|
5805 For syntax highlighting the time applies per window. When over the |
998d2cf59caa
patch 8.0.0647: syntax highlighting can make cause a freeze
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11516
diff
changeset
|
5806 limit syntax highlighting is disabled until |CTRL-L| is used. |
998d2cf59caa
patch 8.0.0647: syntax highlighting can make cause a freeze
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11516
diff
changeset
|
5807 This is used to avoid that Vim hangs when using a very complicated |
998d2cf59caa
patch 8.0.0647: syntax highlighting can make cause a freeze
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11516
diff
changeset
|
5808 pattern. |
1521 | 5809 |
4681
2eb30f341e8d
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4502
diff
changeset
|
5810 *'regexpengine'* *'re'* |
4502
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5811 'regexpengine' 're' number (default 0) |
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5812 global |
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5813 This selects the default regexp engine. |two-engines| |
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5814 The possible values are: |
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5815 0 automatic selection |
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5816 1 old engine |
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5817 2 NFA engine |
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5818 Note that when using the NFA engine and the pattern contains something |
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5819 that is not supported the pattern will not match. This is only useful |
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5820 for debugging the regexp engine. |
6328 | 5821 Using automatic selection enables Vim to switch the engine, if the |
5822 default engine becomes too costly. E.g., when the NFA engine uses too | |
5823 many states. This should prevent Vim from hanging on a combination of | |
5824 a complex pattern with long text. | |
4502
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5825 |
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5826 *'relativenumber'* *'rnu'* *'norelativenumber'* *'nornu'* |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5827 'relativenumber' 'rnu' boolean (default off) |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5828 local to window |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5829 Show the line number relative to the line with the cursor in front of |
2207
b17bbfa96fa0
Add the settabvar() and gettabvar() functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2204
diff
changeset
|
5830 each line. Relative line numbers help you use the |count| you can |
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5831 precede some vertical motion commands (e.g. j k + -) with, without |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5832 having to calculate it yourself. Especially useful in combination with |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5833 other commands (e.g. y d c < > gq gw =). |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5834 When the 'n' option is excluded from 'cpoptions' a wrapped |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5835 line will not use the column of line numbers (this is the default when |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5836 'compatible' isn't set). |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5837 The 'numberwidth' option can be used to set the room used for the line |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5838 number. |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5839 When a long, wrapped line doesn't start with the first character, '-' |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5840 characters are put before the number. |
3445 | 5841 See |hl-LineNr| and |hl-CursorLineNr| for the highlighting used for |
5842 the number. | |
13341
acd7eaa13d2b
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13314
diff
changeset
|
5843 |
4780 | 5844 The number in front of the cursor line also depends on the value of |
5845 'number', see |number_relativenumber| for all combinations of the two | |
5846 options. | |
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5847 |
7 | 5848 *'remap'* *'noremap'* |
5849 'remap' boolean (default on) | |
5850 global | |
5851 Allows for mappings to work recursively. If you do not want this for | |
5852 a single entry, use the :noremap[!] command. | |
717 | 5853 NOTE: To avoid portability problems with Vim scripts, always keep |
5854 this option at the default "on". Only switch it off when working with | |
5855 old Vi scripts. | |
7 | 5856 |
6110 | 5857 *'renderoptions'* *'rop'* |
5858 'renderoptions' 'rop' string (default: empty) | |
5859 global | |
5860 {only available when compiled with GUI and DIRECTX on | |
5861 MS-Windows} | |
5862 Select a text renderer and set its options. The options depend on the | |
5863 renderer. | |
5864 | |
5865 Syntax: > | |
5866 set rop=type:{renderer}(,{name}:{value})* | |
5867 < | |
5868 Currently, only one optional renderer is available. | |
5869 | |
5870 render behavior ~ | |
5871 directx Vim will draw text using DirectX (DirectWrite). It makes | |
5872 drawn glyphs more beautiful than default GDI. | |
5873 It requires 'encoding' is "utf-8", and only works on | |
5874 MS-Windows Vista or newer version. | |
5875 | |
5876 Options: | |
5877 name meaning type value ~ | |
5878 gamma gamma float 1.0 - 2.2 (maybe) | |
5879 contrast enhancedContrast float (unknown) | |
5880 level clearTypeLevel float (unknown) | |
5881 geom pixelGeometry int 0 - 2 (see below) | |
5882 renmode renderingMode int 0 - 6 (see below) | |
5883 taamode textAntialiasMode int 0 - 3 (see below) | |
13150
808625d4b71b
patch 8.0.1449: slow redrawing with DirectX
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13100
diff
changeset
|
5884 scrlines Scroll Lines int (deprecated) |
12986
18e6f4addce9
patch 8.0.1369: MS-Windows: drawing underline slow, mFallbackDC not updated
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12971
diff
changeset
|
5885 |
18e6f4addce9
patch 8.0.1369: MS-Windows: drawing underline slow, mFallbackDC not updated
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12971
diff
changeset
|
5886 See this URL for detail (except for scrlines): |
18e6f4addce9
patch 8.0.1369: MS-Windows: drawing underline slow, mFallbackDC not updated
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12971
diff
changeset
|
5887 https://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd368190.aspx |
6110 | 5888 |
5889 For geom: structure of a device pixel. | |
5890 0 - DWRITE_PIXEL_GEOMETRY_FLAT | |
5891 1 - DWRITE_PIXEL_GEOMETRY_RGB | |
5892 2 - DWRITE_PIXEL_GEOMETRY_BGR | |
5893 | |
5894 See this URL for detail: | |
12986
18e6f4addce9
patch 8.0.1369: MS-Windows: drawing underline slow, mFallbackDC not updated
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12971
diff
changeset
|
5895 https://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd368114.aspx |
6110 | 5896 |
5897 For renmode: method of rendering glyphs. | |
5898 0 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_DEFAULT | |
5899 1 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_ALIASED | |
5900 2 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_GDI_CLASSIC | |
5901 3 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_GDI_NATURAL | |
5902 4 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_NATURAL | |
5903 5 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_NATURAL_SYMMETRIC | |
5904 6 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_OUTLINE | |
5905 | |
5906 See this URL for detail: | |
12986
18e6f4addce9
patch 8.0.1369: MS-Windows: drawing underline slow, mFallbackDC not updated
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12971
diff
changeset
|
5907 https://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd368118.aspx |
6110 | 5908 |
5909 For taamode: antialiasing mode used for drawing text. | |
5910 0 - D2D1_TEXT_ANTIALIAS_MODE_DEFAULT | |
5911 1 - D2D1_TEXT_ANTIALIAS_MODE_CLEARTYPE | |
5912 2 - D2D1_TEXT_ANTIALIAS_MODE_GRAYSCALE | |
5913 3 - D2D1_TEXT_ANTIALIAS_MODE_ALIASED | |
5914 | |
5915 See this URL for detail: | |
12986
18e6f4addce9
patch 8.0.1369: MS-Windows: drawing underline slow, mFallbackDC not updated
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12971
diff
changeset
|
5916 https://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd368170.aspx |
18e6f4addce9
patch 8.0.1369: MS-Windows: drawing underline slow, mFallbackDC not updated
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12971
diff
changeset
|
5917 |
13150
808625d4b71b
patch 8.0.1449: slow redrawing with DirectX
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13100
diff
changeset
|
5918 For scrlines: |
808625d4b71b
patch 8.0.1449: slow redrawing with DirectX
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13100
diff
changeset
|
5919 This was used for optimizing scrolling behavior, however this |
808625d4b71b
patch 8.0.1449: slow redrawing with DirectX
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13100
diff
changeset
|
5920 is now deprecated. If specified, it is simply ignored. |
6110 | 5921 |
5922 Example: > | |
5923 set encoding=utf-8 | |
12934
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
5924 set gfn=Ricty_Diminished:h12 |
6110 | 5925 set rop=type:directx |
5926 < | |
12934
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
5927 If select a raster font (Courier, Terminal or FixedSys which |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
5928 have ".fon" extension in file name) to 'guifont', it will be |
12986
18e6f4addce9
patch 8.0.1369: MS-Windows: drawing underline slow, mFallbackDC not updated
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12971
diff
changeset
|
5929 drawn by GDI as a fallback. |
12934
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
5930 |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
5931 NOTE: It is known that some fonts and options combination |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
5932 causes trouble on drawing glyphs. |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
5933 |
12986
18e6f4addce9
patch 8.0.1369: MS-Windows: drawing underline slow, mFallbackDC not updated
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12971
diff
changeset
|
5934 - 'renmode:5' and 'renmode:6' will not work with some |
12934
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
5935 special made fonts (True-Type fonts which includes only |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
5936 bitmap glyphs). |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
5937 - 'taamode:3' will not work with some vector fonts. |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
5938 |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
5939 NOTE: With this option, you can display colored emoji |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
5940 (emoticon) in Windows 8.1 or later. To display colored emoji, |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
5941 there are some conditions which you should notice. |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
5942 |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
5943 - If your font includes non-colored emoji already, it will |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
5944 be used. |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
5945 - If your font doesn't have emoji, the system chooses an |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
5946 alternative symbol font. On Windows 10, "Segoe UI Emoji" |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
5947 will be used. |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
5948 - When this alternative font didn't have fixed width glyph, |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
5949 emoji might be rendered beyond the bounding box of drawing |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
5950 cell. |
6110 | 5951 |
5952 Other render types are currently not supported. | |
5953 | |
7 | 5954 *'report'* |
5955 'report' number (default 2) | |
5956 global | |
5957 Threshold for reporting number of lines changed. When the number of | |
5958 changed lines is more than 'report' a message will be given for most | |
5959 ":" commands. If you want it always, set 'report' to 0. | |
5960 For the ":substitute" command the number of substitutions is used | |
5961 instead of the number of lines. | |
5962 | |
5963 *'restorescreen'* *'rs'* *'norestorescreen'* *'nors'* | |
5964 'restorescreen' 'rs' boolean (default on) | |
5965 global | |
16443
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
5966 {only in Windows 95/NT console version} |
7 | 5967 When set, the screen contents is restored when exiting Vim. This also |
5968 happens when executing external commands. | |
5969 | |
5970 For non-Windows Vim: You can set or reset the 't_ti' and 't_te' | |
5971 options in your .vimrc. To disable restoring: | |
5972 set t_ti= t_te= | |
5973 To enable restoring (for an xterm): | |
5974 set t_ti=^[7^[[r^[[?47h t_te=^[[?47l^[8 | |
5975 (Where ^[ is an <Esc>, type CTRL-V <Esc> to insert it) | |
5976 | |
5977 *'revins'* *'ri'* *'norevins'* *'nori'* | |
5978 'revins' 'ri' boolean (default off) | |
5979 global | |
5980 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft| | |
5981 feature} | |
5982 Inserting characters in Insert mode will work backwards. See "typing | |
5983 backwards" |ins-reverse|. This option can be toggled with the CTRL-_ | |
5984 command in Insert mode, when 'allowrevins' is set. | |
7147
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
5985 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
5986 This option is reset when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste' is |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
5987 reset. |
7 | 5988 |
5989 *'rightleft'* *'rl'* *'norightleft'* *'norl'* | |
5990 'rightleft' 'rl' boolean (default off) | |
5991 local to window | |
5992 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft| | |
5993 feature} | |
5994 When on, display orientation becomes right-to-left, i.e., characters | |
5995 that are stored in the file appear from the right to the left. | |
5996 Using this option, it is possible to edit files for languages that | |
5997 are written from the right to the left such as Hebrew and Arabic. | |
5998 This option is per window, so it is possible to edit mixed files | |
5999 simultaneously, or to view the same file in both ways (this is | |
6000 useful whenever you have a mixed text file with both right-to-left | |
6001 and left-to-right strings so that both sets are displayed properly | |
6002 in different windows). Also see |rileft.txt|. | |
6003 | |
2341 | 6004 *'rightleftcmd'* *'rlc'* |
7 | 6005 'rightleftcmd' 'rlc' string (default "search") |
6006 local to window | |
6007 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft| | |
6008 feature} | |
6009 Each word in this option enables the command line editing to work in | |
6010 right-to-left mode for a group of commands: | |
6011 | |
6012 search "/" and "?" commands | |
6013 | |
6014 This is useful for languages such as Hebrew, Arabic and Farsi. | |
6015 The 'rightleft' option must be set for 'rightleftcmd' to take effect. | |
6016 | |
7196
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
6017 *'rubydll'* |
8629
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
6018 'rubydll' string (default: depends on the build) |
7528
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
6019 global |
7196
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
6020 {only available when compiled with the |+ruby/dyn| |
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
6021 feature} |
7528
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
6022 Specifies the name of the Ruby shared library. The default is |
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
6023 DYNAMIC_RUBY_DLL, which was specified at compile time. |
8951
0bdeaf7092bc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/aa3b15dbebf333282503d6031e2f9ba6ee4398ed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8876
diff
changeset
|
6024 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. |
7196
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
6025 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
6026 security reasons. |
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
6027 |
7 | 6028 *'ruler'* *'ru'* *'noruler'* *'noru'* |
9669
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
6029 'ruler' 'ru' boolean (default off, set in |defaults.vim|) |
7 | 6030 global |
6031 {not available when compiled without the | |
6032 |+cmdline_info| feature} | |
6033 Show the line and column number of the cursor position, separated by a | |
10 | 6034 comma. When there is room, the relative position of the displayed |
7 | 6035 text in the file is shown on the far right: |
6036 Top first line is visible | |
6037 Bot last line is visible | |
6038 All first and last line are visible | |
6039 45% relative position in the file | |
6040 If 'rulerformat' is set, it will determine the contents of the ruler. | |
10 | 6041 Each window has its own ruler. If a window has a status line, the |
7 | 6042 ruler is shown there. Otherwise it is shown in the last line of the |
233 | 6043 screen. If the statusline is given by 'statusline' (i.e. not empty), |
7 | 6044 this option takes precedence over 'ruler' and 'rulerformat' |
6045 If the number of characters displayed is different from the number of | |
6046 bytes in the text (e.g., for a TAB or a multi-byte character), both | |
6047 the text column (byte number) and the screen column are shown, | |
6048 separated with a dash. | |
6049 For an empty line "0-1" is shown. | |
6050 For an empty buffer the line number will also be zero: "0,0-1". | |
7147
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
6051 This option is reset when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste' is |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
6052 reset. |
7 | 6053 If you don't want to see the ruler all the time but want to know where |
6054 you are, use "g CTRL-G" |g_CTRL-G|. | |
6055 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
6056 | |
6057 *'rulerformat'* *'ruf'* | |
6058 'rulerformat' 'ruf' string (default empty) | |
6059 global | |
6060 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline| | |
6061 feature} | |
6062 When this option is not empty, it determines the content of the ruler | |
6063 string, as displayed for the 'ruler' option. | |
692 | 6064 The format of this option is like that of 'statusline'. |
7 | 6065 The default ruler width is 17 characters. To make the ruler 15 |
6066 characters wide, put "%15(" at the start and "%)" at the end. | |
6067 Example: > | |
6068 :set rulerformat=%15(%c%V\ %p%%%) | |
6069 < | |
6070 *'runtimepath'* *'rtp'* *vimfiles* | |
6071 'runtimepath' 'rtp' string (default: | |
6072 Unix: "$HOME/.vim, | |
6073 $VIM/vimfiles, | |
6074 $VIMRUNTIME, | |
6075 $VIM/vimfiles/after, | |
6076 $HOME/.vim/after" | |
6077 Amiga: "home:vimfiles, | |
6078 $VIM/vimfiles, | |
6079 $VIMRUNTIME, | |
6080 $VIM/vimfiles/after, | |
6081 home:vimfiles/after" | |
6082 PC, OS/2: "$HOME/vimfiles, | |
6083 $VIM/vimfiles, | |
6084 $VIMRUNTIME, | |
6085 $VIM/vimfiles/after, | |
6086 $HOME/vimfiles/after" | |
6087 Macintosh: "$VIM:vimfiles, | |
6088 $VIMRUNTIME, | |
6089 $VIM:vimfiles:after" | |
6090 RISC-OS: "Choices:vimfiles, | |
6091 $VIMRUNTIME, | |
6092 Choices:vimfiles/after" | |
6093 VMS: "sys$login:vimfiles, | |
6094 $VIM/vimfiles, | |
6095 $VIMRUNTIME, | |
6096 $VIM/vimfiles/after, | |
233 | 6097 sys$login:vimfiles/after") |
7 | 6098 global |
6099 This is a list of directories which will be searched for runtime | |
6100 files: | |
6101 filetype.vim filetypes by file name |new-filetype| | |
6102 scripts.vim filetypes by file contents |new-filetype-scripts| | |
164 | 6103 autoload/ automatically loaded scripts |autoload-functions| |
7 | 6104 colors/ color scheme files |:colorscheme| |
6105 compiler/ compiler files |:compiler| | |
6106 doc/ documentation |write-local-help| | |
6107 ftplugin/ filetype plugins |write-filetype-plugin| | |
6108 indent/ indent scripts |indent-expression| | |
6109 keymap/ key mapping files |mbyte-keymap| | |
6110 lang/ menu translations |:menutrans| | |
6111 menu.vim GUI menus |menu.vim| | |
9116
bc38030aec7d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/26852128a2b713ef49341a0c18daba928444e7eb
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9098
diff
changeset
|
6112 pack/ packages |:packadd| |
7 | 6113 plugin/ plugin scripts |write-plugin| |
6114 print/ files for printing |postscript-print-encoding| | |
650 | 6115 spell/ spell checking files |spell| |
7 | 6116 syntax/ syntax files |mysyntaxfile| |
6117 tutor/ files for vimtutor |tutor| | |
6118 | |
6119 And any other file searched for with the |:runtime| command. | |
6120 | |
6121 The defaults for most systems are setup to search five locations: | |
6122 1. In your home directory, for your personal preferences. | |
6123 2. In a system-wide Vim directory, for preferences from the system | |
6124 administrator. | |
6125 3. In $VIMRUNTIME, for files distributed with Vim. | |
6126 *after-directory* | |
6127 4. In the "after" directory in the system-wide Vim directory. This is | |
6128 for the system administrator to overrule or add to the distributed | |
6129 defaults (rarely needed) | |
6130 5. In the "after" directory in your home directory. This is for | |
6131 personal preferences to overrule or add to the distributed defaults | |
6132 or system-wide settings (rarely needed). | |
6133 | |
10211
b7da8d4c594c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d07969093a9b3051511c478d71c36de6fc33c0d6
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10198
diff
changeset
|
6134 More entries are added when using |packages|. If it gets very long |
b7da8d4c594c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d07969093a9b3051511c478d71c36de6fc33c0d6
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10198
diff
changeset
|
6135 then `:set rtp` will be truncated, use `:echo &rtp` to see the full |
b7da8d4c594c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d07969093a9b3051511c478d71c36de6fc33c0d6
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10198
diff
changeset
|
6136 string. |
9116
bc38030aec7d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/26852128a2b713ef49341a0c18daba928444e7eb
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9098
diff
changeset
|
6137 |
7 | 6138 Note that, unlike 'path', no wildcards like "**" are allowed. Normal |
6139 wildcards are allowed, but can significantly slow down searching for | |
10 | 6140 runtime files. For speed, use as few items as possible and avoid |
7 | 6141 wildcards. |
6142 See |:runtime|. | |
6143 Example: > | |
6144 :set runtimepath=~/vimruntime,/mygroup/vim,$VIMRUNTIME | |
6145 < This will use the directory "~/vimruntime" first (containing your | |
6146 personal Vim runtime files), then "/mygroup/vim" (shared between a | |
6147 group of people) and finally "$VIMRUNTIME" (the distributed runtime | |
6148 files). | |
6149 You probably should always include $VIMRUNTIME somewhere, to use the | |
6150 distributed runtime files. You can put a directory before $VIMRUNTIME | |
6151 to find files which replace a distributed runtime files. You can put | |
6152 a directory after $VIMRUNTIME to find files which add to distributed | |
6153 runtime files. | |
13437 | 6154 When Vim is started with |--clean| the home directory entries are not |
6155 included. | |
7 | 6156 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
6157 security reasons. | |
6158 | |
6159 *'scroll'* *'scr'* | |
6160 'scroll' 'scr' number (default: half the window height) | |
6161 local to window | |
6162 Number of lines to scroll with CTRL-U and CTRL-D commands. Will be | |
6163 set to half the number of lines in the window when the window size | |
6164 changes. If you give a count to the CTRL-U or CTRL-D command it will | |
10 | 6165 be used as the new value for 'scroll'. Reset to half the window |
7 | 6166 height with ":set scroll=0". {Vi is a bit different: 'scroll' gives |
6167 the number of screen lines instead of file lines, makes a difference | |
6168 when lines wrap} | |
6169 | |
6170 *'scrollbind'* *'scb'* *'noscrollbind'* *'noscb'* | |
6171 'scrollbind' 'scb' boolean (default off) | |
6172 local to window | |
6173 See also |scroll-binding|. When this option is set, the current | |
6174 window scrolls as other scrollbind windows (windows that also have | |
6175 this option set) scroll. This option is useful for viewing the | |
6176 differences between two versions of a file, see 'diff'. | |
6177 See |'scrollopt'| for options that determine how this option should be | |
6178 interpreted. | |
6179 This option is mostly reset when splitting a window to edit another | |
6180 file. This means that ":split | edit file" results in two windows | |
6181 with scroll-binding, but ":split file" does not. | |
6182 | |
6183 *'scrolljump'* *'sj'* | |
6184 'scrolljump' 'sj' number (default 1) | |
6185 global | |
6186 Minimal number of lines to scroll when the cursor gets off the | |
6187 screen (e.g., with "j"). Not used for scroll commands (e.g., CTRL-E, | |
6188 CTRL-D). Useful if your terminal scrolls very slowly. | |
532 | 6189 When set to a negative number from -1 to -100 this is used as the |
6190 percentage of the window height. Thus -50 scrolls half the window | |
6191 height. | |
7 | 6192 NOTE: This option is set to 1 when 'compatible' is set. |
6193 | |
6194 *'scrolloff'* *'so'* | |
10218
584c835a2de1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/50ba526fbf3e9e5e0e6b0b3086a4d5df581ebc7e
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10211
diff
changeset
|
6195 'scrolloff' 'so' number (default 0, set to 5 in |defaults.vim|) |
15713
ad8b2c109b22
patch 8.1.0864: cannot have a local value for 'scrolloff' and 'sidescrolloff'
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15701
diff
changeset
|
6196 global or local to window |global-local| |
7 | 6197 Minimal number of screen lines to keep above and below the cursor. |
6198 This will make some context visible around where you are working. If | |
6199 you set it to a very large value (999) the cursor line will always be | |
6200 in the middle of the window (except at the start or end of the file or | |
6201 when long lines wrap). | |
15713
ad8b2c109b22
patch 8.1.0864: cannot have a local value for 'scrolloff' and 'sidescrolloff'
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15701
diff
changeset
|
6202 After using the local value, go back the global value with one of |
ad8b2c109b22
patch 8.1.0864: cannot have a local value for 'scrolloff' and 'sidescrolloff'
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15701
diff
changeset
|
6203 these two: > |
ad8b2c109b22
patch 8.1.0864: cannot have a local value for 'scrolloff' and 'sidescrolloff'
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15701
diff
changeset
|
6204 setlocal scrolloff< |
ad8b2c109b22
patch 8.1.0864: cannot have a local value for 'scrolloff' and 'sidescrolloff'
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15701
diff
changeset
|
6205 setlocal scrolloff=-1 |
ad8b2c109b22
patch 8.1.0864: cannot have a local value for 'scrolloff' and 'sidescrolloff'
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15701
diff
changeset
|
6206 < For scrolling horizontally see 'sidescrolloff'. |
7 | 6207 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set. |
6208 | |
6209 *'scrollopt'* *'sbo'* | |
6210 'scrollopt' 'sbo' string (default "ver,jump") | |
6211 global | |
6212 This is a comma-separated list of words that specifies how | |
236 | 6213 'scrollbind' windows should behave. 'sbo' stands for ScrollBind |
6214 Options. | |
7 | 6215 The following words are available: |
6216 ver Bind vertical scrolling for 'scrollbind' windows | |
6217 hor Bind horizontal scrolling for 'scrollbind' windows | |
6218 jump Applies to the offset between two windows for vertical | |
6219 scrolling. This offset is the difference in the first | |
6220 displayed line of the bound windows. When moving | |
6221 around in a window, another 'scrollbind' window may | |
6222 reach a position before the start or after the end of | |
6223 the buffer. The offset is not changed though, when | |
6224 moving back the 'scrollbind' window will try to scroll | |
6225 to the desired position when possible. | |
6226 When now making that window the current one, two | |
6227 things can be done with the relative offset: | |
6228 1. When "jump" is not included, the relative offset is | |
6229 adjusted for the scroll position in the new current | |
6230 window. When going back to the other window, the | |
1152 | 6231 new relative offset will be used. |
7 | 6232 2. When "jump" is included, the other windows are |
6233 scrolled to keep the same relative offset. When | |
6234 going back to the other window, it still uses the | |
6235 same relative offset. | |
6236 Also see |scroll-binding|. | |
819 | 6237 When 'diff' mode is active there always is vertical scroll binding, |
6238 even when "ver" isn't there. | |
7 | 6239 |
6240 *'sections'* *'sect'* | |
6241 'sections' 'sect' string (default "SHNHH HUnhsh") | |
6242 global | |
6243 Specifies the nroff macros that separate sections. These are pairs of | |
6244 two letters (See |object-motions|). The default makes a section start | |
6245 at the nroff macros ".SH", ".NH", ".H", ".HU", ".nh" and ".sh". | |
6246 | |
6247 *'secure'* *'nosecure'* *E523* | |
6248 'secure' boolean (default off) | |
6249 global | |
6250 When on, ":autocmd", shell and write commands are not allowed in | |
6251 ".vimrc" and ".exrc" in the current directory and map commands are | |
6252 displayed. Switch it off only if you know that you will not run into | |
6253 problems, or when the 'exrc' option is off. On Unix this option is | |
6254 only used if the ".vimrc" or ".exrc" is not owned by you. This can be | |
10 | 6255 dangerous if the systems allows users to do a "chown". You better set |
7 | 6256 'secure' at the end of your ~/.vimrc then. |
6257 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
6258 security reasons. | |
6259 | |
6260 *'selection'* *'sel'* | |
6261 'selection' 'sel' string (default "inclusive") | |
6262 global | |
6263 This option defines the behavior of the selection. It is only used | |
6264 in Visual and Select mode. | |
6265 Possible values: | |
6266 value past line inclusive ~ | |
6267 old no yes | |
6268 inclusive yes yes | |
6269 exclusive yes no | |
6270 "past line" means that the cursor is allowed to be positioned one | |
6271 character past the line. | |
6272 "inclusive" means that the last character of the selection is included | |
6273 in an operation. For example, when "x" is used to delete the | |
6274 selection. | |
9975
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
6275 When "old" is used and 'virtualedit' allows the cursor to move past |
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
6276 the end of line the line break still isn't included. |
7 | 6277 Note that when "exclusive" is used and selecting from the end |
6278 backwards, you cannot include the last character of a line, when | |
6279 starting in Normal mode and 'virtualedit' empty. | |
6280 | |
6281 The 'selection' option is set by the |:behave| command. | |
6282 | |
6283 *'selectmode'* *'slm'* | |
6284 'selectmode' 'slm' string (default "") | |
6285 global | |
6286 This is a comma separated list of words, which specifies when to start | |
6287 Select mode instead of Visual mode, when a selection is started. | |
6288 Possible values: | |
6289 mouse when using the mouse | |
6290 key when using shifted special keys | |
6291 cmd when using "v", "V" or CTRL-V | |
6292 See |Select-mode|. | |
6293 The 'selectmode' option is set by the |:behave| command. | |
6294 | |
6295 *'sessionoptions'* *'ssop'* | |
6296 'sessionoptions' 'ssop' string (default: "blank,buffers,curdir,folds, | |
13437 | 6297 help,options,tabpages,winsize,terminal") |
7 | 6298 global |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
6299 {not available when compiled without the |+mksession| |
7 | 6300 feature} |
6301 Changes the effect of the |:mksession| command. It is a comma | |
6302 separated list of words. Each word enables saving and restoring | |
6303 something: | |
6304 word save and restore ~ | |
6305 blank empty windows | |
6306 buffers hidden and unloaded buffers, not just those in windows | |
6307 curdir the current directory | |
6308 folds manually created folds, opened/closed folds and local | |
6309 fold options | |
6310 globals global variables that start with an uppercase letter | |
75 | 6311 and contain at least one lowercase letter. Only |
6312 String and Number types are stored. | |
7 | 6313 help the help window |
6314 localoptions options and mappings local to a window or buffer (not | |
6315 global values for local options) | |
6316 options all options and mappings (also global values for local | |
6317 options) | |
6318 resize size of the Vim window: 'lines' and 'columns' | |
6319 sesdir the directory in which the session file is located | |
6320 will become the current directory (useful with | |
6321 projects accessed over a network from different | |
6322 systems) | |
6323 slash backslashes in file names replaced with forward | |
6324 slashes | |
827 | 6325 tabpages all tab pages; without this only the current tab page |
6326 is restored, so that you can make a session for each | |
6327 tab page separately | |
14519 | 6328 terminal include terminal windows where the command can be |
6329 restored | |
7 | 6330 unix with Unix end-of-line format (single <NL>), even when |
6331 on Windows or DOS | |
6332 winpos position of the whole Vim window | |
6333 winsize window sizes | |
6334 | |
6335 Don't include both "curdir" and "sesdir". | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
6336 When neither "curdir" nor "sesdir" is included, file names are stored |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
6337 with absolute paths. |
7 | 6338 "slash" and "unix" are useful on Windows when sharing session files |
6339 with Unix. The Unix version of Vim cannot source dos format scripts, | |
6340 but the Windows version of Vim can source unix format scripts. | |
6341 | |
6342 *'shell'* *'sh'* *E91* | |
6343 'shell' 'sh' string (default $SHELL or "sh", | |
6344 MS-DOS and Win32: "command.com" or | |
6345 "cmd.exe", OS/2: "cmd") | |
6346 global | |
6347 Name of the shell to use for ! and :! commands. When changing the | |
6348 value also check these options: 'shelltype', 'shellpipe', 'shellslash' | |
6349 'shellredir', 'shellquote', 'shellxquote' and 'shellcmdflag'. | |
10 | 6350 It is allowed to give an argument to the command, e.g. "csh -f". |
7 | 6351 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes. |
6352 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. | |
13162
51521b8a370c
patch 8.0.1455: if $SHELL contains a space then 'shell' is incorrect
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13154
diff
changeset
|
6353 |
7 | 6354 If the name of the shell contains a space, you might need to enclose |
13162
51521b8a370c
patch 8.0.1455: if $SHELL contains a space then 'shell' is incorrect
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13154
diff
changeset
|
6355 it in quotes or escape the space. Example with quotes: > |
7 | 6356 :set shell=\"c:\program\ files\unix\sh.exe\"\ -f |
6357 < Note the backslash before each quote (to avoid starting a comment) and | |
10 | 6358 each space (to avoid ending the option value). Also note that the |
7 | 6359 "-f" is not inside the quotes, because it is not part of the command |
13162
51521b8a370c
patch 8.0.1455: if $SHELL contains a space then 'shell' is incorrect
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13154
diff
changeset
|
6360 name. Vim automagically recognizes the backslashes that are path |
7 | 6361 separators. |
13162
51521b8a370c
patch 8.0.1455: if $SHELL contains a space then 'shell' is incorrect
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13154
diff
changeset
|
6362 Example with escaped space (Vim will do this when initializing the |
51521b8a370c
patch 8.0.1455: if $SHELL contains a space then 'shell' is incorrect
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13154
diff
changeset
|
6363 option from $SHELL): > |
51521b8a370c
patch 8.0.1455: if $SHELL contains a space then 'shell' is incorrect
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13154
diff
changeset
|
6364 :set shell=/bin/with\\\ space/sh |
14519 | 6365 < The resulting value of 'shell' is "/bin/with\ space/sh", two |
13162
51521b8a370c
patch 8.0.1455: if $SHELL contains a space then 'shell' is incorrect
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13154
diff
changeset
|
6366 backslashes are consumed by `:set`. |
51521b8a370c
patch 8.0.1455: if $SHELL contains a space then 'shell' is incorrect
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13154
diff
changeset
|
6367 |
7 | 6368 Under MS-Windows, when the executable ends in ".com" it must be |
6369 included. Thus setting the shell to "command.com" or "4dos.com" | |
6370 works, but "command" and "4dos" do not work for all commands (e.g., | |
6371 filtering). | |
6372 For unknown reasons, when using "4dos.com" the current directory is | |
6373 changed to "C:\". To avoid this set 'shell' like this: > | |
6374 :set shell=command.com\ /c\ 4dos | |
6375 < This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
6376 security reasons. | |
6377 | |
6378 *'shellcmdflag'* *'shcf'* | |
3356 | 6379 'shellcmdflag' 'shcf' string (default: "-c"; |
3371 | 6380 MS-DOS and Win32, when 'shell' does not |
6381 contain "sh" somewhere: "/c") | |
7 | 6382 global |
6383 Flag passed to the shell to execute "!" and ":!" commands; e.g., | |
6384 "bash.exe -c ls" or "command.com /c dir". For the MS-DOS-like | |
6385 systems, the default is set according to the value of 'shell', to | |
11262 | 6386 reduce the need to set this option by the user. |
3082 | 6387 On Unix it can have more than one flag. Each white space separated |
6388 part is passed as an argument to the shell command. | |
6389 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes. | |
6390 Also see |dos-shell| for MS-DOS and MS-Windows. | |
7 | 6391 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
6392 security reasons. | |
6393 | |
6394 *'shellpipe'* *'sp'* | |
6395 'shellpipe' 'sp' string (default ">", "| tee", "|& tee" or "2>&1| tee") | |
6396 global | |
6397 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix| | |
6398 feature} | |
6399 String to be used to put the output of the ":make" command in the | |
10 | 6400 error file. See also |:make_makeprg|. See |option-backslash| about |
7 | 6401 including spaces and backslashes. |
6402 The name of the temporary file can be represented by "%s" if necessary | |
6403 (the file name is appended automatically if no %s appears in the value | |
6404 of this option). | |
6405 For the Amiga and MS-DOS the default is ">". The output is directly | |
6406 saved in a file and not echoed to the screen. | |
6407 For Unix the default it "| tee". The stdout of the compiler is saved | |
6408 in a file and echoed to the screen. If the 'shell' option is "csh" or | |
6409 "tcsh" after initializations, the default becomes "|& tee". If the | |
2788 | 6410 'shell' option is "sh", "ksh", "mksh", "pdksh", "zsh" or "bash" the |
6411 default becomes "2>&1| tee". This means that stderr is also included. | |
6412 Before using the 'shell' option a path is removed, thus "/bin/sh" uses | |
6413 "sh". | |
7 | 6414 The initialization of this option is done after reading the ".vimrc" |
6415 and the other initializations, so that when the 'shell' option is set | |
6416 there, the 'shellpipe' option changes automatically, unless it was | |
6417 explicitly set before. | |
6418 When 'shellpipe' is set to an empty string, no redirection of the | |
6419 ":make" output will be done. This is useful if you use a 'makeprg' | |
6420 that writes to 'makeef' by itself. If you want no piping, but do | |
6421 want to include the 'makeef', set 'shellpipe' to a single space. | |
6422 Don't forget to precede the space with a backslash: ":set sp=\ ". | |
6423 In the future pipes may be used for filtering and this option will | |
6424 become obsolete (at least for Unix). | |
6425 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
6426 security reasons. | |
6427 | |
6428 *'shellquote'* *'shq'* | |
6429 'shellquote' 'shq' string (default: ""; MS-DOS and Win32, when 'shell' | |
6430 contains "sh" somewhere: "\"") | |
6431 global | |
6432 Quoting character(s), put around the command passed to the shell, for | |
6433 the "!" and ":!" commands. The redirection is kept outside of the | |
6434 quoting. See 'shellxquote' to include the redirection. It's | |
6435 probably not useful to set both options. | |
6436 This is an empty string by default. Only known to be useful for | |
6437 third-party shells on MS-DOS-like systems, such as the MKS Korn Shell | |
6438 or bash, where it should be "\"". The default is adjusted according | |
6439 the value of 'shell', to reduce the need to set this option by the | |
6440 user. See |dos-shell|. | |
6441 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
6442 security reasons. | |
6443 | |
6444 *'shellredir'* *'srr'* | |
6445 'shellredir' 'srr' string (default ">", ">&" or ">%s 2>&1") | |
6446 global | |
6447 String to be used to put the output of a filter command in a temporary | |
6448 file. See also |:!|. See |option-backslash| about including spaces | |
6449 and backslashes. | |
6450 The name of the temporary file can be represented by "%s" if necessary | |
6451 (the file name is appended automatically if no %s appears in the value | |
6452 of this option). | |
6453 The default is ">". For Unix, if the 'shell' option is "csh", "tcsh" | |
6454 or "zsh" during initializations, the default becomes ">&". If the | |
6455 'shell' option is "sh", "ksh" or "bash" the default becomes | |
6456 ">%s 2>&1". This means that stderr is also included. | |
6457 For Win32, the Unix checks are done and additionally "cmd" is checked | |
6458 for, which makes the default ">%s 2>&1". Also, the same names with | |
6459 ".exe" appended are checked for. | |
6460 The initialization of this option is done after reading the ".vimrc" | |
6461 and the other initializations, so that when the 'shell' option is set | |
6462 there, the 'shellredir' option changes automatically unless it was | |
6463 explicitly set before. | |
6464 In the future pipes may be used for filtering and this option will | |
6465 become obsolete (at least for Unix). | |
6466 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
6467 security reasons. | |
6468 | |
6469 *'shellslash'* *'ssl'* *'noshellslash'* *'nossl'* | |
6470 'shellslash' 'ssl' boolean (default off) | |
6471 global | |
16443
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
6472 {only for MSDOS, MS-Windows and OS/2} |
7 | 6473 When set, a forward slash is used when expanding file names. This is |
6474 useful when a Unix-like shell is used instead of command.com or | |
6475 cmd.exe. Backward slashes can still be typed, but they are changed to | |
6476 forward slashes by Vim. | |
6477 Note that setting or resetting this option has no effect for some | |
6478 existing file names, thus this option needs to be set before opening | |
6479 any file for best results. This might change in the future. | |
6480 'shellslash' only works when a backslash can be used as a path | |
6481 separator. To test if this is so use: > | |
6482 if exists('+shellslash') | |
6483 < | |
168 | 6484 *'shelltemp'* *'stmp'* *'noshelltemp'* *'nostmp'* |
6485 'shelltemp' 'stmp' boolean (Vi default off, Vim default on) | |
6486 global | |
6487 When on, use temp files for shell commands. When off use a pipe. | |
6488 When using a pipe is not possible temp files are used anyway. | |
2965 | 6489 Currently a pipe is only supported on Unix and MS-Windows 2K and |
6490 later. You can check it with: > | |
168 | 6491 :if has("filterpipe") |
6492 < The advantage of using a pipe is that nobody can read the temp file | |
6493 and the 'shell' command does not need to support redirection. | |
6494 The advantage of using a temp file is that the file type and encoding | |
6495 can be detected. | |
6496 The |FilterReadPre|, |FilterReadPost| and |FilterWritePre|, | |
6497 |FilterWritePost| autocommands event are not triggered when | |
6498 'shelltemp' is off. | |
9533
9f921133ee90
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/269f595f9eef584937e7eae70fde68cdd7da5bcf
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9464
diff
changeset
|
6499 The `system()` function does not respect this option and always uses |
9f921133ee90
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/269f595f9eef584937e7eae70fde68cdd7da5bcf
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9464
diff
changeset
|
6500 temp files. |
11160 | 6501 NOTE: This option is set to the Vim default value when 'compatible' |
6502 is reset. | |
168 | 6503 |
7 | 6504 *'shelltype'* *'st'* |
6505 'shelltype' 'st' number (default 0) | |
6506 global | |
16443
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
6507 {only for the Amiga} |
7 | 6508 On the Amiga this option influences the way how the commands work |
6509 which use a shell. | |
6510 0 and 1: always use the shell | |
6511 2 and 3: use the shell only to filter lines | |
6512 4 and 5: use shell only for ':sh' command | |
6513 When not using the shell, the command is executed directly. | |
6514 | |
6515 0 and 2: use "shell 'shellcmdflag' cmd" to start external commands | |
6516 1 and 3: use "shell cmd" to start external commands | |
6517 | |
3371 | 6518 *'shellxescape'* *'sxe'* |
6519 'shellxescape' 'sxe' string (default: ""; | |
6520 for MS-DOS and MS-Windows: "\"&|<>()@^") | |
6521 global | |
6522 When 'shellxquote' is set to "(" then the characters listed in this | |
6523 option will be escaped with a '^' character. This makes it possible | |
6524 to execute most external commands with cmd.exe. | |
6525 | |
7 | 6526 *'shellxquote'* *'sxq'* |
6527 'shellxquote' 'sxq' string (default: ""; | |
3359 | 6528 for Win32, when 'shell' is cmd.exe: "(" |
6529 for Win32, when 'shell' contains "sh" | |
6530 somewhere: "\"" | |
7 | 6531 for Unix, when using system(): "\"") |
6532 global | |
6533 Quoting character(s), put around the command passed to the shell, for | |
6534 the "!" and ":!" commands. Includes the redirection. See | |
6535 'shellquote' to exclude the redirection. It's probably not useful | |
6536 to set both options. | |
3359 | 6537 When the value is '(' then ')' is appended. When the value is '"(' |
6538 then ')"' is appended. | |
6539 When the value is '(' then also see 'shellxescape'. | |
3352 | 6540 This is an empty string by default on most systems, but is known to be |
6541 useful for on Win32 version, either for cmd.exe which automatically | |
6542 strips off the first and last quote on a command, or 3rd-party shells | |
6543 such as the MKS Korn Shell or bash, where it should be "\"". The | |
6544 default is adjusted according the value of 'shell', to reduce the need | |
6545 to set this option by the user. See |dos-shell|. | |
7 | 6546 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
6547 security reasons. | |
6548 | |
6549 *'shiftround'* *'sr'* *'noshiftround'* *'nosr'* | |
6550 'shiftround' 'sr' boolean (default off) | |
6551 global | |
6552 Round indent to multiple of 'shiftwidth'. Applies to > and < | |
6553 commands. CTRL-T and CTRL-D in Insert mode always round the indent to | |
6554 a multiple of 'shiftwidth' (this is Vi compatible). | |
6555 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
6556 | |
6557 *'shiftwidth'* *'sw'* | |
6558 'shiftwidth' 'sw' number (default 8) | |
6559 local to buffer | |
10 | 6560 Number of spaces to use for each step of (auto)indent. Used for |
7 | 6561 |'cindent'|, |>>|, |<<|, etc. |
3893 | 6562 When zero the 'ts' value will be used. Use the |shiftwidth()| |
6563 function to get the effective shiftwidth value. | |
7 | 6564 |
6565 *'shortmess'* *'shm'* | |
168 | 6566 'shortmess' 'shm' string (Vim default "filnxtToO", Vi default: "", |
6567 POSIX default: "A") | |
7 | 6568 global |
6569 This option helps to avoid all the |hit-enter| prompts caused by file | |
6570 messages, for example with CTRL-G, and to avoid some other messages. | |
6571 It is a list of flags: | |
6572 flag meaning when present ~ | |
6573 f use "(3 of 5)" instead of "(file 3 of 5)" | |
6574 i use "[noeol]" instead of "[Incomplete last line]" | |
6575 l use "999L, 888C" instead of "999 lines, 888 characters" | |
6576 m use "[+]" instead of "[Modified]" | |
6577 n use "[New]" instead of "[New File]" | |
6578 r use "[RO]" instead of "[readonly]" | |
6579 w use "[w]" instead of "written" for file write message | |
6580 and "[a]" instead of "appended" for ':w >> file' command | |
6581 x use "[dos]" instead of "[dos format]", "[unix]" instead of | |
6582 "[unix format]" and "[mac]" instead of "[mac format]". | |
6583 a all of the above abbreviations | |
6584 | |
6585 o overwrite message for writing a file with subsequent message | |
6586 for reading a file (useful for ":wn" or when 'autowrite' on) | |
6587 O message for reading a file overwrites any previous message. | |
6588 Also for quickfix message (e.g., ":cn"). | |
6589 s don't give "search hit BOTTOM, continuing at TOP" or "search | |
6590 hit TOP, continuing at BOTTOM" messages | |
6591 t truncate file message at the start if it is too long to fit | |
6592 on the command-line, "<" will appear in the left most column. | |
6593 Ignored in Ex mode. | |
6594 T truncate other messages in the middle if they are too long to | |
233 | 6595 fit on the command line. "..." will appear in the middle. |
7 | 6596 Ignored in Ex mode. |
6597 W don't give "written" or "[w]" when writing a file | |
6598 A don't give the "ATTENTION" message when an existing swap file | |
6599 is found. | |
6600 I don't give the intro message when starting Vim |:intro|. | |
5946 | 6601 c don't give |ins-completion-menu| messages. For example, |
6602 "-- XXX completion (YYY)", "match 1 of 2", "The only match", | |
6603 "Pattern not found", "Back at original", etc. | |
8560
f3c636c673f7
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/426dd0219512af5f4abeb0901b533159253ffba3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8497
diff
changeset
|
6604 q use "recording" instead of "recording @a" |
f3c636c673f7
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/426dd0219512af5f4abeb0901b533159253ffba3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8497
diff
changeset
|
6605 F don't give the file info when editing a file, like `:silent` |
f3c636c673f7
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/426dd0219512af5f4abeb0901b533159253ffba3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8497
diff
changeset
|
6606 was used for the command |
7 | 6607 |
6608 This gives you the opportunity to avoid that a change between buffers | |
6609 requires you to hit <Enter>, but still gives as useful a message as | |
6610 possible for the space available. To get the whole message that you | |
6611 would have got with 'shm' empty, use ":file!" | |
6612 Useful values: | |
6613 shm= No abbreviation of message. | |
6614 shm=a Abbreviation, but no loss of information. | |
6615 shm=at Abbreviation, and truncate message when necessary. | |
6616 | |
6617 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is | |
6618 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
6619 | |
6620 *'shortname'* *'sn'* *'noshortname'* *'nosn'* | |
6621 'shortname' 'sn' boolean (default off) | |
6622 local to buffer | |
6623 Filenames are assumed to be 8 characters plus one extension of 3 | |
6624 characters. Multiple dots in file names are not allowed. When this | |
6625 option is on, dots in file names are replaced with underscores when | |
6626 adding an extension (".~" or ".swp"). This option is not available | |
6627 for MS-DOS, because then it would always be on. This option is useful | |
6628 when editing files on an MS-DOS compatible filesystem, e.g., messydos | |
6629 or crossdos. When running the Win32 GUI version under Win32s, this | |
6630 option is always on by default. | |
6631 | |
6632 *'showbreak'* *'sbr'* *E595* | |
6633 'showbreak' 'sbr' string (default "") | |
6634 global | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
6635 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak| |
7 | 6636 feature} |
6637 String to put at the start of lines that have been wrapped. Useful | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
6638 values are "> " or "+++ ": > |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
6639 :set showbreak=>\ |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
6640 < Note the backslash to escape the trailing space. It's easier like |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
6641 this: > |
2314
233eb4412f5d
Added 'colorcolumn' option. Partly by Gregor Uhlenheuer.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2302
diff
changeset
|
6642 :let &showbreak = '+++ ' |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
6643 < Only printable single-cell characters are allowed, excluding <Tab> and |
7 | 6644 comma (in a future version the comma might be used to separate the |
6645 part that is shown at the end and at the start of a line). | |
6646 The characters are highlighted according to the '@' flag in | |
6647 'highlight'. | |
6648 Note that tabs after the showbreak will be displayed differently. | |
6649 If you want the 'showbreak' to appear in between line numbers, add the | |
6650 "n" flag to 'cpoptions'. | |
6651 | |
6652 *'showcmd'* *'sc'* *'noshowcmd'* *'nosc'* | |
9669
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
6653 'showcmd' 'sc' boolean (Vim default: on, off for Unix, |
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
6654 Vi default: off, set in |defaults.vim|) |
7 | 6655 global |
6656 {not available when compiled without the | |
6657 |+cmdline_info| feature} | |
1152 | 6658 Show (partial) command in the last line of the screen. Set this |
6659 option off if your terminal is slow. | |
7 | 6660 In Visual mode the size of the selected area is shown: |
6661 - When selecting characters within a line, the number of characters. | |
2324
0a258a67051d
In Visual mode with 'showcmd' display the number of bytes and characters.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2317
diff
changeset
|
6662 If the number of bytes is different it is also displayed: "2-6" |
0a258a67051d
In Visual mode with 'showcmd' display the number of bytes and characters.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2317
diff
changeset
|
6663 means two characters and six bytes. |
7 | 6664 - When selecting more than one line, the number of lines. |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
6665 - When selecting a block, the size in screen characters: |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
6666 {lines}x{columns}. |
7 | 6667 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is |
6668 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
6669 | |
6670 *'showfulltag'* *'sft'* *'noshowfulltag'* *'nosft'* | |
6671 'showfulltag' 'sft' boolean (default off) | |
6672 global | |
6673 When completing a word in insert mode (see |ins-completion|) from the | |
6674 tags file, show both the tag name and a tidied-up form of the search | |
10 | 6675 pattern (if there is one) as possible matches. Thus, if you have |
7 | 6676 matched a C function, you can see a template for what arguments are |
6677 required (coding style permitting). | |
1621 | 6678 Note that this doesn't work well together with having "longest" in |
6679 'completeopt', because the completion from the search pattern may not | |
6680 match the typed text. | |
7 | 6681 |
6682 *'showmatch'* *'sm'* *'noshowmatch'* *'nosm'* | |
6683 'showmatch' 'sm' boolean (default off) | |
6684 global | |
6685 When a bracket is inserted, briefly jump to the matching one. The | |
6686 jump is only done if the match can be seen on the screen. The time to | |
6687 show the match can be set with 'matchtime'. | |
6688 A Beep is given if there is no match (no matter if the match can be | |
7147
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
6689 seen or not). |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
6690 This option is reset when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste' is |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
6691 reset. |
7 | 6692 When the 'm' flag is not included in 'cpoptions', typing a character |
6693 will immediately move the cursor back to where it belongs. | |
6694 See the "sm" field in 'guicursor' for setting the cursor shape and | |
6695 blinking when showing the match. | |
6696 The 'matchpairs' option can be used to specify the characters to show | |
6697 matches for. 'rightleft' and 'revins' are used to look for opposite | |
6698 matches. | |
699 | 6699 Also see the matchparen plugin for highlighting the match when moving |
6700 around |pi_paren.txt|. | |
6701 Note: Use of the short form is rated PG. | |
7 | 6702 |
6703 *'showmode'* *'smd'* *'noshowmode'* *'nosmd'* | |
6704 'showmode' 'smd' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off) | |
6705 global | |
6706 If in Insert, Replace or Visual mode put a message on the last line. | |
6707 Use the 'M' flag in 'highlight' to set the type of highlighting for | |
6708 this message. | |
10 | 6709 When |XIM| may be used the message will include "XIM". But this |
7 | 6710 doesn't mean XIM is really active, especially when 'imactivatekey' is |
6711 not set. | |
6712 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is | |
6713 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
6714 | |
677 | 6715 *'showtabline'* *'stal'* |
6716 'showtabline' 'stal' number (default 1) | |
6717 global | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
6718 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| |
677 | 6719 feature} |
6720 The value of this option specifies when the line with tab page labels | |
6721 will be displayed: | |
6722 0: never | |
6723 1: only if there are at least two tab pages | |
6724 2: always | |
6725 This is both for the GUI and non-GUI implementation of the tab pages | |
6726 line. | |
6727 See |tab-page| for more information about tab pages. | |
6728 | |
7 | 6729 *'sidescroll'* *'ss'* |
6730 'sidescroll' 'ss' number (default 0) | |
6731 global | |
6732 The minimal number of columns to scroll horizontally. Used only when | |
6733 the 'wrap' option is off and the cursor is moved off of the screen. | |
6734 When it is zero the cursor will be put in the middle of the screen. | |
6735 When using a slow terminal set it to a large number or 0. When using | |
6736 a fast terminal use a small number or 1. Not used for "zh" and "zl" | |
6737 commands. | |
6738 | |
6739 *'sidescrolloff'* *'siso'* | |
6740 'sidescrolloff' 'siso' number (default 0) | |
15713
ad8b2c109b22
patch 8.1.0864: cannot have a local value for 'scrolloff' and 'sidescrolloff'
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15701
diff
changeset
|
6741 global or local to window |global-local| |
7 | 6742 The minimal number of screen columns to keep to the left and to the |
534 | 6743 right of the cursor if 'nowrap' is set. Setting this option to a |
6744 value greater than 0 while having |'sidescroll'| also at a non-zero | |
6745 value makes some context visible in the line you are scrolling in | |
6746 horizontally (except at beginning of the line). Setting this option | |
6747 to a large value (like 999) has the effect of keeping the cursor | |
6748 horizontally centered in the window, as long as one does not come too | |
6749 close to the beginning of the line. | |
15713
ad8b2c109b22
patch 8.1.0864: cannot have a local value for 'scrolloff' and 'sidescrolloff'
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15701
diff
changeset
|
6750 After using the local value, go back the global value with one of |
ad8b2c109b22
patch 8.1.0864: cannot have a local value for 'scrolloff' and 'sidescrolloff'
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15701
diff
changeset
|
6751 these two: > |
ad8b2c109b22
patch 8.1.0864: cannot have a local value for 'scrolloff' and 'sidescrolloff'
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15701
diff
changeset
|
6752 setlocal sidescrolloff< |
ad8b2c109b22
patch 8.1.0864: cannot have a local value for 'scrolloff' and 'sidescrolloff'
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15701
diff
changeset
|
6753 setlocal sidescrolloff=-1 |
ad8b2c109b22
patch 8.1.0864: cannot have a local value for 'scrolloff' and 'sidescrolloff'
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15701
diff
changeset
|
6754 < NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set. |
7 | 6755 |
6756 Example: Try this together with 'sidescroll' and 'listchars' as | |
6757 in the following example to never allow the cursor to move | |
9852
4eea48b76d03
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/95ec9d6a6ab3117d60ff638670a803d43974ba51
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9737
diff
changeset
|
6758 onto the "extends" character: > |
7 | 6759 |
6760 :set nowrap sidescroll=1 listchars=extends:>,precedes:< | |
6761 :set sidescrolloff=1 | |
9852
4eea48b76d03
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/95ec9d6a6ab3117d60ff638670a803d43974ba51
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9737
diff
changeset
|
6762 < |
4eea48b76d03
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/95ec9d6a6ab3117d60ff638670a803d43974ba51
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9737
diff
changeset
|
6763 *'signcolumn'* *'scl'* |
4eea48b76d03
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/95ec9d6a6ab3117d60ff638670a803d43974ba51
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9737
diff
changeset
|
6764 'signcolumn' 'scl' string (default "auto") |
4eea48b76d03
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/95ec9d6a6ab3117d60ff638670a803d43974ba51
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9737
diff
changeset
|
6765 local to window |
4eea48b76d03
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/95ec9d6a6ab3117d60ff638670a803d43974ba51
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9737
diff
changeset
|
6766 {not available when compiled without the |+signs| |
4eea48b76d03
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/95ec9d6a6ab3117d60ff638670a803d43974ba51
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9737
diff
changeset
|
6767 feature} |
9860
9eaf8ef656e9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0952131376a517fc12dc5ae908a97018b4ee23f0
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9852
diff
changeset
|
6768 Whether or not to draw the signcolumn. Valid values are: |
9eaf8ef656e9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0952131376a517fc12dc5ae908a97018b4ee23f0
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9852
diff
changeset
|
6769 "auto" only when there is a sign to display |
9eaf8ef656e9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0952131376a517fc12dc5ae908a97018b4ee23f0
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9852
diff
changeset
|
6770 "no" never |
9eaf8ef656e9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0952131376a517fc12dc5ae908a97018b4ee23f0
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9852
diff
changeset
|
6771 "yes" always |
7 | 6772 |
6773 | |
6774 *'smartcase'* *'scs'* *'nosmartcase'* *'noscs'* | |
6775 'smartcase' 'scs' boolean (default off) | |
6776 global | |
6777 Override the 'ignorecase' option if the search pattern contains upper | |
6778 case characters. Only used when the search pattern is typed and | |
6779 'ignorecase' option is on. Used for the commands "/", "?", "n", "N", | |
3557 | 6780 ":g" and ":s". Not used for "*", "#", "gd", tag search, etc. After |
7 | 6781 "*" and "#" you can make 'smartcase' used by doing a "/" command, |
6782 recalling the search pattern from history and hitting <Enter>. | |
6783 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
6784 | |
6785 *'smartindent'* *'si'* *'nosmartindent'* *'nosi'* | |
6786 'smartindent' 'si' boolean (default off) | |
6787 local to buffer | |
6788 {not available when compiled without the | |
6789 |+smartindent| feature} | |
6790 Do smart autoindenting when starting a new line. Works for C-like | |
6791 programs, but can also be used for other languages. 'cindent' does | |
6792 something like this, works better in most cases, but is more strict, | |
2662 | 6793 see |C-indenting|. When 'cindent' is on or 'indentexpr' is set, |
2642 | 6794 setting 'si' has no effect. 'indentexpr' is a more advanced |
6795 alternative. | |
7 | 6796 Normally 'autoindent' should also be on when using 'smartindent'. |
6797 An indent is automatically inserted: | |
6798 - After a line ending in '{'. | |
6799 - After a line starting with a keyword from 'cinwords'. | |
6800 - Before a line starting with '}' (only with the "O" command). | |
6801 When typing '}' as the first character in a new line, that line is | |
6802 given the same indent as the matching '{'. | |
6803 When typing '#' as the first character in a new line, the indent for | |
6804 that line is removed, the '#' is put in the first column. The indent | |
10 | 6805 is restored for the next line. If you don't want this, use this |
7 | 6806 mapping: ":inoremap # X^H#", where ^H is entered with CTRL-V CTRL-H. |
6807 When using the ">>" command, lines starting with '#' are not shifted | |
6808 right. | |
11160 | 6809 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
7147
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
6810 This option is reset when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste' is |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
6811 reset. |
7 | 6812 |
6813 *'smarttab'* *'sta'* *'nosmarttab'* *'nosta'* | |
6814 'smarttab' 'sta' boolean (default off) | |
6815 global | |
6816 When on, a <Tab> in front of a line inserts blanks according to | |
648 | 6817 'shiftwidth'. 'tabstop' or 'softtabstop' is used in other places. A |
6818 <BS> will delete a 'shiftwidth' worth of space at the start of the | |
6819 line. | |
650 | 6820 When off, a <Tab> always inserts blanks according to 'tabstop' or |
648 | 6821 'softtabstop'. 'shiftwidth' is only used for shifting text left or |
6822 right |shift-left-right|. | |
1263 | 6823 What gets inserted (a <Tab> or spaces) depends on the 'expandtab' |
7 | 6824 option. Also see |ins-expandtab|. When 'expandtab' is not set, the |
11 | 6825 number of spaces is minimized by using <Tab>s. |
7147
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
6826 This option is reset when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste' is |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
6827 reset. |
7 | 6828 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
6829 | |
6830 *'softtabstop'* *'sts'* | |
6831 'softtabstop' 'sts' number (default 0) | |
6832 local to buffer | |
6833 Number of spaces that a <Tab> counts for while performing editing | |
6834 operations, like inserting a <Tab> or using <BS>. It "feels" like | |
6835 <Tab>s are being inserted, while in fact a mix of spaces and <Tab>s is | |
6836 used. This is useful to keep the 'ts' setting at its standard value | |
6837 of 8, while being able to edit like it is set to 'sts'. However, | |
6838 commands like "x" still work on the actual characters. | |
6839 When 'sts' is zero, this feature is off. | |
3893 | 6840 When 'sts' is negative, the value of 'shiftwidth' is used. |
7147
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
6841 'softtabstop' is set to 0 when the 'paste' option is set and restored |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
6842 when 'paste' is reset. |
7 | 6843 See also |ins-expandtab|. When 'expandtab' is not set, the number of |
6844 spaces is minimized by using <Tab>s. | |
6845 The 'L' flag in 'cpoptions' changes how tabs are used when 'list' is | |
6846 set. | |
6847 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set. | |
6848 | |
14175
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
6849 If Vim is compiled with the |+vartabs| feature then the value of |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
6850 'softtabstop' will be ignored if |'varsofttabstop'| is set to |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
6851 anything other than an empty string. |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
6852 |
221 | 6853 *'spell'* *'nospell'* |
6854 'spell' boolean (default off) | |
6855 local to window | |
6856 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| | |
6857 feature} | |
6858 When on spell checking will be done. See |spell|. | |
236 | 6859 The languages are specified with 'spelllang'. |
221 | 6860 |
386 | 6861 *'spellcapcheck'* *'spc'* |
389 | 6862 'spellcapcheck' 'spc' string (default "[.?!]\_[\])'" \t]\+") |
386 | 6863 local to buffer |
6864 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| | |
6865 feature} | |
6866 Pattern to locate the end of a sentence. The following word will be | |
6867 checked to start with a capital letter. If not then it is highlighted | |
484 | 6868 with SpellCap |hl-SpellCap| (unless the word is also badly spelled). |
386 | 6869 When this check is not wanted make this option empty. |
6870 Only used when 'spell' is set. | |
389 | 6871 Be careful with special characters, see |option-backslash| about |
6872 including spaces and backslashes. | |
480 | 6873 To set this option automatically depending on the language, see |
6874 |set-spc-auto|. | |
386 | 6875 |
314 | 6876 *'spellfile'* *'spf'* |
6877 'spellfile' 'spf' string (default empty) | |
6878 local to buffer | |
6879 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| | |
6880 feature} | |
6881 Name of the word list file where words are added for the |zg| and |zw| | |
401 | 6882 commands. It must end in ".{encoding}.add". You need to include the |
6883 path, otherwise the file is placed in the current directory. | |
386 | 6884 *E765* |
6885 It may also be a comma separated list of names. A count before the | |
6886 |zg| and |zw| commands can be used to access each. This allows using | |
6887 a personal word list file and a project word list file. | |
314 | 6888 When a word is added while this option is empty Vim will set it for |
819 | 6889 you: Using the first directory in 'runtimepath' that is writable. If |
6890 there is no "spell" directory yet it will be created. For the file | |
6891 name the first language name that appears in 'spelllang' is used, | |
353 | 6892 ignoring the region. |
6893 The resulting ".spl" file will be used for spell checking, it does not | |
6894 have to appear in 'spelllang'. | |
6895 Normally one file is used for all regions, but you can add the region | |
6896 name if you want to. However, it will then only be used when | |
6897 'spellfile' is set to it, for entries in 'spelllang' only files | |
6898 without region name will be found. | |
336 | 6899 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
6900 security reasons. | |
314 | 6901 |
221 | 6902 *'spelllang'* *'spl'* |
314 | 6903 'spelllang' 'spl' string (default "en") |
221 | 6904 local to buffer |
6905 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| | |
6906 feature} | |
353 | 6907 A comma separated list of word list names. When the 'spell' option is |
6908 on spellchecking will be done for these languages. Example: > | |
6909 set spelllang=en_us,nl,medical | |
6910 < This means US English, Dutch and medical words are recognized. Words | |
6911 that are not recognized will be highlighted. | |
16380 | 6912 The word list name must consist of alphanumeric characters, a dash or |
6913 an underscore. It should not include a comma or dot. Using a dash is | |
353 | 6914 recommended to separate the two letter language name from a |
6915 specification. Thus "en-rare" is used for rare English words. | |
6916 A region name must come last and have the form "_xx", where "xx" is | |
6917 the two-letter, lower case region name. You can use more than one | |
6918 region by listing them: "en_us,en_ca" supports both US and Canadian | |
6919 English, but not words specific for Australia, New Zealand or Great | |
7477
05cf4cc72a9f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/fa7353428f705f7a13465a1943dddeede4083023
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7272
diff
changeset
|
6920 Britain. (Note: currently en_au and en_nz dictionaries are older than |
05cf4cc72a9f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/fa7353428f705f7a13465a1943dddeede4083023
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7272
diff
changeset
|
6921 en_ca, en_gb and en_us). |
5477 | 6922 If the name "cjk" is included East Asian characters are excluded from |
6923 spell checking. This is useful when editing text that also has Asian | |
6924 words. | |
484 | 6925 *E757* |
419 | 6926 As a special case the name of a .spl file can be given as-is. The |
6927 first "_xx" in the name is removed and used as the region name | |
6928 (_xx is an underscore, two letters and followed by a non-letter). | |
6929 This is mainly for testing purposes. You must make sure the correct | |
6930 encoding is used, Vim doesn't check it. | |
236 | 6931 When 'encoding' is set the word lists are reloaded. Thus it's a good |
419 | 6932 idea to set 'spelllang' after setting 'encoding' to avoid loading the |
6933 files twice. | |
353 | 6934 How the related spell files are found is explained here: |spell-load|. |
221 | 6935 |
653 | 6936 If the |spellfile.vim| plugin is active and you use a language name |
6937 for which Vim cannot find the .spl file in 'runtimepath' the plugin | |
6938 will ask you if you want to download the file. | |
6939 | |
480 | 6940 After this option has been set successfully, Vim will source the files |
6941 "spell/LANG.vim" in 'runtimepath'. "LANG" is the value of 'spelllang' | |
15068 | 6942 up to the first character that is not an ASCII letter or number and |
6943 not a dash. Also see |set-spc-auto|. | |
480 | 6944 |
6945 | |
344 | 6946 *'spellsuggest'* *'sps'* |
6947 'spellsuggest' 'sps' string (default "best") | |
6948 global | |
6949 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| | |
6950 feature} | |
593 | 6951 Methods used for spelling suggestions. Both for the |z=| command and |
374 | 6952 the |spellsuggest()| function. This is a comma-separated list of |
6953 items: | |
6954 | |
6955 best Internal method that works best for English. Finds | |
6956 changes like "fast" and uses a bit of sound-a-like | |
6957 scoring to improve the ordering. | |
6958 | |
6959 double Internal method that uses two methods and mixes the | |
6960 results. The first method is "fast", the other method | |
344 | 6961 computes how much the suggestion sounds like the bad |
374 | 6962 word. That only works when the language specifies |
6963 sound folding. Can be slow and doesn't always give | |
6964 better results. | |
6965 | |
6966 fast Internal method that only checks for simple changes: | |
6967 character inserts/deletes/swaps. Works well for | |
6968 simple typing mistakes. | |
6969 | |
593 | 6970 {number} The maximum number of suggestions listed for |z=|. |
484 | 6971 Not used for |spellsuggest()|. The number of |
6972 suggestions is never more than the value of 'lines' | |
6973 minus two. | |
6974 | |
374 | 6975 file:{filename} Read file {filename}, which must have two columns, |
6976 separated by a slash. The first column contains the | |
6977 bad word, the second column the suggested good word. | |
6978 Example: | |
6979 theribal/terrible ~ | |
6980 Use this for common mistakes that do not appear at the | |
6981 top of the suggestion list with the internal methods. | |
6982 Lines without a slash are ignored, use this for | |
6983 comments. | |
5862 | 6984 The word in the second column must be correct, |
6985 otherwise it will not be used. Add the word to an | |
6986 ".add" file if it is currently flagged as a spelling | |
6987 mistake. | |
374 | 6988 The file is used for all languages. |
6989 | |
6990 expr:{expr} Evaluate expression {expr}. Use a function to avoid | |
6991 trouble with spaces. |v:val| holds the badly spelled | |
6992 word. The expression must evaluate to a List of | |
6993 Lists, each with a suggestion and a score. | |
6994 Example: | |
11062 | 6995 [['the', 33], ['that', 44]] ~ |
593 | 6996 Set 'verbose' and use |z=| to see the scores that the |
374 | 6997 internal methods use. A lower score is better. |
6998 This may invoke |spellsuggest()| if you temporarily | |
6999 set 'spellsuggest' to exclude the "expr:" part. | |
7000 Errors are silently ignored, unless you set the | |
7001 'verbose' option to a non-zero value. | |
7002 | |
7003 Only one of "best", "double" or "fast" may be used. The others may | |
7004 appear several times in any order. Example: > | |
7005 :set sps=file:~/.vim/sugg,best,expr:MySuggest() | |
7006 < | |
7007 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
7008 security reasons. | |
344 | 7009 |
7010 | |
7 | 7011 *'splitbelow'* *'sb'* *'nosplitbelow'* *'nosb'* |
7012 'splitbelow' 'sb' boolean (default off) | |
7013 global | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
7014 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| |
7 | 7015 feature} |
7016 When on, splitting a window will put the new window below the current | |
7017 one. |:split| | |
7018 | |
7019 *'splitright'* *'spr'* *'nosplitright'* *'nospr'* | |
7020 'splitright' 'spr' boolean (default off) | |
7021 global | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
7022 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit| |
7 | 7023 feature} |
7024 When on, splitting a window will put the new window right of the | |
7025 current one. |:vsplit| | |
7026 | |
7027 *'startofline'* *'sol'* *'nostartofline'* *'nosol'* | |
7028 'startofline' 'sol' boolean (default on) | |
7029 global | |
7030 When "on" the commands listed below move the cursor to the first | |
11 | 7031 non-blank of the line. When off the cursor is kept in the same column |
10 | 7032 (if possible). This applies to the commands: CTRL-D, CTRL-U, CTRL-B, |
11 | 7033 CTRL-F, "G", "H", "M", "L", gg, and to the commands "d", "<<" and ">>" |
7 | 7034 with a linewise operator, with "%" with a count and to buffer changing |
7035 commands (CTRL-^, :bnext, :bNext, etc.). Also for an Ex command that | |
7036 only has a line number, e.g., ":25" or ":+". | |
7037 In case of buffer changing commands the cursor is placed at the column | |
7038 where it was the last time the buffer was edited. | |
7039 NOTE: This option is set when 'compatible' is set. | |
7040 | |
2709 | 7041 *'statusline'* *'stl'* *E540* *E542* |
7 | 7042 'statusline' 'stl' string (default empty) |
40 | 7043 global or local to window |global-local| |
7 | 7044 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline| |
7045 feature} | |
7046 When nonempty, this option determines the content of the status line. | |
7047 Also see |status-line|. | |
7048 | |
7049 The option consists of printf style '%' items interspersed with | |
7050 normal text. Each status line item is of the form: | |
7051 %-0{minwid}.{maxwid}{item} | |
7876
93f747af7b58
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/5e9b2fa9bb0e6061cf18457c173cd141a5dc9c92
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7687
diff
changeset
|
7052 All fields except the {item} are optional. A single percent sign can |
2709 | 7053 be given as "%%". Up to 80 items can be specified. *E541* |
7 | 7054 |
680 | 7055 When the option starts with "%!" then it is used as an expression, |
7056 evaluated and the result is used as the option value. Example: > | |
7057 :set statusline=%!MyStatusLine() | |
7058 < The result can contain %{} items that will be evaluated too. | |
3445 | 7059 Note that the "%!" expression is evaluated in the context of the |
7060 current window and buffer, while %{} items are evaluated in the | |
7061 context of the window that the statusline belongs to. | |
680 | 7062 |
7063 When there is error while evaluating the option then it will be made | |
7064 empty to avoid further errors. Otherwise screen updating would loop. | |
7065 | |
7 | 7066 Note that the only effect of 'ruler' when this option is set (and |
7067 'laststatus' is 2) is controlling the output of |CTRL-G|. | |
7068 | |
7069 field meaning ~ | |
233 | 7070 - Left justify the item. The default is right justified |
7 | 7071 when minwid is larger than the length of the item. |
233 | 7072 0 Leading zeroes in numeric items. Overridden by '-'. |
7 | 7073 minwid Minimum width of the item, padding as set by '-' & '0'. |
7074 Value must be 50 or less. | |
10 | 7075 maxwid Maximum width of the item. Truncation occurs with a '<' |
7 | 7076 on the left for text items. Numeric items will be |
7077 shifted down to maxwid-2 digits followed by '>'number | |
7078 where number is the amount of missing digits, much like | |
7079 an exponential notation. | |
7080 item A one letter code as described below. | |
7081 | |
7082 Following is a description of the possible statusline items. The | |
7083 second character in "item" is the type: | |
7084 N for number | |
7085 S for string | |
7086 F for flags as described below | |
7087 - not applicable | |
7088 | |
7089 item meaning ~ | |
1152 | 7090 f S Path to the file in the buffer, as typed or relative to current |
7091 directory. | |
7 | 7092 F S Full path to the file in the buffer. |
7093 t S File name (tail) of file in the buffer. | |
1698 | 7094 m F Modified flag, text is "[+]"; "[-]" if 'modifiable' is off. |
7 | 7095 M F Modified flag, text is ",+" or ",-". |
1698 | 7096 r F Readonly flag, text is "[RO]". |
7 | 7097 R F Readonly flag, text is ",RO". |
1698 | 7098 h F Help buffer flag, text is "[help]". |
7 | 7099 H F Help buffer flag, text is ",HLP". |
1698 | 7100 w F Preview window flag, text is "[Preview]". |
7 | 7101 W F Preview window flag, text is ",PRV". |
1698 | 7102 y F Type of file in the buffer, e.g., "[vim]". See 'filetype'. |
7 | 7103 Y F Type of file in the buffer, e.g., ",VIM". See 'filetype'. |
2411
68e394361ca3
Add "q" item for 'statusline'. Add w:quickfix_title. (Lech Lorens)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2400
diff
changeset
|
7104 q S "[Quickfix List]", "[Location List]" or empty. |
7 | 7105 k S Value of "b:keymap_name" or 'keymap' when |:lmap| mappings are |
7106 being used: "<keymap>" | |
7107 n N Buffer number. | |
2709 | 7108 b N Value of character under cursor. |
7 | 7109 B N As above, in hexadecimal. |
7110 o N Byte number in file of byte under cursor, first byte is 1. | |
7111 Mnemonic: Offset from start of file (with one added) | |
7112 {not available when compiled without |+byte_offset| feature} | |
7113 O N As above, in hexadecimal. | |
233 | 7114 N N Printer page number. (Only works in the 'printheader' option.) |
7 | 7115 l N Line number. |
7116 L N Number of lines in buffer. | |
7117 c N Column number. | |
7118 v N Virtual column number. | |
10 | 7119 V N Virtual column number as -{num}. Not displayed if equal to 'c'. |
7 | 7120 p N Percentage through file in lines as in |CTRL-G|. |
7121 P S Percentage through file of displayed window. This is like the | |
5055 | 7122 percentage described for 'ruler'. Always 3 in length, unless |
7123 translated. | |
233 | 7124 a S Argument list status as in default title. ({current} of {max}) |
7 | 7125 Empty if the argument file count is zero or one. |
680 | 7126 { NF Evaluate expression between '%{' and '}' and substitute result. |
13742
a34b1323286c
patch 8.0.1743: terminal window options are named inconsistently
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13735
diff
changeset
|
7127 Note that there is no '%' before the closing '}'. The |
a34b1323286c
patch 8.0.1743: terminal window options are named inconsistently
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13735
diff
changeset
|
7128 expression cannot contain a '}' character, call a function to |
a34b1323286c
patch 8.0.1743: terminal window options are named inconsistently
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13735
diff
changeset
|
7129 work around that. |
7 | 7130 ( - Start of item group. Can be used for setting the width and |
7131 alignment of a section. Must be followed by %) somewhere. | |
7132 ) - End of item group. No width fields allowed. | |
681 | 7133 T N For 'tabline': start of tab page N label. Use %T after the last |
7134 label. This information is used for mouse clicks. | |
7135 X N For 'tabline': start of close tab N label. Use %X after the | |
7136 label, e.g.: %3Xclose%X. Use %999X for a "close current tab" | |
7137 mark. This information is used for mouse clicks. | |
7 | 7138 < - Where to truncate line if too long. Default is at the start. |
7139 No width fields allowed. | |
7140 = - Separation point between left and right aligned items. | |
7141 No width fields allowed. | |
680 | 7142 # - Set highlight group. The name must follow and then a # again. |
7143 Thus use %#HLname# for highlight group HLname. The same | |
7144 highlighting is used, also for the statusline of non-current | |
7145 windows. | |
7 | 7146 * - Set highlight group to User{N}, where {N} is taken from the |
233 | 7147 minwid field, e.g. %1*. Restore normal highlight with %* or %0*. |
7 | 7148 The difference between User{N} and StatusLine will be applied |
7149 to StatusLineNC for the statusline of non-current windows. | |
7150 The number N must be between 1 and 9. See |hl-User1..9| | |
7151 | |
1698 | 7152 When displaying a flag, Vim removes the leading comma, if any, when |
7153 that flag comes right after plaintext. This will make a nice display | |
7154 when flags are used like in the examples below. | |
7 | 7155 |
233 | 7156 When all items in a group becomes an empty string (i.e. flags that are |
7 | 7157 not set) and a minwid is not set for the group, the whole group will |
7158 become empty. This will make a group like the following disappear | |
7159 completely from the statusline when none of the flags are set. > | |
7160 :set statusline=...%(\ [%M%R%H]%)... | |
7245
8896150aba23
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e392eb41f8dfc01bd13634e534ac6b4d505326f4
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7233
diff
changeset
|
7161 < *g:actual_curbuf* |
7 | 7162 Beware that an expression is evaluated each and every time the status |
7163 line is displayed. The current buffer and current window will be set | |
7164 temporarily to that of the window (and buffer) whose statusline is | |
233 | 7165 currently being drawn. The expression will evaluate in this context. |
14519 | 7166 The variable "g:actual_curbuf" is set to the `bufnr()` number of the |
634 | 7167 real current buffer. |
7168 | |
3682 | 7169 The 'statusline' option will be evaluated in the |sandbox| if set from |
7170 a modeline, see |sandbox-option|. | |
634 | 7171 |
7172 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while | |
7173 evaluating 'statusline' |textlock|. | |
7 | 7174 |
7175 If the statusline is not updated when you want it (e.g., after setting | |
7176 a variable that's used in an expression), you can force an update by | |
7177 setting an option without changing its value. Example: > | |
7178 :let &ro = &ro | |
7179 | |
7180 < A result of all digits is regarded a number for display purposes. | |
7181 Otherwise the result is taken as flag text and applied to the rules | |
7182 described above. | |
7183 | |
199 | 7184 Watch out for errors in expressions. They may render Vim unusable! |
7 | 7185 If you are stuck, hold down ':' or 'Q' to get a prompt, then quit and |
11666
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
7186 edit your .vimrc or whatever with "vim --clean" to get it right. |
7 | 7187 |
7188 Examples: | |
7189 Emulate standard status line with 'ruler' set > | |
7190 :set statusline=%<%f\ %h%m%r%=%-14.(%l,%c%V%)\ %P | |
7191 < Similar, but add ASCII value of char under the cursor (like "ga") > | |
7192 :set statusline=%<%f%h%m%r%=%b\ 0x%B\ \ %l,%c%V\ %P | |
7193 < Display byte count and byte value, modified flag in red. > | |
7194 :set statusline=%<%f%=\ [%1*%M%*%n%R%H]\ %-19(%3l,%02c%03V%)%O'%02b' | |
7195 :hi User1 term=inverse,bold cterm=inverse,bold ctermfg=red | |
7196 < Display a ,GZ flag if a compressed file is loaded > | |
7197 :set statusline=...%r%{VarExists('b:gzflag','\ [GZ]')}%h... | |
7198 < In the |:autocmd|'s: > | |
7199 :let b:gzflag = 1 | |
7200 < And: > | |
7201 :unlet b:gzflag | |
7202 < And define this function: > | |
7203 :function VarExists(var, val) | |
7204 : if exists(a:var) | return a:val | else | return '' | endif | |
7205 :endfunction | |
7206 < | |
7207 *'suffixes'* *'su'* | |
7208 'suffixes' 'su' string (default ".bak,~,.o,.h,.info,.swp,.obj") | |
7209 global | |
7210 Files with these suffixes get a lower priority when multiple files | |
7211 match a wildcard. See |suffixes|. Commas can be used to separate the | |
10 | 7212 suffixes. Spaces after the comma are ignored. A dot is also seen as |
7213 the start of a suffix. To avoid a dot or comma being recognized as a | |
7 | 7214 separator, precede it with a backslash (see |option-backslash| about |
7215 including spaces and backslashes). | |
7216 See 'wildignore' for completely ignoring files. | |
7217 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing | |
7218 suffixes from the list. This avoids problems when a future version | |
7219 uses another default. | |
7220 | |
7221 *'suffixesadd'* *'sua'* | |
7222 'suffixesadd' 'sua' string (default "") | |
7223 local to buffer | |
7224 {not available when compiled without the | |
7225 |+file_in_path| feature} | |
7226 Comma separated list of suffixes, which are used when searching for a | |
7227 file for the "gf", "[I", etc. commands. Example: > | |
7228 :set suffixesadd=.java | |
7229 < | |
7230 *'swapfile'* *'swf'* *'noswapfile'* *'noswf'* | |
7231 'swapfile' 'swf' boolean (default on) | |
7232 local to buffer | |
10 | 7233 Use a swapfile for the buffer. This option can be reset when a |
7 | 7234 swapfile is not wanted for a specific buffer. For example, with |
7235 confidential information that even root must not be able to access. | |
7236 Careful: All text will be in memory: | |
7237 - Don't use this for big files. | |
7238 - Recovery will be impossible! | |
7239 A swapfile will only be present when |'updatecount'| is non-zero and | |
7240 'swapfile' is set. | |
7241 When 'swapfile' is reset, the swap file for the current buffer is | |
7242 immediately deleted. When 'swapfile' is set, and 'updatecount' is | |
7243 non-zero, a swap file is immediately created. | |
7244 Also see |swap-file| and |'swapsync'|. | |
5763 | 7245 If you want to open a new buffer without creating a swap file for it, |
7246 use the |:noswapfile| modifier. | |
13341
acd7eaa13d2b
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13314
diff
changeset
|
7247 See 'directory' for where the swap file is created. |
7 | 7248 |
7249 This option is used together with 'bufhidden' and 'buftype' to | |
7250 specify special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|. | |
7251 | |
7252 *'swapsync'* *'sws'* | |
7253 'swapsync' 'sws' string (default "fsync") | |
7254 global | |
7255 When this option is not empty a swap file is synced to disk after | |
10 | 7256 writing to it. This takes some time, especially on busy unix systems. |
7 | 7257 When this option is empty parts of the swap file may be in memory and |
7258 not written to disk. When the system crashes you may lose more work. | |
7259 On Unix the system does a sync now and then without Vim asking for it, | |
7260 so the disadvantage of setting this option off is small. On some | |
7261 systems the swap file will not be written at all. For a unix system | |
7262 setting it to "sync" will use the sync() call instead of the default | |
7263 fsync(), which may work better on some systems. | |
36 | 7264 The 'fsync' option is used for the actual file. |
7 | 7265 |
7266 *'switchbuf'* *'swb'* | |
7267 'switchbuf' 'swb' string (default "") | |
7268 global | |
7269 This option controls the behavior when switching between buffers. | |
7270 Possible values (comma separated list): | |
7271 useopen If included, jump to the first open window that | |
7272 contains the specified buffer (if there is one). | |
7273 Otherwise: Do not examine other windows. | |
7274 This setting is checked with |quickfix| commands, when | |
7275 jumping to errors (":cc", ":cn", "cp", etc.). It is | |
7276 also used in all buffer related split commands, for | |
7277 example ":sbuffer", ":sbnext", or ":sbrewind". | |
825 | 7278 usetab Like "useopen", but also consider windows in other tab |
856 | 7279 pages. |
7 | 7280 split If included, split the current window before loading |
3153 | 7281 a buffer for a |quickfix| command that display errors. |
16086 | 7282 Otherwise: do not split, use current window (when used |
7283 in the quickfix window: the previously used window or | |
7284 split if there is no other window). | |
6843 | 7285 vsplit Just like "split" but split vertically. |
1621 | 7286 newtab Like "split", but open a new tab page. Overrules |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
7287 "split" when both are present. |
7 | 7288 |
410 | 7289 *'synmaxcol'* *'smc'* |
7290 'synmaxcol' 'smc' number (default 3000) | |
7291 local to buffer | |
7292 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| | |
7293 feature} | |
419 | 7294 Maximum column in which to search for syntax items. In long lines the |
7295 text after this column is not highlighted and following lines may not | |
7296 be highlighted correctly, because the syntax state is cleared. | |
410 | 7297 This helps to avoid very slow redrawing for an XML file that is one |
7298 long line. | |
7299 Set to zero to remove the limit. | |
7300 | |
7 | 7301 *'syntax'* *'syn'* |
7302 'syntax' 'syn' string (default empty) | |
7303 local to buffer | |
7304 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| | |
7305 feature} | |
7306 When this option is set, the syntax with this name is loaded, unless | |
7307 syntax highlighting has been switched off with ":syntax off". | |
7308 Otherwise this option does not always reflect the current syntax (the | |
7309 b:current_syntax variable does). | |
7310 This option is most useful in a modeline, for a file which syntax is | |
782 | 7311 not automatically recognized. Example, in an IDL file: |
7312 /* vim: set syntax=idl : */ ~ | |
7313 When a dot appears in the value then this separates two filetype | |
7314 names. Example: | |
7315 /* vim: set syntax=c.doxygen : */ ~ | |
7316 This will use the "c" syntax first, then the "doxygen" syntax. | |
7317 Note that the second one must be prepared to be loaded as an addition, | |
7318 otherwise it will be skipped. More than one dot may appear. | |
7319 To switch off syntax highlighting for the current file, use: > | |
7 | 7320 :set syntax=OFF |
7321 < To switch syntax highlighting on according to the current value of the | |
7322 'filetype' option: > | |
7323 :set syntax=ON | |
7324 < What actually happens when setting the 'syntax' option is that the | |
7325 Syntax autocommand event is triggered with the value as argument. | |
7326 This option is not copied to another buffer, independent of the 's' or | |
7327 'S' flag in 'cpoptions'. | |
36 | 7328 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal. |
7 | 7329 |
699 | 7330 *'tabline'* *'tal'* |
677 | 7331 'tabline' 'tal' string (default empty) |
674 | 7332 global |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
7333 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| |
674 | 7334 feature} |
677 | 7335 When nonempty, this option determines the content of the tab pages |
7336 line at the top of the Vim window. When empty Vim will use a default | |
681 | 7337 tab pages line. See |setting-tabline| for more info. |
677 | 7338 |
7339 The tab pages line only appears as specified with the 'showtabline' | |
688 | 7340 option and only when there is no GUI tab line. When 'e' is in |
7341 'guioptions' and the GUI supports a tab line 'guitablabel' is used | |
2572
ee53a39d5896
Last changes for the 7.3 release!
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2570
diff
changeset
|
7342 instead. Note that the two tab pages lines are very different. |
677 | 7343 |
7344 The value is evaluated like with 'statusline'. You can use | |
7345 |tabpagenr()|, |tabpagewinnr()| and |tabpagebuflist()| to figure out | |
681 | 7346 the text to be displayed. Use "%1T" for the first label, "%2T" for |
7347 the second one, etc. Use "%X" items for closing labels. | |
677 | 7348 |
15396
325e4a8ba1b6
patch 8.1.0706: tabline is not always redrawn
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15281
diff
changeset
|
7349 When changing something that is used in 'tabline' that does not |
325e4a8ba1b6
patch 8.1.0706: tabline is not always redrawn
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15281
diff
changeset
|
7350 trigger it to be updated, use |:redrawtabline|. |
325e4a8ba1b6
patch 8.1.0706: tabline is not always redrawn
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15281
diff
changeset
|
7351 |
677 | 7352 Keep in mind that only one of the tab pages is the current one, others |
7353 are invisible and you can't jump to their windows. | |
7354 | |
674 | 7355 |
699 | 7356 *'tabpagemax'* *'tpm'* |
7357 'tabpagemax' 'tpm' number (default 10) | |
7358 global | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
7359 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| |
699 | 7360 feature} |
7361 Maximum number of tab pages to be opened by the |-p| command line | |
7362 argument or the ":tab all" command. |tabpage| | |
7363 | |
7364 | |
7365 *'tabstop'* *'ts'* | |
7 | 7366 'tabstop' 'ts' number (default 8) |
7367 local to buffer | |
7368 Number of spaces that a <Tab> in the file counts for. Also see | |
7369 |:retab| command, and 'softtabstop' option. | |
7370 | |
7371 Note: Setting 'tabstop' to any other value than 8 can make your file | |
7372 appear wrong in many places (e.g., when printing it). | |
7373 | |
7374 There are four main ways to use tabs in Vim: | |
7375 1. Always keep 'tabstop' at 8, set 'softtabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to 4 | |
7376 (or 3 or whatever you prefer) and use 'noexpandtab'. Then Vim | |
1263 | 7377 will use a mix of tabs and spaces, but typing <Tab> and <BS> will |
7 | 7378 behave like a tab appears every 4 (or 3) characters. |
7379 2. Set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to whatever you prefer and use | |
7380 'expandtab'. This way you will always insert spaces. The | |
7381 formatting will never be messed up when 'tabstop' is changed. | |
7382 3. Set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to whatever you prefer and use a | |
10 | 7383 |modeline| to set these values when editing the file again. Only |
7 | 7384 works when using Vim to edit the file. |
7385 4. Always set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to the same value, and | |
7386 'noexpandtab'. This should then work (for initial indents only) | |
7387 for any tabstop setting that people use. It might be nice to have | |
7388 tabs after the first non-blank inserted as spaces if you do this | |
7389 though. Otherwise aligned comments will be wrong when 'tabstop' is | |
7390 changed. | |
7391 | |
14175
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
7392 If Vim is compiled with the |+vartabs| feature then the value of |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
7393 'tabstop' will be ignored if |'vartabstop'| is set to anything other |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
7394 than an empty string. |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
7395 |
7 | 7396 *'tagbsearch'* *'tbs'* *'notagbsearch'* *'notbs'* |
7397 'tagbsearch' 'tbs' boolean (default on) | |
7398 global | |
7399 When searching for a tag (e.g., for the |:ta| command), Vim can either | |
10 | 7400 use a binary search or a linear search in a tags file. Binary |
7 | 7401 searching makes searching for a tag a LOT faster, but a linear search |
7402 will find more tags if the tags file wasn't properly sorted. | |
7403 Vim normally assumes that your tags files are sorted, or indicate that | |
7404 they are not sorted. Only when this is not the case does the | |
7405 'tagbsearch' option need to be switched off. | |
7406 | |
7407 When 'tagbsearch' is on, binary searching is first used in the tags | |
10 | 7408 files. In certain situations, Vim will do a linear search instead for |
7 | 7409 certain files, or retry all files with a linear search. When |
7410 'tagbsearch' is off, only a linear search is done. | |
7411 | |
7412 Linear searching is done anyway, for one file, when Vim finds a line | |
7413 at the start of the file indicating that it's not sorted: > | |
1621 | 7414 !_TAG_FILE_SORTED 0 /some comment/ |
7 | 7415 < [The whitespace before and after the '0' must be a single <Tab>] |
7416 | |
7417 When a binary search was done and no match was found in any of the | |
7266
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7418 files listed in 'tags', and case is ignored or a pattern is used |
7 | 7419 instead of a normal tag name, a retry is done with a linear search. |
7420 Tags in unsorted tags files, and matches with different case will only | |
7421 be found in the retry. | |
7422 | |
22 | 7423 If a tag file indicates that it is case-fold sorted, the second, |
7266
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7424 linear search can be avoided when case is ignored. Use a value of '2' |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7425 in the "!_TAG_FILE_SORTED" line for this. A tag file can be case-fold |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7426 sorted with the -f switch to "sort" in most unices, as in the command: |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7427 "sort -f -o tags tags". For "Exuberant ctags" version 5.x or higher |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7428 (at least 5.5) the --sort=foldcase switch can be used for this as |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7429 well. Note that case must be folded to uppercase for this to work. |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7430 |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7431 By default, tag searches are case-sensitive. Case is ignored when |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7432 'ignorecase' is set and 'tagcase' is "followic", or when 'tagcase' is |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7433 "ignore". |
9913
bb00c661b3a4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/66e29d7112e437b2b50efe1f82c7e892736d23e4
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9887
diff
changeset
|
7434 Also when 'tagcase' is "followscs" and 'smartcase' is set, or |
bb00c661b3a4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/66e29d7112e437b2b50efe1f82c7e892736d23e4
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9887
diff
changeset
|
7435 'tagcase' is "smart", and the pattern contains only lowercase |
bb00c661b3a4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/66e29d7112e437b2b50efe1f82c7e892736d23e4
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9887
diff
changeset
|
7436 characters. |
7 | 7437 |
7438 When 'tagbsearch' is off, tags searching is slower when a full match | |
7439 exists, but faster when no full match exists. Tags in unsorted tags | |
7440 files may only be found with 'tagbsearch' off. | |
7441 When the tags file is not sorted, or sorted in a wrong way (not on | |
7442 ASCII byte value), 'tagbsearch' should be off, or the line given above | |
7443 must be included in the tags file. | |
7444 This option doesn't affect commands that find all matching tags (e.g., | |
7445 command-line completion and ":help"). | |
7446 {Vi: always uses binary search in some versions} | |
7447 | |
7266
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7448 *'tagcase'* *'tc'* |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7449 'tagcase' 'tc' string (default "followic") |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7450 global or local to buffer |global-local| |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7451 This option specifies how case is handled when searching the tags |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7452 file: |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7453 followic Follow the 'ignorecase' option |
9913
bb00c661b3a4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/66e29d7112e437b2b50efe1f82c7e892736d23e4
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9887
diff
changeset
|
7454 followscs Follow the 'smartcase' and 'ignorecase' options |
7266
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7455 ignore Ignore case |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7456 match Match case |
9913
bb00c661b3a4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/66e29d7112e437b2b50efe1f82c7e892736d23e4
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9887
diff
changeset
|
7457 smart Ignore case unless an upper case letter is used |
11160 | 7458 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is |
7459 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
7266
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7460 |
7 | 7461 *'taglength'* *'tl'* |
7462 'taglength' 'tl' number (default 0) | |
7463 global | |
7464 If non-zero, tags are significant up to this number of characters. | |
7465 | |
7466 *'tagrelative'* *'tr'* *'notagrelative'* *'notr'* | |
7467 'tagrelative' 'tr' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off) | |
7468 global | |
824 | 7469 If on and using a tags file in another directory, file names in that |
7470 tags file are relative to the directory where the tags file is. | |
7 | 7471 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is |
7472 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
7473 | |
7474 *'tags'* *'tag'* *E433* | |
7475 'tags' 'tag' string (default "./tags,tags", when compiled with | |
7476 |+emacs_tags|: "./tags,./TAGS,tags,TAGS") | |
7477 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
7478 Filenames for the tag command, separated by spaces or commas. To | |
7479 include a space or comma in a file name, precede it with a backslash | |
7480 (see |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes). | |
7481 When a file name starts with "./", the '.' is replaced with the path | |
7482 of the current file. But only when the 'd' flag is not included in | |
7483 'cpoptions'. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. Also see | |
7484 |tags-option|. | |
7485 "*", "**" and other wildcards can be used to search for tags files in | |
2522
d7ecfc8b784c
Update help about wildcards in 'tags' option.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2492
diff
changeset
|
7486 a directory tree. See |file-searching|. E.g., "/lib/**/tags" will |
d7ecfc8b784c
Update help about wildcards in 'tags' option.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2492
diff
changeset
|
7487 find all files named "tags" below "/lib". The filename itself cannot |
d7ecfc8b784c
Update help about wildcards in 'tags' option.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2492
diff
changeset
|
7488 contain wildcards, it is used as-is. E.g., "/lib/**/tags?" will find |
d7ecfc8b784c
Update help about wildcards in 'tags' option.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2492
diff
changeset
|
7489 files called "tags?". {not available when compiled without the |
d7ecfc8b784c
Update help about wildcards in 'tags' option.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2492
diff
changeset
|
7490 |+path_extra| feature} |
515 | 7491 The |tagfiles()| function can be used to get a list of the file names |
7492 actually used. | |
7 | 7493 If Vim was compiled with the |+emacs_tags| feature, Emacs-style tag |
7494 files are also supported. They are automatically recognized. The | |
7495 default value becomes "./tags,./TAGS,tags,TAGS", unless case | |
7496 differences are ignored (MS-Windows). |emacs-tags| | |
7497 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing | |
7498 file names from the list. This avoids problems when a future version | |
7499 uses another default. | |
7500 {Vi: default is "tags /usr/lib/tags"} | |
7501 | |
7502 *'tagstack'* *'tgst'* *'notagstack'* *'notgst'* | |
7503 'tagstack' 'tgst' boolean (default on) | |
7504 global | |
7505 When on, the |tagstack| is used normally. When off, a ":tag" or | |
7506 ":tselect" command with an argument will not push the tag onto the | |
7507 tagstack. A following ":tag" without an argument, a ":pop" command or | |
7508 any other command that uses the tagstack will use the unmodified | |
7509 tagstack, but does change the pointer to the active entry. | |
7510 Resetting this option is useful when using a ":tag" command in a | |
7511 mapping which should not change the tagstack. | |
7512 | |
7538
c9fc24b76293
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8a5115cf18751022387af2085f374d38c60dde83
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7528
diff
changeset
|
7513 *'tcldll'* |
8629
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
7514 'tcldll' string (default depends on the build) |
7538
c9fc24b76293
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8a5115cf18751022387af2085f374d38c60dde83
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7528
diff
changeset
|
7515 global |
c9fc24b76293
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8a5115cf18751022387af2085f374d38c60dde83
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7528
diff
changeset
|
7516 {only available when compiled with the |+tcl/dyn| |
c9fc24b76293
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8a5115cf18751022387af2085f374d38c60dde83
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7528
diff
changeset
|
7517 feature} |
c9fc24b76293
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8a5115cf18751022387af2085f374d38c60dde83
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7528
diff
changeset
|
7518 Specifies the name of the Tcl shared library. The default is |
c9fc24b76293
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8a5115cf18751022387af2085f374d38c60dde83
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7528
diff
changeset
|
7519 DYNAMIC_TCL_DLL, which was specified at compile time. |
8951
0bdeaf7092bc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/aa3b15dbebf333282503d6031e2f9ba6ee4398ed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8876
diff
changeset
|
7520 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. |
7538
c9fc24b76293
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8a5115cf18751022387af2085f374d38c60dde83
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7528
diff
changeset
|
7521 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
c9fc24b76293
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8a5115cf18751022387af2085f374d38c60dde83
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7528
diff
changeset
|
7522 security reasons. |
c9fc24b76293
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8a5115cf18751022387af2085f374d38c60dde83
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7528
diff
changeset
|
7523 |
7 | 7524 *'term'* *E529* *E530* *E531* |
7525 'term' string (default is $TERM, if that fails: | |
7526 in the GUI: "builtin_gui" | |
7527 on Amiga: "amiga" | |
7528 on BeOS: "beos-ansi" | |
7529 on Mac: "mac-ansi" | |
7530 on MiNT: "vt52" | |
7531 on MS-DOS: "pcterm" | |
7532 on OS/2: "os2ansi" | |
7533 on Unix: "ansi" | |
7534 on VMS: "ansi" | |
7535 on Win 32: "win32") | |
7536 global | |
7537 Name of the terminal. Used for choosing the terminal control | |
7538 characters. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. | |
7539 For example: > | |
7540 :set term=$TERM | |
7541 < See |termcap|. | |
7542 | |
7543 *'termbidi'* *'tbidi'* | |
7544 *'notermbidi'* *'notbidi'* | |
7545 'termbidi' 'tbidi' boolean (default off, on for "mlterm") | |
7546 global | |
7547 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic| | |
7548 feature} | |
7549 The terminal is in charge of Bi-directionality of text (as specified | |
7550 by Unicode). The terminal is also expected to do the required shaping | |
7551 that some languages (such as Arabic) require. | |
7552 Setting this option implies that 'rightleft' will not be set when | |
7553 'arabic' is set and the value of 'arabicshape' will be ignored. | |
7554 Note that setting 'termbidi' has the immediate effect that | |
7555 'arabicshape' is ignored, but 'rightleft' isn't changed automatically. | |
7556 This option is reset when the GUI is started. | |
7557 For further details see |arabic.txt|. | |
7558 | |
7559 *'termencoding'* *'tenc'* | |
10895
c391bfbdb452
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10734
diff
changeset
|
7560 'termencoding' 'tenc' string (default ""; with GTK+ GUI: "utf-8"; with |
7 | 7561 Macintosh GUI: "macroman") |
7562 global | |
7563 Encoding used for the terminal. This specifies what character | |
7564 encoding the keyboard produces and the display will understand. For | |
8629
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
7565 the GUI it only applies to the keyboard ('encoding' is used for the |
1152 | 7566 display). Except for the Mac when 'macatsui' is off, then |
7567 'termencoding' should be "macroman". | |
7 | 7568 *E617* |
10895
c391bfbdb452
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10734
diff
changeset
|
7569 Note: This does not apply to the GTK+ GUI. After the GUI has been |
7 | 7570 successfully initialized, 'termencoding' is forcibly set to "utf-8". |
7571 Any attempts to set a different value will be rejected, and an error | |
7572 message is shown. | |
7080
1a34f5272977
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ac360bf2ca293735fc7c6654dc2b3066f4c62488
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7051
diff
changeset
|
7573 For the Win32 GUI and console versions 'termencoding' is not used, |
7 | 7574 because the Win32 system always passes Unicode characters. |
7575 When empty, the same encoding is used as for the 'encoding' option. | |
7576 This is the normal value. | |
7577 Not all combinations for 'termencoding' and 'encoding' are valid. See | |
7578 |encoding-table|. | |
7579 The value for this option must be supported by internal conversions or | |
7580 iconv(). When this is not possible no conversion will be done and you | |
7581 will probably experience problems with non-ASCII characters. | |
7582 Example: You are working with the locale set to euc-jp (Japanese) and | |
7583 want to edit a UTF-8 file: > | |
7584 :let &termencoding = &encoding | |
7585 :set encoding=utf-8 | |
7586 < You need to do this when your system has no locale support for UTF-8. | |
7587 | |
13314
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
7588 *'termguicolors'* *'tgc'* *E954* |
9027
773d627cac0b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/61be73bb0f965a895bfb064ea3e55476ac175162
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8969
diff
changeset
|
7589 'termguicolors' 'tgc' boolean (default off) |
773d627cac0b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/61be73bb0f965a895bfb064ea3e55476ac175162
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8969
diff
changeset
|
7590 global |
773d627cac0b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/61be73bb0f965a895bfb064ea3e55476ac175162
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8969
diff
changeset
|
7591 {not available when compiled without the |
773d627cac0b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/61be73bb0f965a895bfb064ea3e55476ac175162
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8969
diff
changeset
|
7592 |+termguicolors| feature} |
773d627cac0b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/61be73bb0f965a895bfb064ea3e55476ac175162
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8969
diff
changeset
|
7593 When on, uses |highlight-guifg| and |highlight-guibg| attributes in |
13314
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
7594 the terminal (thus using 24-bit color). |
13341
acd7eaa13d2b
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13314
diff
changeset
|
7595 |
13314
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
7596 Requires a ISO-8613-3 compatible terminal. If setting this option |
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
7597 does not work (produces a colorless UI) reading |xterm-true-color| |
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
7598 might help. |
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
7599 |
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
7600 For Win32 console, Windows 10 version 1703 (Creators Update) or later |
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
7601 is required. Use this check to find out: > |
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
7602 if has('vcon') |
13341
acd7eaa13d2b
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13314
diff
changeset
|
7603 < This requires Vim to be built with the |+vtp| feature. |
acd7eaa13d2b
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13314
diff
changeset
|
7604 |
11473 | 7605 Note that the "cterm" attributes are still used, not the "gui" ones. |
11160 | 7606 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
9027
773d627cac0b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/61be73bb0f965a895bfb064ea3e55476ac175162
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8969
diff
changeset
|
7607 |
13735 | 7608 *'termwinkey'* *'twk'* |
7609 'termwinkey' 'twk' string (default "") | |
11659
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
7610 local to window |
11914 | 7611 The key that starts a CTRL-W command in a terminal window. Other keys |
11659
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
7612 are sent to the job running in the window. |
11914 | 7613 The <> notation can be used, e.g.: > |
13735 | 7614 :set termwinkey=<C-L> |
11914 | 7615 < The string must be one key stroke but can be multiple bytes. |
7616 When not set CTRL-W is used, so that CTRL-W : gets you to the command | |
13735 | 7617 line. If 'termwinkey' is set to CTRL-L then CTRL-L : gets you to the |
11914 | 7618 command line. |
11659
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
7619 |
16443
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
7620 *'termwinscroll'* *'twsl'* |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
7621 'termwinscroll' 'twsl' number (default 10000) |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
7622 local to buffer |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
7623 {not available when compiled without the |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
7624 |+terminal| feature} |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
7625 Number of scrollback lines to keep. When going over this limit the |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
7626 first 10% of the scrollback lines are deleted. This is just to reduce |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
7627 the memory usage. See |Terminal-Normal|. |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
7628 |
13735 | 7629 *'termwinsize'* *'tws'* |
7630 'termwinsize' 'tws' string (default "") | |
11659
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
7631 local to window |
13700
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7632 Size of the |terminal| window. Format: {rows}x{columns} or |
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7633 {rows}*{columns}. |
11659
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
7634 - When empty the terminal gets the size from the window. |
13700
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7635 - When set with a "x" (e.g., "24x80") the terminal size is not |
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7636 adjusted to the window size. If the window is smaller only the |
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7637 top-left part is displayed. |
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7638 - When set with a "*" (e.g., "10*50") the terminal size follows the |
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7639 window size, but will not be smaller than the specified rows and/or |
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7640 columns. |
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7641 - When rows is zero then use the height of the window. |
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7642 - When columns is zero then use the width of the window. |
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7643 - Using "0x0" or "0*0" is the same as empty. |
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7644 |
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7645 Examples: |
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7646 "30x0" uses 30 rows and the current window width. |
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7647 "20*0" uses at least 20 rows and the current window width. |
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7648 "0*40" uses the current window height and at least 40 columns. |
11757
74abb6c84984
patch 8.0.0761: options not set properly for a terminal buffer
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11666
diff
changeset
|
7649 Note that the command running in the terminal window may still change |
74abb6c84984
patch 8.0.0761: options not set properly for a terminal buffer
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11666
diff
changeset
|
7650 the size of the terminal. In that case the Vim window will be |
74abb6c84984
patch 8.0.0761: options not set properly for a terminal buffer
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11666
diff
changeset
|
7651 adjusted to that size, if possible. |
11659
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
7652 |
15746
c017195b121b
patch 8.1.0880: MS-Windows: inconsistent selection of winpty/conpty
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15729
diff
changeset
|
7653 *'termwintype'* *'twt'* |
c017195b121b
patch 8.1.0880: MS-Windows: inconsistent selection of winpty/conpty
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15729
diff
changeset
|
7654 'termwintype' 'twt' string (default "") |
c017195b121b
patch 8.1.0880: MS-Windows: inconsistent selection of winpty/conpty
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15729
diff
changeset
|
7655 global |
c017195b121b
patch 8.1.0880: MS-Windows: inconsistent selection of winpty/conpty
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15729
diff
changeset
|
7656 {only available when compiled with the |terminal| |
c017195b121b
patch 8.1.0880: MS-Windows: inconsistent selection of winpty/conpty
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15729
diff
changeset
|
7657 feature on MS-Windows} |
c017195b121b
patch 8.1.0880: MS-Windows: inconsistent selection of winpty/conpty
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15729
diff
changeset
|
7658 Specify the virtual console (pty) used when opening the terminal |
c017195b121b
patch 8.1.0880: MS-Windows: inconsistent selection of winpty/conpty
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15729
diff
changeset
|
7659 window. |
c017195b121b
patch 8.1.0880: MS-Windows: inconsistent selection of winpty/conpty
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15729
diff
changeset
|
7660 |
c017195b121b
patch 8.1.0880: MS-Windows: inconsistent selection of winpty/conpty
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15729
diff
changeset
|
7661 Possible values are: |
15804
864ec0dd71b9
patch 8.1.0909: MS-Windows: using ConPTY even though it is not stable
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15746
diff
changeset
|
7662 "" use ConPTY if it is stable, winpty otherwise |
15746
c017195b121b
patch 8.1.0880: MS-Windows: inconsistent selection of winpty/conpty
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15729
diff
changeset
|
7663 "winpty" use winpty, fail if not supported |
c017195b121b
patch 8.1.0880: MS-Windows: inconsistent selection of winpty/conpty
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15729
diff
changeset
|
7664 "conpty" use |ConPTY|, fail if not supported |
c017195b121b
patch 8.1.0880: MS-Windows: inconsistent selection of winpty/conpty
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15729
diff
changeset
|
7665 |
15804
864ec0dd71b9
patch 8.1.0909: MS-Windows: using ConPTY even though it is not stable
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15746
diff
changeset
|
7666 |ConPTY| support depends on the platform. Windows 10 October 2018 |
864ec0dd71b9
patch 8.1.0909: MS-Windows: using ConPTY even though it is not stable
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15746
diff
changeset
|
7667 Update is the first version that supports ConPTY, however it is still |
864ec0dd71b9
patch 8.1.0909: MS-Windows: using ConPTY even though it is not stable
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15746
diff
changeset
|
7668 considered unstable. ConPTY might become stable in the next release |
864ec0dd71b9
patch 8.1.0909: MS-Windows: using ConPTY even though it is not stable
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15746
diff
changeset
|
7669 of Windows 10. winpty support needs to be installed. If neither is |
15746
c017195b121b
patch 8.1.0880: MS-Windows: inconsistent selection of winpty/conpty
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15729
diff
changeset
|
7670 supported then you cannot open a terminal window. |
c017195b121b
patch 8.1.0880: MS-Windows: inconsistent selection of winpty/conpty
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15729
diff
changeset
|
7671 |
7 | 7672 *'terse'* *'noterse'* |
7673 'terse' boolean (default off) | |
7674 global | |
7675 When set: Add 's' flag to 'shortmess' option (this makes the message | |
7676 for a search that hits the start or end of the file not being | |
7677 displayed). When reset: Remove 's' flag from 'shortmess' option. {Vi | |
7678 shortens a lot of messages} | |
7679 | |
7680 *'textauto'* *'ta'* *'notextauto'* *'nota'* | |
7681 'textauto' 'ta' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off) | |
7682 global | |
7683 This option is obsolete. Use 'fileformats'. | |
7684 For backwards compatibility, when 'textauto' is set, 'fileformats' is | |
7685 set to the default value for the current system. When 'textauto' is | |
7686 reset, 'fileformats' is made empty. | |
7687 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is | |
7688 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
7689 | |
7690 *'textmode'* *'tx'* *'notextmode'* *'notx'* | |
7691 'textmode' 'tx' boolean (MS-DOS, Win32 and OS/2: default on, | |
7692 others: default off) | |
7693 local to buffer | |
7694 This option is obsolete. Use 'fileformat'. | |
7695 For backwards compatibility, when 'textmode' is set, 'fileformat' is | |
7696 set to "dos". When 'textmode' is reset, 'fileformat' is set to | |
7697 "unix". | |
7698 | |
7699 *'textwidth'* *'tw'* | |
7700 'textwidth' 'tw' number (default 0) | |
7701 local to buffer | |
7702 Maximum width of text that is being inserted. A longer line will be | |
7703 broken after white space to get this width. A zero value disables | |
7147
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
7704 this. |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
7705 'textwidth' is set to 0 when the 'paste' option is set and restored |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
7706 when 'paste' is reset. |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
7707 When 'textwidth' is zero, 'wrapmargin' may be used. See also |
7 | 7708 'formatoptions' and |ins-textwidth|. |
838 | 7709 When 'formatexpr' is set it will be used to break the line. |
7 | 7710 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set. |
7711 | |
7712 *'thesaurus'* *'tsr'* | |
7713 'thesaurus' 'tsr' string (default "") | |
7714 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
7715 List of file names, separated by commas, that are used to lookup words | |
15033 | 7716 for thesaurus completion commands |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-T|. |
7717 | |
7718 Each line in the file should contain words with similar meaning, | |
7719 separated by non-keyword characters (white space is preferred). | |
7720 Maximum line length is 510 bytes. | |
7721 | |
15131 | 7722 An English word list was added to this github issue: |
7723 https://github.com/vim/vim/issues/629#issuecomment-443293282 | |
7724 Unpack thesaurus_pkg.zip, put the thesaurus.txt file somewhere, e.g. | |
7725 ~/.vim/thesaurus/english.txt, and the 'thesaurus' option to this file | |
7726 name. | |
15033 | 7727 |
10 | 7728 To include a comma in a file name precede it with a backslash. Spaces |
7 | 7729 after a comma are ignored, otherwise spaces are included in the file |
7730 name. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes. | |
7731 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing | |
7732 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version | |
7733 uses another default. | |
7734 Backticks cannot be used in this option for security reasons. | |
7735 | |
7736 *'tildeop'* *'top'* *'notildeop'* *'notop'* | |
7737 'tildeop' 'top' boolean (default off) | |
7738 global | |
7739 When on: The tilde command "~" behaves like an operator. | |
7740 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
7741 | |
7742 *'timeout'* *'to'* *'notimeout'* *'noto'* | |
7743 'timeout' 'to' boolean (default on) | |
7744 global | |
7745 *'ttimeout'* *'nottimeout'* | |
11400
0f8713fe20dc
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11262
diff
changeset
|
7746 'ttimeout' boolean (default off, set in |defaults.vim|) |
7 | 7747 global |
7748 These two options together determine the behavior when part of a | |
7749 mapped key sequence or keyboard code has been received: | |
7750 | |
7751 'timeout' 'ttimeout' action ~ | |
7752 off off do not time out | |
7753 on on or off time out on :mappings and key codes | |
7754 off on time out on key codes | |
7755 | |
7756 If both options are off, Vim will wait until either the complete | |
7757 mapping or key sequence has been received, or it is clear that there | |
7758 is no mapping or key sequence for the received characters. For | |
7759 example: if you have mapped "vl" and Vim has received 'v', the next | |
7760 character is needed to see if the 'v' is followed by an 'l'. | |
7761 When one of the options is on, Vim will wait for about 1 second for | |
7762 the next character to arrive. After that the already received | |
7763 characters are interpreted as single characters. The waiting time can | |
7764 be changed with the 'timeoutlen' option. | |
7765 On slow terminals or very busy systems timing out may cause | |
7766 malfunctioning cursor keys. If both options are off, Vim waits | |
7767 forever after an entered <Esc> if there are key codes that start | |
7768 with <Esc>. You will have to type <Esc> twice. If you do not have | |
7769 problems with key codes, but would like to have :mapped key | |
7770 sequences not timing out in 1 second, set the 'ttimeout' option and | |
7771 reset the 'timeout' option. | |
7772 | |
7773 NOTE: 'ttimeout' is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
7774 | |
7775 *'timeoutlen'* *'tm'* | |
7776 'timeoutlen' 'tm' number (default 1000) | |
7777 global | |
7778 {not in all versions of Vi} | |
7779 *'ttimeoutlen'* *'ttm'* | |
11400
0f8713fe20dc
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11262
diff
changeset
|
7780 'ttimeoutlen' 'ttm' number (default -1, set to 100 in |defaults.vim|) |
7 | 7781 global |
7782 The time in milliseconds that is waited for a key code or mapped key | |
7783 sequence to complete. Also used for CTRL-\ CTRL-N and CTRL-\ CTRL-G | |
7784 when part of a command has been typed. | |
7785 Normally only 'timeoutlen' is used and 'ttimeoutlen' is -1. When a | |
7786 different timeout value for key codes is desired set 'ttimeoutlen' to | |
7787 a non-negative number. | |
7788 | |
7789 ttimeoutlen mapping delay key code delay ~ | |
7790 < 0 'timeoutlen' 'timeoutlen' | |
7791 >= 0 'timeoutlen' 'ttimeoutlen' | |
7792 | |
7793 The timeout only happens when the 'timeout' and 'ttimeout' options | |
7794 tell so. A useful setting would be > | |
7795 :set timeout timeoutlen=3000 ttimeoutlen=100 | |
7796 < (time out on mapping after three seconds, time out on key codes after | |
7797 a tenth of a second). | |
7798 | |
7799 *'title'* *'notitle'* | |
7800 'title' boolean (default off, on when title can be restored) | |
7801 global | |
7802 {not available when compiled without the |+title| | |
7803 feature} | |
7804 When on, the title of the window will be set to the value of | |
7805 'titlestring' (if it is not empty), or to: | |
7806 filename [+=-] (path) - VIM | |
7807 Where: | |
7808 filename the name of the file being edited | |
7809 - indicates the file cannot be modified, 'ma' off | |
7810 + indicates the file was modified | |
7811 = indicates the file is read-only | |
7812 =+ indicates the file is read-only and modified | |
7813 (path) is the path of the file being edited | |
7814 - VIM the server name |v:servername| or "VIM" | |
7815 Only works if the terminal supports setting window titles | |
7816 (currently Amiga console, Win32 console, all GUI versions and | |
7817 terminals with a non- empty 't_ts' option - these are Unix xterm and | |
7818 iris-ansi by default, where 't_ts' is taken from the builtin termcap). | |
7819 *X11* | |
7820 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original title will | |
7821 be restored if possible. The output of ":version" will include "+X11" | |
7822 when HAVE_X11 was defined, otherwise it will be "-X11". This also | |
7823 works for the icon name |'icon'|. | |
7824 But: When Vim was started with the |-X| argument, restoring the title | |
7825 will not work (except in the GUI). | |
7826 If the title cannot be restored, it is set to the value of 'titleold'. | |
7827 You might want to restore the title outside of Vim then. | |
7828 When using an xterm from a remote machine you can use this command: | |
7829 rsh machine_name xterm -display $DISPLAY & | |
7830 then the WINDOWID environment variable should be inherited and the | |
7831 title of the window should change back to what it should be after | |
7832 exiting Vim. | |
7833 | |
7834 *'titlelen'* | |
7835 'titlelen' number (default 85) | |
7836 global | |
7837 {not available when compiled without the |+title| | |
7838 feature} | |
7839 Gives the percentage of 'columns' to use for the length of the window | |
10 | 7840 title. When the title is longer, only the end of the path name is |
7841 shown. A '<' character before the path name is used to indicate this. | |
7 | 7842 Using a percentage makes this adapt to the width of the window. But |
7843 it won't work perfectly, because the actual number of characters | |
7844 available also depends on the font used and other things in the title | |
7845 bar. When 'titlelen' is zero the full path is used. Otherwise, | |
7846 values from 1 to 30000 percent can be used. | |
7847 'titlelen' is also used for the 'titlestring' option. | |
7848 | |
7849 *'titleold'* | |
7850 'titleold' string (default "Thanks for flying Vim") | |
7851 global | |
7852 {only available when compiled with the |+title| | |
7853 feature} | |
7854 This option will be used for the window title when exiting Vim if the | |
7855 original title cannot be restored. Only happens if 'title' is on or | |
7856 'titlestring' is not empty. | |
36 | 7857 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
7858 security reasons. | |
7 | 7859 *'titlestring'* |
7860 'titlestring' string (default "") | |
7861 global | |
7862 {not available when compiled without the |+title| | |
7863 feature} | |
7864 When this option is not empty, it will be used for the title of the | |
7865 window. This happens only when the 'title' option is on. | |
7866 Only works if the terminal supports setting window titles (currently | |
7867 Amiga console, Win32 console, all GUI versions and terminals with a | |
7868 non-empty 't_ts' option). | |
7869 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original title will | |
10449
222b1432814e
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/5162822914372fc916a93f85848c0c82209e7cec
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10272
diff
changeset
|
7870 be restored if possible, see |X11|. |
7 | 7871 When this option contains printf-style '%' items, they will be |
7872 expanded according to the rules used for 'statusline'. | |
7873 Example: > | |
7874 :auto BufEnter * let &titlestring = hostname() . "/" . expand("%:p") | |
7875 :set title titlestring=%<%F%=%l/%L-%P titlelen=70 | |
7876 < The value of 'titlelen' is used to align items in the middle or right | |
7877 of the available space. | |
7878 Some people prefer to have the file name first: > | |
7879 :set titlestring=%t%(\ %M%)%(\ (%{expand(\"%:~:.:h\")})%)%(\ %a%) | |
7880 < Note the use of "%{ }" and an expression to get the path of the file, | |
10 | 7881 without the file name. The "%( %)" constructs are used to add a |
7 | 7882 separating space only when needed. |
7883 NOTE: Use of special characters in 'titlestring' may cause the display | |
7884 to be garbled (e.g., when it contains a CR or NL character). | |
7885 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline| feature} | |
7886 | |
7887 *'toolbar'* *'tb'* | |
7888 'toolbar' 'tb' string (default "icons,tooltips") | |
7889 global | |
7890 {only for |+GUI_GTK|, |+GUI_Athena|, |+GUI_Motif| and | |
7891 |+GUI_Photon|} | |
10 | 7892 The contents of this option controls various toolbar settings. The |
7 | 7893 possible values are: |
7894 icons Toolbar buttons are shown with icons. | |
7895 text Toolbar buttons shown with text. | |
7896 horiz Icon and text of a toolbar button are | |
10 | 7897 horizontally arranged. {only in GTK+ 2 GUI} |
7 | 7898 tooltips Tooltips are active for toolbar buttons. |
7899 Tooltips refer to the popup help text which appears after the mouse | |
7900 cursor is placed over a toolbar button for a brief moment. | |
7901 | |
7902 If you want the toolbar to be shown with icons as well as text, do the | |
7903 following: > | |
7904 :set tb=icons,text | |
7905 < Motif and Athena cannot display icons and text at the same time. They | |
7906 will show icons if both are requested. | |
7907 | |
7908 If none of the strings specified in 'toolbar' are valid or if | |
7909 'toolbar' is empty, this option is ignored. If you want to disable | |
7910 the toolbar, you need to set the 'guioptions' option. For example: > | |
7911 :set guioptions-=T | |
7912 < Also see |gui-toolbar|. | |
7913 | |
7914 *'toolbariconsize'* *'tbis'* | |
7915 'toolbariconsize' 'tbis' string (default "small") | |
7916 global | |
10895
c391bfbdb452
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10734
diff
changeset
|
7917 {only in the GTK+ GUI} |
7 | 7918 Controls the size of toolbar icons. The possible values are: |
8497
da01d5da2cfa
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/77cdfd10382e01cc51f4ba1a9177032351843151
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8246
diff
changeset
|
7919 tiny Use tiny icons. |
da01d5da2cfa
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/77cdfd10382e01cc51f4ba1a9177032351843151
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8246
diff
changeset
|
7920 small Use small icons (default). |
da01d5da2cfa
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/77cdfd10382e01cc51f4ba1a9177032351843151
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8246
diff
changeset
|
7921 medium Use medium-sized icons. |
da01d5da2cfa
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/77cdfd10382e01cc51f4ba1a9177032351843151
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8246
diff
changeset
|
7922 large Use large icons. |
da01d5da2cfa
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/77cdfd10382e01cc51f4ba1a9177032351843151
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8246
diff
changeset
|
7923 huge Use even larger icons. |
da01d5da2cfa
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/77cdfd10382e01cc51f4ba1a9177032351843151
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8246
diff
changeset
|
7924 giant Use very big icons. |
7 | 7925 The exact dimensions in pixels of the various icon sizes depend on |
8497
da01d5da2cfa
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/77cdfd10382e01cc51f4ba1a9177032351843151
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8246
diff
changeset
|
7926 the current theme. Common dimensions are giant=48x48, huge=32x32, |
da01d5da2cfa
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/77cdfd10382e01cc51f4ba1a9177032351843151
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8246
diff
changeset
|
7927 large=24x24, medium=24x24, small=20x20 and tiny=16x16. |
7 | 7928 |
7929 If 'toolbariconsize' is empty, the global default size as determined | |
7930 by user preferences or the current theme is used. | |
7931 | |
7932 *'ttybuiltin'* *'tbi'* *'nottybuiltin'* *'notbi'* | |
7933 'ttybuiltin' 'tbi' boolean (default on) | |
7934 global | |
7935 When on, the builtin termcaps are searched before the external ones. | |
7936 When off the builtin termcaps are searched after the external ones. | |
7937 When this option is changed, you should set the 'term' option next for | |
7938 the change to take effect, for example: > | |
7939 :set notbi term=$TERM | |
7940 < See also |termcap|. | |
7941 Rationale: The default for this option is "on", because the builtin | |
7942 termcap entries are generally better (many systems contain faulty | |
7943 xterm entries...). | |
7944 | |
7945 *'ttyfast'* *'tf'* *'nottyfast'* *'notf'* | |
7946 'ttyfast' 'tf' boolean (default off, on when 'term' is xterm, hpterm, | |
7947 sun-cmd, screen, rxvt, dtterm or | |
7948 iris-ansi; also on when running Vim in | |
7949 a DOS console) | |
7950 global | |
7951 Indicates a fast terminal connection. More characters will be sent to | |
7952 the screen for redrawing, instead of using insert/delete line | |
7953 commands. Improves smoothness of redrawing when there are multiple | |
7954 windows and the terminal does not support a scrolling region. | |
7955 Also enables the extra writing of characters at the end of each screen | |
7956 line for lines that wrap. This helps when using copy/paste with the | |
7957 mouse in an xterm and other terminals. | |
7958 | |
7959 *'ttymouse'* *'ttym'* | |
7960 'ttymouse' 'ttym' string (default depends on 'term') | |
7961 global | |
7962 {only in Unix and VMS, doesn't work in the GUI; not | |
7963 available when compiled without |+mouse|} | |
7964 Name of the terminal type for which mouse codes are to be recognized. | |
1213 | 7965 Currently these strings are valid: |
7 | 7966 *xterm-mouse* |
7967 xterm xterm-like mouse handling. The mouse generates | |
7968 "<Esc>[Mscr", where "scr" is three bytes: | |
7969 "s" = button state | |
7970 "c" = column plus 33 | |
7971 "r" = row plus 33 | |
5908 | 7972 This only works up to 223 columns! See "dec", |
7973 "urxvt", and "sgr" for solutions. | |
7 | 7974 xterm2 Works like "xterm", but with the xterm reporting the |
7975 mouse position while the mouse is dragged. This works | |
7976 much faster and more precise. Your xterm must at | |
180 | 7977 least at patchlevel 88 / XFree 3.3.3 for this to |
7 | 7978 work. See below for how Vim detects this |
7979 automatically. | |
7980 *netterm-mouse* | |
7981 netterm NetTerm mouse handling. The mouse generates | |
7982 "<Esc>}r,c<CR>", where "r,c" are two decimal numbers | |
7983 for the row and column. | |
7984 *dec-mouse* | |
7985 dec DEC terminal mouse handling. The mouse generates a | |
7986 rather complex sequence, starting with "<Esc>[". | |
189 | 7987 This is also available for an Xterm, if it was |
7988 configured with "--enable-dec-locator". | |
7 | 7989 *jsbterm-mouse* |
7990 jsbterm JSB term mouse handling. | |
7991 *pterm-mouse* | |
7992 pterm QNX pterm mouse handling. | |
3224 | 7993 *urxvt-mouse* |
7994 urxvt Mouse handling for the urxvt (rxvt-unicode) terminal. | |
5908 | 7995 The mouse works only if the terminal supports this |
7996 encoding style, but it does not have 223 columns limit | |
7997 unlike "xterm" or "xterm2". | |
3750 | 7998 *sgr-mouse* |
7999 sgr Mouse handling for the terminal that emits SGR-styled | |
5908 | 8000 mouse reporting. The mouse works even in columns |
8001 beyond 223. This option is backward compatible with | |
8002 "xterm2" because it can also decode "xterm2" style | |
8003 mouse codes. | |
7 | 8004 |
8005 The mouse handling must be enabled at compile time |+mouse_xterm| | |
5908 | 8006 |+mouse_dec| |+mouse_netterm| |+mouse_jsbterm| |+mouse_urxvt| |
8007 |+mouse_sgr|. | |
7 | 8008 Only "xterm"(2) is really recognized. NetTerm mouse codes are always |
8009 recognized, if enabled at compile time. DEC terminal mouse codes | |
8010 are recognized if enabled at compile time, and 'ttymouse' is not | |
5908 | 8011 "xterm", "xterm2", "urxvt" or "sgr" (because dec mouse codes conflict |
8012 with them). | |
7 | 8013 This option is automatically set to "xterm", when the 'term' option is |
10272
57b2b8268d3a
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/4575876dc865d4160f20d61bd822fbe7cafbec41
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10261
diff
changeset
|
8014 set to a name that starts with "xterm", "mlterm", "screen", "tmux", |
57b2b8268d3a
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/4575876dc865d4160f20d61bd822fbe7cafbec41
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10261
diff
changeset
|
8015 "st" (full match only), "st-" or "stterm", and 'ttymouse' is not set |
57b2b8268d3a
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/4575876dc865d4160f20d61bd822fbe7cafbec41
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10261
diff
changeset
|
8016 already. |
5908 | 8017 Additionally, if vim is compiled with the |+termresponse| feature and |
8018 |t_RV| is set to the escape sequence to request the xterm version | |
8019 number, more intelligent detection process runs. | |
7 | 8020 The "xterm2" value will be set if the xterm version is reported to be |
15131 | 8021 from 95 to 276. The "sgr" value will be set if Vim detects Mac |
8022 Terminal.app, iTerm2 or mintty, and when the xterm version is 277 or | |
8023 higher. | |
5908 | 8024 If you do not want 'ttymouse' to be set to "xterm2" or "sgr" |
8025 automatically, set t_RV to an empty string: > | |
7 | 8026 :set t_RV= |
8027 < | |
8028 *'ttyscroll'* *'tsl'* | |
8029 'ttyscroll' 'tsl' number (default 999) | |
8030 global | |
8031 Maximum number of lines to scroll the screen. If there are more lines | |
8032 to scroll the window is redrawn. For terminals where scrolling is | |
8033 very slow and redrawing is not slow this can be set to a small number, | |
8034 e.g., 3, to speed up displaying. | |
8035 | |
8036 *'ttytype'* *'tty'* | |
8037 'ttytype' 'tty' string (default from $TERM) | |
8038 global | |
8039 Alias for 'term', see above. | |
8040 | |
2214
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8041 *'undodir'* *'udir'* |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8042 'undodir' 'udir' string (default ".") |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8043 global |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
8044 {only when compiled with the |+persistent_undo| feature} |
2214
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8045 List of directory names for undo files, separated with commas. |
2220
b1c70c500de4
Found a way to make the MS-Windows installer wait for the uninstaller to
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2218
diff
changeset
|
8046 See |'backupdir'| for details of the format. |
2218
695ceebf17ca
Fix: :wundo didn't work in a buffer without a name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2214
diff
changeset
|
8047 "." means using the directory of the file. The undo file name for |
695ceebf17ca
Fix: :wundo didn't work in a buffer without a name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2214
diff
changeset
|
8048 "file.txt" is ".file.txt.un~". |
695ceebf17ca
Fix: :wundo didn't work in a buffer without a name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2214
diff
changeset
|
8049 For other directories the file name is the full path of the edited |
695ceebf17ca
Fix: :wundo didn't work in a buffer without a name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2214
diff
changeset
|
8050 file, with path separators replaced with "%". |
2214
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8051 When writing: The first directory that exists is used. "." always |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8052 works, no directories after "." will be used for writing. |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8053 When reading all entries are tried to find an undo file. The first |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8054 undo file that exists is used. When it cannot be read an error is |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8055 given, no further entry is used. |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8056 See |undo-persistence|. |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8057 |
4681
2eb30f341e8d
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4502
diff
changeset
|
8058 *'undofile'* *'noundofile'* *'udf'* *'noudf'* |
2214
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8059 'undofile' 'udf' boolean (default off) |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8060 local to buffer |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
8061 {only when compiled with the |+persistent_undo| feature} |
2214
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8062 When on, Vim automatically saves undo history to an undo file when |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8063 writing a buffer to a file, and restores undo history from the same |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8064 file on buffer read. |
2220
b1c70c500de4
Found a way to make the MS-Windows installer wait for the uninstaller to
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2218
diff
changeset
|
8065 The directory where the undo file is stored is specified by 'undodir'. |
b1c70c500de4
Found a way to make the MS-Windows installer wait for the uninstaller to
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2218
diff
changeset
|
8066 For more information about this feature see |undo-persistence|. |
2394
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8067 The undo file is not read when 'undoreload' causes the buffer from |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8068 before a reload to be saved for undo. |
3920 | 8069 When 'undofile' is turned off the undo file is NOT deleted. |
11160 | 8070 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
2214
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8071 |
7 | 8072 *'undolevels'* *'ul'* |
8073 'undolevels' 'ul' number (default 100, 1000 for Unix, VMS, | |
8074 Win32 and OS/2) | |
5446 | 8075 global or local to buffer |global-local| |
7 | 8076 Maximum number of changes that can be undone. Since undo information |
8077 is kept in memory, higher numbers will cause more memory to be used | |
8078 (nevertheless, a single change can use an unlimited amount of memory). | |
8079 Set to 0 for Vi compatibility: One level of undo and "u" undoes | |
8080 itself: > | |
8081 set ul=0 | |
8082 < But you can also get Vi compatibility by including the 'u' flag in | |
8083 'cpoptions', and still be able to use CTRL-R to repeat undo. | |
2249
6d3d35ff2c2b
Use full path in undofile(). Updated docs.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2240
diff
changeset
|
8084 Also see |undo-two-ways|. |
5446 | 8085 Set to -1 for no undo at all. You might want to do this only for the |
8086 current buffer: > | |
8087 setlocal ul=-1 | |
7 | 8088 < This helps when you run out of memory for a single change. |
6336 | 8089 |
8090 The local value is set to -123456 when the global value is to be used. | |
8091 | |
2249
6d3d35ff2c2b
Use full path in undofile(). Updated docs.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2240
diff
changeset
|
8092 Also see |clear-undo|. |
7 | 8093 |
2394
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8094 *'undoreload'* *'ur'* |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8095 'undoreload' 'ur' number (default 10000) |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8096 global |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8097 Save the whole buffer for undo when reloading it. This applies to the |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8098 ":e!" command and reloading for when the buffer changed outside of |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8099 Vim. |FileChangedShell| |
12559 | 8100 The save only happens when this option is negative or when the number |
2394
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8101 of lines is smaller than the value of this option. |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8102 Set this option to zero to disable undo for a reload. |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8103 |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8104 When saving undo for a reload, any undo file is not read. |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8105 |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8106 Note that this causes the whole buffer to be stored in memory. Set |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8107 this option to a lower value if you run out of memory. |
7 | 8108 |
8109 *'updatecount'* *'uc'* | |
8110 'updatecount' 'uc' number (default: 200) | |
8111 global | |
8112 After typing this many characters the swap file will be written to | |
8113 disk. When zero, no swap file will be created at all (see chapter on | |
8114 recovery |crash-recovery|). 'updatecount' is set to zero by starting | |
8115 Vim with the "-n" option, see |startup|. When editing in readonly | |
8116 mode this option will be initialized to 10000. | |
8117 The swapfile can be disabled per buffer with |'swapfile'|. | |
8118 When 'updatecount' is set from zero to non-zero, swap files are | |
8119 created for all buffers that have 'swapfile' set. When 'updatecount' | |
8120 is set to zero, existing swap files are not deleted. | |
8121 Also see |'swapsync'|. | |
8122 This option has no meaning in buffers where |'buftype'| is "nofile" | |
8123 or "nowrite". | |
8124 | |
8125 *'updatetime'* *'ut'* | |
8126 'updatetime' 'ut' number (default 4000) | |
8127 global | |
8128 If this many milliseconds nothing is typed the swap file will be | |
8129 written to disk (see |crash-recovery|). Also used for the | |
8130 |CursorHold| autocommand event. | |
8131 | |
14175
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8132 *'varsofttabstop'* *'vsts'* |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8133 'varsofttabstop' 'vsts' string (default "") |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8134 local to buffer |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8135 {only available when compiled with the |+vartabs| |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8136 feature} |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8137 A list of the number of spaces that a <Tab> counts for while editing, |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8138 such as inserting a <Tab> or using <BS>. It "feels" like variable- |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8139 width <Tab>s are being inserted, while in fact a mixture of spaces |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8140 and <Tab>s is used. Tab widths are separated with commas, with the |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8141 final value applying to all subsequent tabs. |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8142 |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8143 For example, when editing assembly language files where statements |
14249
4543777545a3
Updated runtime and language files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14175
diff
changeset
|
8144 start in the 9th column and comments in the 41st, it may be useful |
14175
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8145 to use the following: > |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8146 :set varsofttabstop=8,32,8 |
14249
4543777545a3
Updated runtime and language files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14175
diff
changeset
|
8147 < This will set soft tabstops with 8 and 8 + 32 spaces, and 8 more |
4543777545a3
Updated runtime and language files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14175
diff
changeset
|
8148 for every column thereafter. |
14175
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8149 |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8150 Note that the value of |'softtabstop'| will be ignored while |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8151 'varsofttabstop' is set. |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8152 |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8153 *'vartabstop'* *'vts'* |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8154 'vartabstop' 'vts' string (default "") |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8155 local to buffer |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8156 {only available when compiled with the |+vartabs| |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8157 feature} |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8158 A list of the number of spaces that a <Tab> in the file counts for, |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8159 separated by commas. Each value corresponds to one tab, with the |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8160 final value applying to all subsequent tabs. For example: > |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8161 :set vartabstop=4,20,10,8 |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8162 < This will make the first tab 4 spaces wide, the second 20 spaces, |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8163 the third 10 spaces, and all following tabs 8 spaces. |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8164 |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8165 Note that the value of |'tabstop'| will be ignored while 'vartabstop' |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8166 is set. |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8167 |
7 | 8168 *'verbose'* *'vbs'* |
8169 'verbose' 'vbs' number (default 0) | |
8170 global | |
8171 When bigger than zero, Vim will give messages about what it is doing. | |
8172 Currently, these messages are given: | |
8173 >= 1 When the viminfo file is read or written. | |
8174 >= 2 When a file is ":source"'ed. | |
712 | 8175 >= 5 Every searched tags file and include file. |
7 | 8176 >= 8 Files for which a group of autocommands is executed. |
8177 >= 9 Every executed autocommand. | |
8178 >= 12 Every executed function. | |
8179 >= 13 When an exception is thrown, caught, finished, or discarded. | |
8180 >= 14 Anything pending in a ":finally" clause. | |
8181 >= 15 Every executed Ex command (truncated at 200 characters). | |
8182 | |
8183 This option can also be set with the "-V" argument. See |-V|. | |
8184 This option is also set by the |:verbose| command. | |
8185 | |
293 | 8186 When the 'verbosefile' option is set then the verbose messages are not |
8187 displayed. | |
8188 | |
8189 *'verbosefile'* *'vfile'* | |
8190 'verbosefile' 'vfile' string (default empty) | |
8191 global | |
8192 When not empty all messages are written in a file with this name. | |
8193 When the file exists messages are appended. | |
8194 Writing to the file ends when Vim exits or when 'verbosefile' is made | |
2265
b7cb69ab616d
Added salt to blowfish encryption.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2250
diff
changeset
|
8195 empty. Writes are buffered, thus may not show up for some time. |
293 | 8196 Setting 'verbosefile' to a new value is like making it empty first. |
8197 The difference with |:redir| is that verbose messages are not | |
8198 displayed when 'verbosefile' is set. | |
8199 | |
7 | 8200 *'viewdir'* *'vdir'* |
8201 'viewdir' 'vdir' string (default for Amiga, MS-DOS, OS/2 and Win32: | |
8202 "$VIM/vimfiles/view", | |
8203 for Unix: "~/.vim/view", | |
8204 for Macintosh: "$VIM:vimfiles:view" | |
8205 for VMS: "sys$login:vimfiles/view" | |
8206 for RiscOS: "Choices:vimfiles/view") | |
8207 global | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
8208 {not available when compiled without the |+mksession| |
7 | 8209 feature} |
8210 Name of the directory where to store files for |:mkview|. | |
8211 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
8212 security reasons. | |
8213 | |
8214 *'viewoptions'* *'vop'* | |
12824
79a754456110
patch 8.0.1289: mkview always includes the local directory
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12802
diff
changeset
|
8215 'viewoptions' 'vop' string (default: "folds,options,cursor,curdir") |
7 | 8216 global |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
8217 {not available when compiled without the |+mksession| |
7 | 8218 feature} |
8219 Changes the effect of the |:mkview| command. It is a comma separated | |
10 | 8220 list of words. Each word enables saving and restoring something: |
7 | 8221 word save and restore ~ |
8222 cursor cursor position in file and in window | |
8223 folds manually created folds, opened/closed folds and local | |
8224 fold options | |
8225 options options and mappings local to a window or buffer (not | |
8226 global values for local options) | |
6213 | 8227 localoptions same as "options" |
7 | 8228 slash backslashes in file names replaced with forward |
8229 slashes | |
8230 unix with Unix end-of-line format (single <NL>), even when | |
8231 on Windows or DOS | |
12824
79a754456110
patch 8.0.1289: mkview always includes the local directory
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12802
diff
changeset
|
8232 curdir the window-local directory, if set with `:lcd` |
7 | 8233 |
8234 "slash" and "unix" are useful on Windows when sharing view files | |
8235 with Unix. The Unix version of Vim cannot source dos format scripts, | |
8236 but the Windows version of Vim can source unix format scripts. | |
8237 | |
8238 *'viminfo'* *'vi'* *E526* *E527* *E528* | |
8239 'viminfo' 'vi' string (Vi default: "", Vim default for MS-DOS, | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
8240 Windows and OS/2: '100,<50,s10,h,rA:,rB:, |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
8241 for Amiga: '100,<50,s10,h,rdf0:,rdf1:,rdf2: |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
8242 for others: '100,<50,s10,h) |
7 | 8243 global |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
8244 {not available when compiled without the |+viminfo| |
7 | 8245 feature} |
8246 When non-empty, the viminfo file is read upon startup and written | |
11666
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8247 when exiting Vim (see |viminfo-file|). Except when 'viminfofile' is |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8248 "NONE". |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8249 The string should be a comma separated list of parameters, each |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8250 consisting of a single character identifying the particular parameter, |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8251 followed by a number or string which specifies the value of that |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8252 parameter. If a particular character is left out, then the default |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8253 value is used for that parameter. The following is a list of the |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8254 identifying characters and the effect of their value. |
7 | 8255 CHAR VALUE ~ |
3224 | 8256 *viminfo-!* |
7 | 8257 ! When included, save and restore global variables that start |
8258 with an uppercase letter, and don't contain a lowercase | |
8259 letter. Thus "KEEPTHIS and "K_L_M" are stored, but "KeepThis" | |
2607 | 8260 and "_K_L_M" are not. Nested List and Dict items may not be |
2642 | 8261 read back correctly, you end up with an empty item. |
3224 | 8262 *viminfo-quote* |
7 | 8263 " Maximum number of lines saved for each register. Old name of |
8264 the '<' item, with the disadvantage that you need to put a | |
8265 backslash before the ", otherwise it will be recognized as the | |
8266 start of a comment! | |
3224 | 8267 *viminfo-%* |
7 | 8268 % When included, save and restore the buffer list. If Vim is |
8269 started with a file name argument, the buffer list is not | |
8270 restored. If Vim is started without a file name argument, the | |
7272
17333ebd2bbd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d042dc825c9b97dacd84d4728f88300da4d5b6b9
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7266
diff
changeset
|
8271 buffer list is restored from the viminfo file. Quickfix |
17333ebd2bbd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d042dc825c9b97dacd84d4728f88300da4d5b6b9
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7266
diff
changeset
|
8272 ('buftype'), unlisted ('buflisted'), unnamed and buffers on |
17333ebd2bbd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d042dc825c9b97dacd84d4728f88300da4d5b6b9
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7266
diff
changeset
|
8273 removable media (|viminfo-r|) are not saved. |
23 | 8274 When followed by a number, the number specifies the maximum |
8275 number of buffers that are stored. Without a number all | |
8276 buffers are stored. | |
3224 | 8277 *viminfo-'* |
7 | 8278 ' Maximum number of previously edited files for which the marks |
8279 are remembered. This parameter must always be included when | |
8280 'viminfo' is non-empty. | |
8281 Including this item also means that the |jumplist| and the | |
8282 |changelist| are stored in the viminfo file. | |
3224 | 8283 *viminfo-/* |
7 | 8284 / Maximum number of items in the search pattern history to be |
10 | 8285 saved. If non-zero, then the previous search and substitute |
7 | 8286 patterns are also saved. When not included, the value of |
8287 'history' is used. | |
3224 | 8288 *viminfo-:* |
7 | 8289 : Maximum number of items in the command-line history to be |
10 | 8290 saved. When not included, the value of 'history' is used. |
3224 | 8291 *viminfo-<* |
7 | 8292 < Maximum number of lines saved for each register. If zero then |
8293 registers are not saved. When not included, all lines are | |
8294 saved. '"' is the old name for this item. | |
8295 Also see the 's' item below: limit specified in Kbyte. | |
3224 | 8296 *viminfo-@* |
7 | 8297 @ Maximum number of items in the input-line history to be |
10 | 8298 saved. When not included, the value of 'history' is used. |
3224 | 8299 *viminfo-c* |
7 | 8300 c When included, convert the text in the viminfo file from the |
8301 'encoding' used when writing the file to the current | |
233 | 8302 'encoding'. See |viminfo-encoding|. |
3224 | 8303 *viminfo-f* |
7 | 8304 f Whether file marks need to be stored. If zero, file marks ('0 |
8305 to '9, 'A to 'Z) are not stored. When not present or when | |
10 | 8306 non-zero, they are all stored. '0 is used for the current |
7 | 8307 cursor position (when exiting or when doing ":wviminfo"). |
3224 | 8308 *viminfo-h* |
7 | 8309 h Disable the effect of 'hlsearch' when loading the viminfo |
8310 file. When not included, it depends on whether ":nohlsearch" | |
8311 has been used since the last search command. | |
3224 | 8312 *viminfo-n* |
7 | 8313 n Name of the viminfo file. The name must immediately follow |
11666
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8314 the 'n'. Must be at the end of the option! If the |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8315 'viminfofile' option is set, that file name overrides the one |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8316 given here with 'viminfo'. Environment variables are |
9464
be72f4201a1d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/063b9d15abea041a5bfff3ffc4e219e26fd1d4fa
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9407
diff
changeset
|
8317 expanded when opening the file, not when setting the option. |
3224 | 8318 *viminfo-r* |
7 | 8319 r Removable media. The argument is a string (up to the next |
8320 ','). This parameter can be given several times. Each | |
8321 specifies the start of a path for which no marks will be | |
8322 stored. This is to avoid removable media. For MS-DOS you | |
8323 could use "ra:,rb:", for Amiga "rdf0:,rdf1:,rdf2:". You can | |
8324 also use it for temp files, e.g., for Unix: "r/tmp". Case is | |
8325 ignored. Maximum length of each 'r' argument is 50 | |
8326 characters. | |
3224 | 8327 *viminfo-s* |
7 | 8328 s Maximum size of an item in Kbyte. If zero then registers are |
8329 not saved. Currently only applies to registers. The default | |
8330 "s10" will exclude registers with more than 10 Kbyte of text. | |
8331 Also see the '<' item above: line count limit. | |
8332 | |
8333 Example: > | |
8334 :set viminfo='50,<1000,s100,:0,n~/vim/viminfo | |
8335 < | |
8336 '50 Marks will be remembered for the last 50 files you | |
8337 edited. | |
8338 <1000 Contents of registers (up to 1000 lines each) will be | |
8339 remembered. | |
8340 s100 Registers with more than 100 Kbyte text are skipped. | |
8341 :0 Command-line history will not be saved. | |
8342 n~/vim/viminfo The name of the file to use is "~/vim/viminfo". | |
8343 no / Since '/' is not specified, the default will be used, | |
8344 that is, save all of the search history, and also the | |
8345 previous search and substitute patterns. | |
8346 no % The buffer list will not be saved nor read back. | |
8347 no h 'hlsearch' highlighting will be restored. | |
8348 | |
8349 When setting 'viminfo' from an empty value you can use |:rviminfo| to | |
8350 load the contents of the file, this is not done automatically. | |
8351 | |
8352 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
8353 security reasons. | |
11160 | 8354 NOTE: This option is set to the Vim default value when 'compatible' |
8355 is reset. | |
7 | 8356 |
11666
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8357 *'viminfofile'* *'vif'* |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8358 'viminfofile' 'vif' string (default: "") |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8359 global |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8360 {not available when compiled without the |+viminfo| |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8361 feature} |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8362 When non-empty, overrides the file name used for viminfo. |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8363 When equal to "NONE" no viminfo file will be read or written. |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8364 This option can be set with the |-i| command line flag. The |--clean| |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8365 command line flag sets it to "NONE". |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8366 |
7 | 8367 *'virtualedit'* *'ve'* |
8368 'virtualedit' 've' string (default "") | |
8369 global | |
8370 {not available when compiled without the | |
8371 |+virtualedit| feature} | |
8372 A comma separated list of these words: | |
8373 block Allow virtual editing in Visual block mode. | |
8374 insert Allow virtual editing in Insert mode. | |
8375 all Allow virtual editing in all modes. | |
772 | 8376 onemore Allow the cursor to move just past the end of the line |
782 | 8377 |
7 | 8378 Virtual editing means that the cursor can be positioned where there is |
1263 | 8379 no actual character. This can be halfway into a tab or beyond the end |
7 | 8380 of the line. Useful for selecting a rectangle in Visual mode and |
8381 editing a table. | |
772 | 8382 "onemore" is not the same, it will only allow moving the cursor just |
8383 after the last character of the line. This makes some commands more | |
8384 consistent. Previously the cursor was always past the end of the line | |
8385 if the line was empty. But it is far from Vi compatible. It may also | |
782 | 8386 break some plugins or Vim scripts. For example because |l| can move |
8387 the cursor after the last character. Use with care! | |
5220 | 8388 Using the `$` command will move to the last character in the line, not |
782 | 8389 past it. This may actually move the cursor to the left! |
5220 | 8390 The `g$` command will move to the end of the screen line. |
772 | 8391 It doesn't make sense to combine "all" with "onemore", but you will |
8392 not get a warning for it. | |
11160 | 8393 NOTE: This option is set to "" when 'compatible' is set. |
7 | 8394 |
8395 *'visualbell'* *'vb'* *'novisualbell'* *'novb'* *beep* | |
8396 'visualbell' 'vb' boolean (default off) | |
8397 global | |
11659
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8398 Use a visual bell instead of beeping. The terminal code to display the |
7 | 8399 visual bell is given with 't_vb'. When no beep or flash is wanted, |
11659
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8400 use: > |
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8401 :set vb t_vb= |
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8402 < If you want a short flash, you can use this on many terminals: > |
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8403 :set vb t_vb=[?5h$<100>[?5l |
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8404 < Here $<100> specifies the time, you can use a smaller or bigger value |
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8405 to get a shorter or longer flash. |
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8406 |
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8407 Note: Vim will limit the bell to once per half a second. This avoids |
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8408 having to wait for the flashing to finish when there are lots of |
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8409 bells, e.g. on key repeat. This also happens without 'visualbell' |
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8410 set. |
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8411 |
7 | 8412 In the GUI, 't_vb' defaults to "<Esc>|f", which inverts the display |
8413 for 20 msec. If you want to use a different time, use "<Esc>|40f", | |
8414 where 40 is the time in msec. | |
11659
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8415 |
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8416 Note: When the GUI starts, 't_vb' is reset to its default value. You |
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8417 might want to set it again in your |gvimrc|. |
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8418 |
7 | 8419 Does not work on the Amiga, you always get a screen flash. |
8420 Also see 'errorbells'. | |
8421 | |
8422 *'warn'* *'nowarn'* | |
8423 'warn' boolean (default on) | |
8424 global | |
8425 Give a warning message when a shell command is used while the buffer | |
8426 has been changed. | |
8427 | |
8428 *'weirdinvert'* *'wiv'* *'noweirdinvert'* *'nowiv'* | |
8429 'weirdinvert' 'wiv' boolean (default off) | |
8430 global | |
667 | 8431 This option has the same effect as the 't_xs' terminal option. |
7 | 8432 It is provided for backwards compatibility with version 4.x. |
8433 Setting 'weirdinvert' has the effect of making 't_xs' non-empty, and | |
8434 vice versa. Has no effect when the GUI is running. | |
8435 | |
8436 *'whichwrap'* *'ww'* | |
8437 'whichwrap' 'ww' string (Vim default: "b,s", Vi default: "") | |
8438 global | |
8439 Allow specified keys that move the cursor left/right to move to the | |
8440 previous/next line when the cursor is on the first/last character in | |
8441 the line. Concatenate characters to allow this for these keys: | |
8442 char key mode ~ | |
8443 b <BS> Normal and Visual | |
8444 s <Space> Normal and Visual | |
712 | 8445 h "h" Normal and Visual (not recommended) |
8446 l "l" Normal and Visual (not recommended) | |
7 | 8447 < <Left> Normal and Visual |
8448 > <Right> Normal and Visual | |
8449 ~ "~" Normal | |
8450 [ <Left> Insert and Replace | |
8451 ] <Right> Insert and Replace | |
8452 For example: > | |
8453 :set ww=<,>,[,] | |
8454 < allows wrap only when cursor keys are used. | |
8455 When the movement keys are used in combination with a delete or change | |
8456 operator, the <EOL> also counts for a character. This makes "3h" | |
8457 different from "3dh" when the cursor crosses the end of a line. This | |
8458 is also true for "x" and "X", because they do the same as "dl" and | |
8459 "dh". If you use this, you may also want to use the mapping | |
8460 ":map <BS> X" to make backspace delete the character in front of the | |
8461 cursor. | |
714 | 8462 When 'l' is included and it is used after an operator at the end of a |
8463 line then it will not move to the next line. This makes "dl", "cl", | |
8464 "yl" etc. work normally. | |
7 | 8465 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is |
8466 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
8467 | |
8468 *'wildchar'* *'wc'* | |
8469 'wildchar' 'wc' number (Vim default: <Tab>, Vi default: CTRL-E) | |
8470 global | |
8471 Character you have to type to start wildcard expansion in the | |
8472 command-line, as specified with 'wildmode'. | |
1621 | 8473 More info here: |cmdline-completion|. |
7 | 8474 The character is not recognized when used inside a macro. See |
8475 'wildcharm' for that. | |
8476 Although 'wc' is a number option, you can set it to a special key: > | |
8477 :set wc=<Esc> | |
8478 < NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is | |
8479 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
8480 | |
8481 *'wildcharm'* *'wcm'* | |
8482 'wildcharm' 'wcm' number (default: none (0)) | |
8483 global | |
8484 'wildcharm' works exactly like 'wildchar', except that it is | |
233 | 8485 recognized when used inside a macro. You can find "spare" command-line |
8486 keys suitable for this option by looking at |ex-edit-index|. Normally | |
7 | 8487 you'll never actually type 'wildcharm', just use it in mappings that |
8488 automatically invoke completion mode, e.g.: > | |
8489 :set wcm=<C-Z> | |
1621 | 8490 :cnoremap ss so $vim/sessions/*.vim<C-Z> |
7 | 8491 < Then after typing :ss you can use CTRL-P & CTRL-N. |
8492 | |
8493 *'wildignore'* *'wig'* | |
8494 'wildignore' 'wig' string (default "") | |
8495 global | |
8496 {not available when compiled without the |+wildignore| | |
8497 feature} | |
8498 A list of file patterns. A file that matches with one of these | |
3682 | 8499 patterns is ignored when expanding |wildcards|, completing file or |
8500 directory names, and influences the result of |expand()|, |glob()| and | |
8501 |globpath()| unless a flag is passed to disable this. | |
7 | 8502 The pattern is used like with |:autocmd|, see |autocmd-patterns|. |
8503 Also see 'suffixes'. | |
8504 Example: > | |
8505 :set wildignore=*.o,*.obj | |
8506 < The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing | |
8507 a pattern from the list. This avoids problems when a future version | |
8508 uses another default. | |
8509 | |
2652 | 8510 |
2662 | 8511 *'wildignorecase'* *'wic'* *'nowildignorecase'* *'nowic'* |
2652 | 8512 'wildignorecase' 'wic' boolean (default off) |
8513 global | |
8514 When set case is ignored when completing file names and directories. | |
4242 | 8515 Has no effect when 'fileignorecase' is set. |
2652 | 8516 Does not apply when the shell is used to expand wildcards, which |
8517 happens when there are special characters. | |
8518 | |
8519 | |
7 | 8520 *'wildmenu'* *'wmnu'* *'nowildmenu'* *'nowmnu'* |
9669
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
8521 'wildmenu' 'wmnu' boolean (default off, set in |defaults.vim|) |
7 | 8522 global |
8523 {not available if compiled without the |+wildmenu| | |
8524 feature} | |
8525 When 'wildmenu' is on, command-line completion operates in an enhanced | |
8526 mode. On pressing 'wildchar' (usually <Tab>) to invoke completion, | |
8527 the possible matches are shown just above the command line, with the | |
8528 first match highlighted (overwriting the status line, if there is | |
8529 one). Keys that show the previous/next match, such as <Tab> or | |
8530 CTRL-P/CTRL-N, cause the highlight to move to the appropriate match. | |
8531 When 'wildmode' is used, "wildmenu" mode is used where "full" is | |
8532 specified. "longest" and "list" do not start "wildmenu" mode. | |
4159 | 8533 You can check the current mode with |wildmenumode()|. |
7 | 8534 If there are more matches than can fit in the line, a ">" is shown on |
8535 the right and/or a "<" is shown on the left. The status line scrolls | |
8536 as needed. | |
8537 The "wildmenu" mode is abandoned when a key is hit that is not used | |
8538 for selecting a completion. | |
8539 While the "wildmenu" is active the following keys have special | |
8540 meanings: | |
8541 | |
8542 <Left> <Right> - select previous/next match (like CTRL-P/CTRL-N) | |
8543 <Down> - in filename/menu name completion: move into a | |
8544 subdirectory or submenu. | |
8545 <CR> - in menu completion, when the cursor is just after a | |
8546 dot: move into a submenu. | |
8547 <Up> - in filename/menu name completion: move up into | |
8548 parent directory or parent menu. | |
8549 | |
8550 This makes the menus accessible from the console |console-menus|. | |
8551 | |
8552 If you prefer the <Left> and <Right> keys to move the cursor instead | |
8553 of selecting a different match, use this: > | |
8554 :cnoremap <Left> <Space><BS><Left> | |
8555 :cnoremap <Right> <Space><BS><Right> | |
8556 < | |
8557 The "WildMenu" highlighting is used for displaying the current match | |
8558 |hl-WildMenu|. | |
8559 | |
8560 *'wildmode'* *'wim'* | |
8561 'wildmode' 'wim' string (Vim default: "full") | |
8562 global | |
8563 Completion mode that is used for the character specified with | |
10 | 8564 'wildchar'. It is a comma separated list of up to four parts. Each |
1152 | 8565 part specifies what to do for each consecutive use of 'wildchar'. The |
7 | 8566 first part specifies the behavior for the first use of 'wildchar', |
8567 The second part for the second use, etc. | |
8568 These are the possible values for each part: | |
8569 "" Complete only the first match. | |
8570 "full" Complete the next full match. After the last match, | |
8571 the original string is used and then the first match | |
8572 again. | |
8573 "longest" Complete till longest common string. If this doesn't | |
8574 result in a longer string, use the next part. | |
8575 "longest:full" Like "longest", but also start 'wildmenu' if it is | |
8576 enabled. | |
8577 "list" When more than one match, list all matches. | |
8578 "list:full" When more than one match, list all matches and | |
8579 complete first match. | |
8580 "list:longest" When more than one match, list all matches and | |
8581 complete till longest common string. | |
8582 When there is only a single match, it is fully completed in all cases. | |
8583 | |
8584 Examples: > | |
8585 :set wildmode=full | |
233 | 8586 < Complete first full match, next match, etc. (the default) > |
7 | 8587 :set wildmode=longest,full |
8588 < Complete longest common string, then each full match > | |
8589 :set wildmode=list:full | |
8590 < List all matches and complete each full match > | |
8591 :set wildmode=list,full | |
8592 < List all matches without completing, then each full match > | |
8593 :set wildmode=longest,list | |
8594 < Complete longest common string, then list alternatives. | |
1621 | 8595 More info here: |cmdline-completion|. |
7 | 8596 |
40 | 8597 *'wildoptions'* *'wop'* |
8598 'wildoptions' 'wop' string (default "") | |
8599 global | |
8600 {not available when compiled without the |+wildignore| | |
8601 feature} | |
8602 A list of words that change how command line completion is done. | |
8603 Currently only one word is allowed: | |
8604 tagfile When using CTRL-D to list matching tags, the kind of | |
856 | 8605 tag and the file of the tag is listed. Only one match |
40 | 8606 is displayed per line. Often used tag kinds are: |
8607 d #define | |
8608 f function | |
8609 Also see |cmdline-completion|. | |
8610 | |
7 | 8611 *'winaltkeys'* *'wak'* |
8612 'winaltkeys' 'wak' string (default "menu") | |
8613 global | |
8614 {only used in Win32, Motif, GTK and Photon GUI} | |
8615 Some GUI versions allow the access to menu entries by using the ALT | |
8616 key in combination with a character that appears underlined in the | |
8617 menu. This conflicts with the use of the ALT key for mappings and | |
8618 entering special characters. This option tells what to do: | |
8619 no Don't use ALT keys for menus. ALT key combinations can be | |
8620 mapped, but there is no automatic handling. This can then be | |
8621 done with the |:simalt| command. | |
8622 yes ALT key handling is done by the windowing system. ALT key | |
8623 combinations cannot be mapped. | |
8624 menu Using ALT in combination with a character that is a menu | |
10 | 8625 shortcut key, will be handled by the windowing system. Other |
7 | 8626 keys can be mapped. |
8627 If the menu is disabled by excluding 'm' from 'guioptions', the ALT | |
8628 key is never used for the menu. | |
36 | 8629 This option is not used for <F10>; on Win32 and with GTK <F10> will |
8630 select the menu, unless it has been mapped. | |
7 | 8631 |
164 | 8632 *'window'* *'wi'* |
8633 'window' 'wi' number (default screen height - 1) | |
8634 global | |
8635 Window height. Do not confuse this with the height of the Vim window, | |
8636 use 'lines' for that. | |
179 | 8637 Used for |CTRL-F| and |CTRL-B| when there is only one window and the |
8638 value is smaller than 'lines' minus one. The screen will scroll | |
8639 'window' minus two lines, with a minimum of one. | |
164 | 8640 When 'window' is equal to 'lines' minus one CTRL-F and CTRL-B scroll |
8641 in a much smarter way, taking care of wrapping lines. | |
8642 When resizing the Vim window, the value is smaller than 1 or more than | |
8643 or equal to 'lines' it will be set to 'lines' minus 1. | |
8644 {Vi also uses the option to specify the number of displayed lines} | |
8645 | |
7 | 8646 *'winheight'* *'wh'* *E591* |
8647 'winheight' 'wh' number (default 1) | |
8648 global | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
8649 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| |
7 | 8650 feature} |
8651 Minimal number of lines for the current window. This is not a hard | |
10 | 8652 minimum, Vim will use fewer lines if there is not enough room. If the |
1621 | 8653 focus goes to a window that is smaller, its size is increased, at the |
8654 cost of the height of other windows. | |
8655 Set 'winheight' to a small number for normal editing. | |
8656 Set it to 999 to make the current window fill most of the screen. | |
8657 Other windows will be only 'winminheight' high. This has the drawback | |
8658 that ":all" will create only two windows. To avoid "vim -o 1 2 3 4" | |
8659 to create only two windows, set the option after startup is done, | |
8660 using the |VimEnter| event: > | |
8661 au VimEnter * set winheight=999 | |
8662 < Minimum value is 1. | |
8663 The height is not adjusted after one of the commands that change the | |
7 | 8664 height of the current window. |
8665 'winheight' applies to the current window. Use 'winminheight' to set | |
8666 the minimal height for other windows. | |
8667 | |
8668 *'winfixheight'* *'wfh'* *'nowinfixheight'* *'nowfh'* | |
8669 'winfixheight' 'wfh' boolean (default off) | |
8670 local to window | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
8671 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| |
7 | 8672 feature} |
8673 Keep the window height when windows are opened or closed and | |
1152 | 8674 'equalalways' is set. Also for |CTRL-W_=|. Set by default for the |
8675 |preview-window| and |quickfix-window|. | |
7 | 8676 The height may be changed anyway when running out of room. |
8677 | |
782 | 8678 *'winfixwidth'* *'wfw'* *'nowinfixwidth'* *'nowfw'* |
8679 'winfixwidth' 'wfw' boolean (default off) | |
8680 local to window | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
8681 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| |
782 | 8682 feature} |
8683 Keep the window width when windows are opened or closed and | |
1152 | 8684 'equalalways' is set. Also for |CTRL-W_=|. |
782 | 8685 The width may be changed anyway when running out of room. |
8686 | |
7 | 8687 *'winminheight'* *'wmh'* |
8688 'winminheight' 'wmh' number (default 1) | |
8689 global | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
8690 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| |
7 | 8691 feature} |
8692 The minimal height of a window, when it's not the current window. | |
8693 This is a hard minimum, windows will never become smaller. | |
8694 When set to zero, windows may be "squashed" to zero lines (i.e. just a | |
8695 status bar) if necessary. They will return to at least one line when | |
8696 they become active (since the cursor has to have somewhere to go.) | |
8697 Use 'winheight' to set the minimal height of the current window. | |
8698 This option is only checked when making a window smaller. Don't use a | |
8699 large number, it will cause errors when opening more than a few | |
8700 windows. A value of 0 to 3 is reasonable. | |
8701 | |
8702 *'winminwidth'* *'wmw'* | |
8703 'winminwidth' 'wmw' number (default 1) | |
8704 global | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
8705 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit| |
7 | 8706 feature} |
8707 The minimal width of a window, when it's not the current window. | |
8708 This is a hard minimum, windows will never become smaller. | |
8709 When set to zero, windows may be "squashed" to zero columns (i.e. just | |
8710 a vertical separator) if necessary. They will return to at least one | |
8711 line when they become active (since the cursor has to have somewhere | |
8712 to go.) | |
8713 Use 'winwidth' to set the minimal width of the current window. | |
8714 This option is only checked when making a window smaller. Don't use a | |
8715 large number, it will cause errors when opening more than a few | |
8716 windows. A value of 0 to 12 is reasonable. | |
8717 | |
12138
bee3751f3d4e
patch 8.0.0949: winpty.dll name is fixed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11914
diff
changeset
|
8718 *'winptydll'* |
bee3751f3d4e
patch 8.0.0949: winpty.dll name is fixed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11914
diff
changeset
|
8719 'winptydll' string (default "winpty32.dll" or "winpty64.dll") |
bee3751f3d4e
patch 8.0.0949: winpty.dll name is fixed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11914
diff
changeset
|
8720 global |
bee3751f3d4e
patch 8.0.0949: winpty.dll name is fixed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11914
diff
changeset
|
8721 {only available when compiled with the |terminal| |
bee3751f3d4e
patch 8.0.0949: winpty.dll name is fixed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11914
diff
changeset
|
8722 feature on MS-Windows} |
bee3751f3d4e
patch 8.0.0949: winpty.dll name is fixed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11914
diff
changeset
|
8723 Specifies the name of the winpty shared library, used for the |
bee3751f3d4e
patch 8.0.0949: winpty.dll name is fixed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11914
diff
changeset
|
8724 |:terminal| command. The default depends on whether was build as a |
12254 | 8725 32-bit or 64-bit executable. If not found, "winpty.dll" is tried as |
12138
bee3751f3d4e
patch 8.0.0949: winpty.dll name is fixed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11914
diff
changeset
|
8726 a fallback. |
bee3751f3d4e
patch 8.0.0949: winpty.dll name is fixed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11914
diff
changeset
|
8727 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. |
bee3751f3d4e
patch 8.0.0949: winpty.dll name is fixed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11914
diff
changeset
|
8728 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
bee3751f3d4e
patch 8.0.0949: winpty.dll name is fixed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11914
diff
changeset
|
8729 security reasons. |
bee3751f3d4e
patch 8.0.0949: winpty.dll name is fixed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11914
diff
changeset
|
8730 |
7 | 8731 *'winwidth'* *'wiw'* *E592* |
8732 'winwidth' 'wiw' number (default 20) | |
8733 global | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
8734 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit| |
7 | 8735 feature} |
8736 Minimal number of columns for the current window. This is not a hard | |
8737 minimum, Vim will use fewer columns if there is not enough room. If | |
8738 the current window is smaller, its size is increased, at the cost of | |
8739 the width of other windows. Set it to 999 to make the current window | |
8740 always fill the screen. Set it to a small number for normal editing. | |
8741 The width is not adjusted after one of the commands to change the | |
8742 width of the current window. | |
8743 'winwidth' applies to the current window. Use 'winminwidth' to set | |
8744 the minimal width for other windows. | |
8745 | |
8746 *'wrap'* *'nowrap'* | |
8747 'wrap' boolean (default on) | |
8748 local to window | |
8749 This option changes how text is displayed. It doesn't change the text | |
8750 in the buffer, see 'textwidth' for that. | |
8751 When on, lines longer than the width of the window will wrap and | |
10 | 8752 displaying continues on the next line. When off lines will not wrap |
8753 and only part of long lines will be displayed. When the cursor is | |
7 | 8754 moved to a part that is not shown, the screen will scroll |
8755 horizontally. | |
8756 The line will be broken in the middle of a word if necessary. See | |
8757 'linebreak' to get the break at a word boundary. | |
8758 To make scrolling horizontally a bit more useful, try this: > | |
8759 :set sidescroll=5 | |
8760 :set listchars+=precedes:<,extends:> | |
8761 < See 'sidescroll', 'listchars' and |wrap-off|. | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
8762 This option can't be set from a |modeline| when the 'diff' option is |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
8763 on. |
7 | 8764 |
8765 *'wrapmargin'* *'wm'* | |
8766 'wrapmargin' 'wm' number (default 0) | |
8767 local to buffer | |
8768 Number of characters from the right window border where wrapping | |
8769 starts. When typing text beyond this limit, an <EOL> will be inserted | |
8770 and inserting continues on the next line. | |
8771 Options that add a margin, such as 'number' and 'foldcolumn', cause | |
8772 the text width to be further reduced. This is Vi compatible. | |
8773 When 'textwidth' is non-zero, this option is not used. | |
7147
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
8774 This option is set to 0 when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste' |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
8775 is reset. |
7 | 8776 See also 'formatoptions' and |ins-textwidth|. {Vi: works differently |
8777 and less usefully} | |
8778 | |
8779 *'wrapscan'* *'ws'* *'nowrapscan'* *'nows'* | |
8780 'wrapscan' 'ws' boolean (default on) *E384* *E385* | |
8781 global | |
500 | 8782 Searches wrap around the end of the file. Also applies to |]s| and |
8783 |[s|, searching for spelling mistakes. | |
7 | 8784 |
8785 *'write'* *'nowrite'* | |
8786 'write' boolean (default on) | |
8787 global | |
8788 Allows writing files. When not set, writing a file is not allowed. | |
8789 Can be used for a view-only mode, where modifications to the text are | |
10 | 8790 still allowed. Can be reset with the |-m| or |-M| command line |
7 | 8791 argument. Filtering text is still possible, even though this requires |
8792 writing a temporary file. | |
8793 | |
8794 *'writeany'* *'wa'* *'nowriteany'* *'nowa'* | |
8795 'writeany' 'wa' boolean (default off) | |
8796 global | |
8797 Allows writing to any file with no need for "!" override. | |
8798 | |
8799 *'writebackup'* *'wb'* *'nowritebackup'* *'nowb'* | |
8800 'writebackup' 'wb' boolean (default on with |+writebackup| feature, off | |
8801 otherwise) | |
8802 global | |
8803 Make a backup before overwriting a file. The backup is removed after | |
8804 the file was successfully written, unless the 'backup' option is | |
3513 | 8805 also on. |
8806 WARNING: Switching this option off means that when Vim fails to write | |
8807 your buffer correctly and then, for whatever reason, Vim exits, you | |
8808 lose both the original file and what you were writing. Only reset | |
8809 this option if your file system is almost full and it makes the write | |
8810 fail (and make sure not to exit Vim until the write was successful). | |
8811 See |backup-table| for another explanation. | |
7 | 8812 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a backup is not made anyway. |
8813 NOTE: This option is set to the default value when 'compatible' is | |
8814 set. | |
8815 | |
8816 *'writedelay'* *'wd'* | |
8817 'writedelay' 'wd' number (default 0) | |
8818 global | |
9344
33c1b85d408c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/802a0d902fca423acb15f835d7b09183883d79a0
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9286
diff
changeset
|
8819 The number of milliseconds to wait for each character sent to the |
7 | 8820 screen. When non-zero, characters are sent to the terminal one by |
8821 one. For MS-DOS pcterm this does not work. For debugging purposes. | |
8822 | |
14421 | 8823 vim:tw=78:ts=8:noet:ft=help:norl: |